LCOV - code coverage report
Current view: top level - src/backend/access/transam - xlog.c (source / functions) Coverage Total Hit
Test: PostgreSQL 19devel Lines: 88.7 % 2509 2225
Test Date: 2026-03-23 08:15:59 Functions: 97.6 % 126 123
Legend: Lines:     hit not hit

            Line data    Source code
       1              : /*-------------------------------------------------------------------------
       2              :  *
       3              :  * xlog.c
       4              :  *      PostgreSQL write-ahead log manager
       5              :  *
       6              :  * The Write-Ahead Log (WAL) functionality is split into several source
       7              :  * files, in addition to this one:
       8              :  *
       9              :  * xloginsert.c - Functions for constructing WAL records
      10              :  * xlogrecovery.c - WAL recovery and standby code
      11              :  * xlogreader.c - Facility for reading WAL files and parsing WAL records
      12              :  * xlogutils.c - Helper functions for WAL redo routines
      13              :  *
      14              :  * This file contains functions for coordinating database startup and
      15              :  * checkpointing, and managing the write-ahead log buffers when the
      16              :  * system is running.
      17              :  *
      18              :  * StartupXLOG() is the main entry point of the startup process.  It
      19              :  * coordinates database startup, performing WAL recovery, and the
      20              :  * transition from WAL recovery into normal operations.
      21              :  *
      22              :  * XLogInsertRecord() inserts a WAL record into the WAL buffers.  Most
      23              :  * callers should not call this directly, but use the functions in
      24              :  * xloginsert.c to construct the WAL record.  XLogFlush() can be used
      25              :  * to force the WAL to disk.
      26              :  *
      27              :  * In addition to those, there are many other functions for interrogating
      28              :  * the current system state, and for starting/stopping backups.
      29              :  *
      30              :  *
      31              :  * Portions Copyright (c) 1996-2026, PostgreSQL Global Development Group
      32              :  * Portions Copyright (c) 1994, Regents of the University of California
      33              :  *
      34              :  * src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c
      35              :  *
      36              :  *-------------------------------------------------------------------------
      37              :  */
      38              : 
      39              : #include "postgres.h"
      40              : 
      41              : #include <ctype.h>
      42              : #include <math.h>
      43              : #include <time.h>
      44              : #include <fcntl.h>
      45              : #include <sys/stat.h>
      46              : #include <sys/time.h>
      47              : #include <unistd.h>
      48              : 
      49              : #include "access/clog.h"
      50              : #include "access/commit_ts.h"
      51              : #include "access/heaptoast.h"
      52              : #include "access/multixact.h"
      53              : #include "access/rewriteheap.h"
      54              : #include "access/subtrans.h"
      55              : #include "access/timeline.h"
      56              : #include "access/transam.h"
      57              : #include "access/twophase.h"
      58              : #include "access/xact.h"
      59              : #include "access/xlog_internal.h"
      60              : #include "access/xlogarchive.h"
      61              : #include "access/xloginsert.h"
      62              : #include "access/xlogreader.h"
      63              : #include "access/xlogrecovery.h"
      64              : #include "access/xlogutils.h"
      65              : #include "access/xlogwait.h"
      66              : #include "backup/basebackup.h"
      67              : #include "catalog/catversion.h"
      68              : #include "catalog/pg_control.h"
      69              : #include "catalog/pg_database.h"
      70              : #include "common/controldata_utils.h"
      71              : #include "common/file_utils.h"
      72              : #include "executor/instrument.h"
      73              : #include "miscadmin.h"
      74              : #include "pg_trace.h"
      75              : #include "pgstat.h"
      76              : #include "port/atomics.h"
      77              : #include "postmaster/bgwriter.h"
      78              : #include "postmaster/startup.h"
      79              : #include "postmaster/walsummarizer.h"
      80              : #include "postmaster/walwriter.h"
      81              : #include "replication/origin.h"
      82              : #include "replication/slot.h"
      83              : #include "replication/slotsync.h"
      84              : #include "replication/snapbuild.h"
      85              : #include "replication/walreceiver.h"
      86              : #include "replication/walsender.h"
      87              : #include "storage/bufmgr.h"
      88              : #include "storage/fd.h"
      89              : #include "storage/ipc.h"
      90              : #include "storage/large_object.h"
      91              : #include "storage/latch.h"
      92              : #include "storage/predicate.h"
      93              : #include "storage/proc.h"
      94              : #include "storage/procarray.h"
      95              : #include "storage/reinit.h"
      96              : #include "storage/spin.h"
      97              : #include "storage/sync.h"
      98              : #include "utils/guc_hooks.h"
      99              : #include "utils/guc_tables.h"
     100              : #include "utils/injection_point.h"
     101              : #include "utils/pgstat_internal.h"
     102              : #include "utils/ps_status.h"
     103              : #include "utils/relmapper.h"
     104              : #include "utils/snapmgr.h"
     105              : #include "utils/timeout.h"
     106              : #include "utils/timestamp.h"
     107              : #include "utils/varlena.h"
     108              : #include "utils/wait_event.h"
     109              : 
     110              : #ifdef WAL_DEBUG
     111              : #include "utils/memutils.h"
     112              : #endif
     113              : 
     114              : /* timeline ID to be used when bootstrapping */
     115              : #define BootstrapTimeLineID     1
     116              : 
     117              : /* User-settable parameters */
     118              : int         max_wal_size_mb = 1024; /* 1 GB */
     119              : int         min_wal_size_mb = 80;   /* 80 MB */
     120              : int         wal_keep_size_mb = 0;
     121              : int         XLOGbuffers = -1;
     122              : int         XLogArchiveTimeout = 0;
     123              : int         XLogArchiveMode = ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF;
     124              : char       *XLogArchiveCommand = NULL;
     125              : bool        EnableHotStandby = false;
     126              : bool        fullPageWrites = true;
     127              : bool        wal_log_hints = false;
     128              : int         wal_compression = WAL_COMPRESSION_NONE;
     129              : char       *wal_consistency_checking_string = NULL;
     130              : bool       *wal_consistency_checking = NULL;
     131              : bool        wal_init_zero = true;
     132              : bool        wal_recycle = true;
     133              : bool        log_checkpoints = true;
     134              : int         wal_sync_method = DEFAULT_WAL_SYNC_METHOD;
     135              : int         wal_level = WAL_LEVEL_REPLICA;
     136              : int         CommitDelay = 0;    /* precommit delay in microseconds */
     137              : int         CommitSiblings = 5; /* # concurrent xacts needed to sleep */
     138              : int         wal_retrieve_retry_interval = 5000;
     139              : int         max_slot_wal_keep_size_mb = -1;
     140              : int         wal_decode_buffer_size = 512 * 1024;
     141              : bool        track_wal_io_timing = false;
     142              : 
     143              : #ifdef WAL_DEBUG
     144              : bool        XLOG_DEBUG = false;
     145              : #endif
     146              : 
     147              : int         wal_segment_size = DEFAULT_XLOG_SEG_SIZE;
     148              : 
     149              : /*
     150              :  * Number of WAL insertion locks to use. A higher value allows more insertions
     151              :  * to happen concurrently, but adds some CPU overhead to flushing the WAL,
     152              :  * which needs to iterate all the locks.
     153              :  */
     154              : #define NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS  8
     155              : 
     156              : /*
     157              :  * Max distance from last checkpoint, before triggering a new xlog-based
     158              :  * checkpoint.
     159              :  */
     160              : int         CheckPointSegments;
     161              : 
     162              : /* Estimated distance between checkpoints, in bytes */
     163              : static double CheckPointDistanceEstimate = 0;
     164              : static double PrevCheckPointDistance = 0;
     165              : 
     166              : /*
     167              :  * Track whether there were any deferred checks for custom resource managers
     168              :  * specified in wal_consistency_checking.
     169              :  */
     170              : static bool check_wal_consistency_checking_deferred = false;
     171              : 
     172              : /*
     173              :  * GUC support
     174              :  */
     175              : const struct config_enum_entry wal_sync_method_options[] = {
     176              :     {"fsync", WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC, false},
     177              : #ifdef HAVE_FSYNC_WRITETHROUGH
     178              :     {"fsync_writethrough", WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC_WRITETHROUGH, false},
     179              : #endif
     180              :     {"fdatasync", WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FDATASYNC, false},
     181              : #ifdef O_SYNC
     182              :     {"open_sync", WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN, false},
     183              : #endif
     184              : #ifdef O_DSYNC
     185              :     {"open_datasync", WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN_DSYNC, false},
     186              : #endif
     187              :     {NULL, 0, false}
     188              : };
     189              : 
     190              : 
     191              : /*
     192              :  * Although only "on", "off", and "always" are documented,
     193              :  * we accept all the likely variants of "on" and "off".
     194              :  */
     195              : const struct config_enum_entry archive_mode_options[] = {
     196              :     {"always", ARCHIVE_MODE_ALWAYS, false},
     197              :     {"on", ARCHIVE_MODE_ON, false},
     198              :     {"off", ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF, false},
     199              :     {"true", ARCHIVE_MODE_ON, true},
     200              :     {"false", ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF, true},
     201              :     {"yes", ARCHIVE_MODE_ON, true},
     202              :     {"no", ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF, true},
     203              :     {"1", ARCHIVE_MODE_ON, true},
     204              :     {"0", ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF, true},
     205              :     {NULL, 0, false}
     206              : };
     207              : 
     208              : /*
     209              :  * Statistics for current checkpoint are collected in this global struct.
     210              :  * Because only the checkpointer or a stand-alone backend can perform
     211              :  * checkpoints, this will be unused in normal backends.
     212              :  */
     213              : CheckpointStatsData CheckpointStats;
     214              : 
     215              : /*
     216              :  * During recovery, lastFullPageWrites keeps track of full_page_writes that
     217              :  * the replayed WAL records indicate. It's initialized with full_page_writes
     218              :  * that the recovery starting checkpoint record indicates, and then updated
     219              :  * each time XLOG_FPW_CHANGE record is replayed.
     220              :  */
     221              : static bool lastFullPageWrites;
     222              : 
     223              : /*
     224              :  * Local copy of the state tracked by SharedRecoveryState in shared memory,
     225              :  * It is false if SharedRecoveryState is RECOVERY_STATE_DONE.  True actually
     226              :  * means "not known, need to check the shared state".
     227              :  */
     228              : static bool LocalRecoveryInProgress = true;
     229              : 
     230              : /*
     231              :  * Local state for XLogInsertAllowed():
     232              :  *      1: unconditionally allowed to insert XLOG
     233              :  *      0: unconditionally not allowed to insert XLOG
     234              :  *      -1: must check RecoveryInProgress(); disallow until it is false
     235              :  * Most processes start with -1 and transition to 1 after seeing that recovery
     236              :  * is not in progress.  But we can also force the value for special cases.
     237              :  * The coding in XLogInsertAllowed() depends on the first two of these states
     238              :  * being numerically the same as bool true and false.
     239              :  */
     240              : static int  LocalXLogInsertAllowed = -1;
     241              : 
     242              : /*
     243              :  * ProcLastRecPtr points to the start of the last XLOG record inserted by the
     244              :  * current backend.  It is updated for all inserts.  XactLastRecEnd points to
     245              :  * end+1 of the last record, and is reset when we end a top-level transaction,
     246              :  * or start a new one; so it can be used to tell if the current transaction has
     247              :  * created any XLOG records.
     248              :  *
     249              :  * While in parallel mode, this may not be fully up to date.  When committing,
     250              :  * a transaction can assume this covers all xlog records written either by the
     251              :  * user backend or by any parallel worker which was present at any point during
     252              :  * the transaction.  But when aborting, or when still in parallel mode, other
     253              :  * parallel backends may have written WAL records at later LSNs than the value
     254              :  * stored here.  The parallel leader advances its own copy, when necessary,
     255              :  * in WaitForParallelWorkersToFinish.
     256              :  */
     257              : XLogRecPtr  ProcLastRecPtr = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
     258              : XLogRecPtr  XactLastRecEnd = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
     259              : XLogRecPtr  XactLastCommitEnd = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
     260              : 
     261              : /*
     262              :  * RedoRecPtr is this backend's local copy of the REDO record pointer
     263              :  * (which is almost but not quite the same as a pointer to the most recent
     264              :  * CHECKPOINT record).  We update this from the shared-memory copy,
     265              :  * XLogCtl->Insert.RedoRecPtr, whenever we can safely do so (ie, when we
     266              :  * hold an insertion lock).  See XLogInsertRecord for details.  We are also
     267              :  * allowed to update from XLogCtl->RedoRecPtr if we hold the info_lck;
     268              :  * see GetRedoRecPtr.
     269              :  *
     270              :  * NB: Code that uses this variable must be prepared not only for the
     271              :  * possibility that it may be arbitrarily out of date, but also for the
     272              :  * possibility that it might be set to InvalidXLogRecPtr. We used to
     273              :  * initialize it as a side effect of the first call to RecoveryInProgress(),
     274              :  * which meant that most code that might use it could assume that it had a
     275              :  * real if perhaps stale value. That's no longer the case.
     276              :  */
     277              : static XLogRecPtr RedoRecPtr;
     278              : 
     279              : /*
     280              :  * doPageWrites is this backend's local copy of (fullPageWrites ||
     281              :  * runningBackups > 0).  It is used together with RedoRecPtr to decide whether
     282              :  * a full-page image of a page need to be taken.
     283              :  *
     284              :  * NB: Initially this is false, and there's no guarantee that it will be
     285              :  * initialized to any other value before it is first used. Any code that
     286              :  * makes use of it must recheck the value after obtaining a WALInsertLock,
     287              :  * and respond appropriately if it turns out that the previous value wasn't
     288              :  * accurate.
     289              :  */
     290              : static bool doPageWrites;
     291              : 
     292              : /*----------
     293              :  * Shared-memory data structures for XLOG control
     294              :  *
     295              :  * LogwrtRqst indicates a byte position that we need to write and/or fsync
     296              :  * the log up to (all records before that point must be written or fsynced).
     297              :  * The positions already written/fsynced are maintained in logWriteResult
     298              :  * and logFlushResult using atomic access.
     299              :  * In addition to the shared variable, each backend has a private copy of
     300              :  * both in LogwrtResult, which is updated when convenient.
     301              :  *
     302              :  * The request bookkeeping is simpler: there is a shared XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst
     303              :  * (protected by info_lck), but we don't need to cache any copies of it.
     304              :  *
     305              :  * info_lck is only held long enough to read/update the protected variables,
     306              :  * so it's a plain spinlock.  The other locks are held longer (potentially
     307              :  * over I/O operations), so we use LWLocks for them.  These locks are:
     308              :  *
     309              :  * WALBufMappingLock: must be held to replace a page in the WAL buffer cache.
     310              :  * It is only held while initializing and changing the mapping.  If the
     311              :  * contents of the buffer being replaced haven't been written yet, the mapping
     312              :  * lock is released while the write is done, and reacquired afterwards.
     313              :  *
     314              :  * WALWriteLock: must be held to write WAL buffers to disk (XLogWrite or
     315              :  * XLogFlush).
     316              :  *
     317              :  * ControlFileLock: must be held to read/update control file or create
     318              :  * new log file.
     319              :  *
     320              :  *----------
     321              :  */
     322              : 
     323              : typedef struct XLogwrtRqst
     324              : {
     325              :     XLogRecPtr  Write;          /* last byte + 1 to write out */
     326              :     XLogRecPtr  Flush;          /* last byte + 1 to flush */
     327              : } XLogwrtRqst;
     328              : 
     329              : typedef struct XLogwrtResult
     330              : {
     331              :     XLogRecPtr  Write;          /* last byte + 1 written out */
     332              :     XLogRecPtr  Flush;          /* last byte + 1 flushed */
     333              : } XLogwrtResult;
     334              : 
     335              : /*
     336              :  * Inserting to WAL is protected by a small fixed number of WAL insertion
     337              :  * locks. To insert to the WAL, you must hold one of the locks - it doesn't
     338              :  * matter which one. To lock out other concurrent insertions, you must hold
     339              :  * of them. Each WAL insertion lock consists of a lightweight lock, plus an
     340              :  * indicator of how far the insertion has progressed (insertingAt).
     341              :  *
     342              :  * The insertingAt values are read when a process wants to flush WAL from
     343              :  * the in-memory buffers to disk, to check that all the insertions to the
     344              :  * region the process is about to write out have finished. You could simply
     345              :  * wait for all currently in-progress insertions to finish, but the
     346              :  * insertingAt indicator allows you to ignore insertions to later in the WAL,
     347              :  * so that you only wait for the insertions that are modifying the buffers
     348              :  * you're about to write out.
     349              :  *
     350              :  * This isn't just an optimization. If all the WAL buffers are dirty, an
     351              :  * inserter that's holding a WAL insert lock might need to evict an old WAL
     352              :  * buffer, which requires flushing the WAL. If it's possible for an inserter
     353              :  * to block on another inserter unnecessarily, deadlock can arise when two
     354              :  * inserters holding a WAL insert lock wait for each other to finish their
     355              :  * insertion.
     356              :  *
     357              :  * Small WAL records that don't cross a page boundary never update the value,
     358              :  * the WAL record is just copied to the page and the lock is released. But
     359              :  * to avoid the deadlock-scenario explained above, the indicator is always
     360              :  * updated before sleeping while holding an insertion lock.
     361              :  *
     362              :  * lastImportantAt contains the LSN of the last important WAL record inserted
     363              :  * using a given lock. This value is used to detect if there has been
     364              :  * important WAL activity since the last time some action, like a checkpoint,
     365              :  * was performed - allowing to not repeat the action if not. The LSN is
     366              :  * updated for all insertions, unless the XLOG_MARK_UNIMPORTANT flag was
     367              :  * set. lastImportantAt is never cleared, only overwritten by the LSN of newer
     368              :  * records.  Tracking the WAL activity directly in WALInsertLock has the
     369              :  * advantage of not needing any additional locks to update the value.
     370              :  */
     371              : typedef struct
     372              : {
     373              :     LWLock      lock;
     374              :     pg_atomic_uint64 insertingAt;
     375              :     XLogRecPtr  lastImportantAt;
     376              : } WALInsertLock;
     377              : 
     378              : /*
     379              :  * All the WAL insertion locks are allocated as an array in shared memory. We
     380              :  * force the array stride to be a power of 2, which saves a few cycles in
     381              :  * indexing, but more importantly also ensures that individual slots don't
     382              :  * cross cache line boundaries. (Of course, we have to also ensure that the
     383              :  * array start address is suitably aligned.)
     384              :  */
     385              : typedef union WALInsertLockPadded
     386              : {
     387              :     WALInsertLock l;
     388              :     char        pad[PG_CACHE_LINE_SIZE];
     389              : } WALInsertLockPadded;
     390              : 
     391              : /*
     392              :  * Session status of running backup, used for sanity checks in SQL-callable
     393              :  * functions to start and stop backups.
     394              :  */
     395              : static SessionBackupState sessionBackupState = SESSION_BACKUP_NONE;
     396              : 
     397              : /*
     398              :  * Shared state data for WAL insertion.
     399              :  */
     400              : typedef struct XLogCtlInsert
     401              : {
     402              :     slock_t     insertpos_lck;  /* protects CurrBytePos and PrevBytePos */
     403              : 
     404              :     /*
     405              :      * CurrBytePos is the end of reserved WAL. The next record will be
     406              :      * inserted at that position. PrevBytePos is the start position of the
     407              :      * previously inserted (or rather, reserved) record - it is copied to the
     408              :      * prev-link of the next record. These are stored as "usable byte
     409              :      * positions" rather than XLogRecPtrs (see XLogBytePosToRecPtr()).
     410              :      */
     411              :     uint64      CurrBytePos;
     412              :     uint64      PrevBytePos;
     413              : 
     414              :     /*
     415              :      * Make sure the above heavily-contended spinlock and byte positions are
     416              :      * on their own cache line. In particular, the RedoRecPtr and full page
     417              :      * write variables below should be on a different cache line. They are
     418              :      * read on every WAL insertion, but updated rarely, and we don't want
     419              :      * those reads to steal the cache line containing Curr/PrevBytePos.
     420              :      */
     421              :     char        pad[PG_CACHE_LINE_SIZE];
     422              : 
     423              :     /*
     424              :      * fullPageWrites is the authoritative value used by all backends to
     425              :      * determine whether to write full-page image to WAL. This shared value,
     426              :      * instead of the process-local fullPageWrites, is required because, when
     427              :      * full_page_writes is changed by SIGHUP, we must WAL-log it before it
     428              :      * actually affects WAL-logging by backends.  Checkpointer sets at startup
     429              :      * or after SIGHUP.
     430              :      *
     431              :      * To read these fields, you must hold an insertion lock. To modify them,
     432              :      * you must hold ALL the locks.
     433              :      */
     434              :     XLogRecPtr  RedoRecPtr;     /* current redo point for insertions */
     435              :     bool        fullPageWrites;
     436              : 
     437              :     /*
     438              :      * runningBackups is a counter indicating the number of backups currently
     439              :      * in progress. lastBackupStart is the latest checkpoint redo location
     440              :      * used as a starting point for an online backup.
     441              :      */
     442              :     int         runningBackups;
     443              :     XLogRecPtr  lastBackupStart;
     444              : 
     445              :     /*
     446              :      * WAL insertion locks.
     447              :      */
     448              :     WALInsertLockPadded *WALInsertLocks;
     449              : } XLogCtlInsert;
     450              : 
     451              : /*
     452              :  * Total shared-memory state for XLOG.
     453              :  */
     454              : typedef struct XLogCtlData
     455              : {
     456              :     XLogCtlInsert Insert;
     457              : 
     458              :     /* Protected by info_lck: */
     459              :     XLogwrtRqst LogwrtRqst;
     460              :     XLogRecPtr  RedoRecPtr;     /* a recent copy of Insert->RedoRecPtr */
     461              :     XLogRecPtr  asyncXactLSN;   /* LSN of newest async commit/abort */
     462              :     XLogRecPtr  replicationSlotMinLSN;  /* oldest LSN needed by any slot */
     463              : 
     464              :     XLogSegNo   lastRemovedSegNo;   /* latest removed/recycled XLOG segment */
     465              : 
     466              :     /* Fake LSN counter, for unlogged relations. */
     467              :     pg_atomic_uint64 unloggedLSN;
     468              : 
     469              :     /* Time and LSN of last xlog segment switch. Protected by WALWriteLock. */
     470              :     pg_time_t   lastSegSwitchTime;
     471              :     XLogRecPtr  lastSegSwitchLSN;
     472              : 
     473              :     /* These are accessed using atomics -- info_lck not needed */
     474              :     pg_atomic_uint64 logInsertResult;   /* last byte + 1 inserted to buffers */
     475              :     pg_atomic_uint64 logWriteResult;    /* last byte + 1 written out */
     476              :     pg_atomic_uint64 logFlushResult;    /* last byte + 1 flushed */
     477              : 
     478              :     /*
     479              :      * Latest initialized page in the cache (last byte position + 1).
     480              :      *
     481              :      * To change the identity of a buffer (and InitializedUpTo), you need to
     482              :      * hold WALBufMappingLock.  To change the identity of a buffer that's
     483              :      * still dirty, the old page needs to be written out first, and for that
     484              :      * you need WALWriteLock, and you need to ensure that there are no
     485              :      * in-progress insertions to the page by calling
     486              :      * WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish().
     487              :      */
     488              :     XLogRecPtr  InitializedUpTo;
     489              : 
     490              :     /*
     491              :      * These values do not change after startup, although the pointed-to pages
     492              :      * and xlblocks values certainly do.  xlblocks values are protected by
     493              :      * WALBufMappingLock.
     494              :      */
     495              :     char       *pages;          /* buffers for unwritten XLOG pages */
     496              :     pg_atomic_uint64 *xlblocks; /* 1st byte ptr-s + XLOG_BLCKSZ */
     497              :     int         XLogCacheBlck;  /* highest allocated xlog buffer index */
     498              : 
     499              :     /*
     500              :      * InsertTimeLineID is the timeline into which new WAL is being inserted
     501              :      * and flushed. It is zero during recovery, and does not change once set.
     502              :      *
     503              :      * If we create a new timeline when the system was started up,
     504              :      * PrevTimeLineID is the old timeline's ID that we forked off from.
     505              :      * Otherwise it's equal to InsertTimeLineID.
     506              :      *
     507              :      * We set these fields while holding info_lck. Most that reads these
     508              :      * values knows that recovery is no longer in progress and so can safely
     509              :      * read the value without a lock, but code that could be run either during
     510              :      * or after recovery can take info_lck while reading these values.
     511              :      */
     512              :     TimeLineID  InsertTimeLineID;
     513              :     TimeLineID  PrevTimeLineID;
     514              : 
     515              :     /*
     516              :      * SharedRecoveryState indicates if we're still in crash or archive
     517              :      * recovery.  Protected by info_lck.
     518              :      */
     519              :     RecoveryState SharedRecoveryState;
     520              : 
     521              :     /*
     522              :      * InstallXLogFileSegmentActive indicates whether the checkpointer should
     523              :      * arrange for future segments by recycling and/or PreallocXlogFiles().
     524              :      * Protected by ControlFileLock.  Only the startup process changes it.  If
     525              :      * true, anyone can use InstallXLogFileSegment().  If false, the startup
     526              :      * process owns the exclusive right to install segments, by reading from
     527              :      * the archive and possibly replacing existing files.
     528              :      */
     529              :     bool        InstallXLogFileSegmentActive;
     530              : 
     531              :     /*
     532              :      * WalWriterSleeping indicates whether the WAL writer is currently in
     533              :      * low-power mode (and hence should be nudged if an async commit occurs).
     534              :      * Protected by info_lck.
     535              :      */
     536              :     bool        WalWriterSleeping;
     537              : 
     538              :     /*
     539              :      * During recovery, we keep a copy of the latest checkpoint record here.
     540              :      * lastCheckPointRecPtr points to start of checkpoint record and
     541              :      * lastCheckPointEndPtr points to end+1 of checkpoint record.  Used by the
     542              :      * checkpointer when it wants to create a restartpoint.
     543              :      *
     544              :      * Protected by info_lck.
     545              :      */
     546              :     XLogRecPtr  lastCheckPointRecPtr;
     547              :     XLogRecPtr  lastCheckPointEndPtr;
     548              :     CheckPoint  lastCheckPoint;
     549              : 
     550              :     /*
     551              :      * lastFpwDisableRecPtr points to the start of the last replayed
     552              :      * XLOG_FPW_CHANGE record that instructs full_page_writes is disabled.
     553              :      */
     554              :     XLogRecPtr  lastFpwDisableRecPtr;
     555              : 
     556              :     slock_t     info_lck;       /* locks shared variables shown above */
     557              : } XLogCtlData;
     558              : 
     559              : /*
     560              :  * Classification of XLogInsertRecord operations.
     561              :  */
     562              : typedef enum
     563              : {
     564              :     WALINSERT_NORMAL,
     565              :     WALINSERT_SPECIAL_SWITCH,
     566              :     WALINSERT_SPECIAL_CHECKPOINT
     567              : } WalInsertClass;
     568              : 
     569              : static XLogCtlData *XLogCtl = NULL;
     570              : 
     571              : /* a private copy of XLogCtl->Insert.WALInsertLocks, for convenience */
     572              : static WALInsertLockPadded *WALInsertLocks = NULL;
     573              : 
     574              : /*
     575              :  * We maintain an image of pg_control in shared memory.
     576              :  */
     577              : static ControlFileData *ControlFile = NULL;
     578              : 
     579              : /*
     580              :  * Calculate the amount of space left on the page after 'endptr'. Beware
     581              :  * multiple evaluation!
     582              :  */
     583              : #define INSERT_FREESPACE(endptr)    \
     584              :     (((endptr) % XLOG_BLCKSZ == 0) ? 0 : (XLOG_BLCKSZ - (endptr) % XLOG_BLCKSZ))
     585              : 
     586              : /* Macro to advance to next buffer index. */
     587              : #define NextBufIdx(idx)     \
     588              :         (((idx) == XLogCtl->XLogCacheBlck) ? 0 : ((idx) + 1))
     589              : 
     590              : /*
     591              :  * XLogRecPtrToBufIdx returns the index of the WAL buffer that holds, or
     592              :  * would hold if it was in cache, the page containing 'recptr'.
     593              :  */
     594              : #define XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(recptr)  \
     595              :     (((recptr) / XLOG_BLCKSZ) % (XLogCtl->XLogCacheBlck + 1))
     596              : 
     597              : /*
     598              :  * These are the number of bytes in a WAL page usable for WAL data.
     599              :  */
     600              : #define UsableBytesInPage (XLOG_BLCKSZ - SizeOfXLogShortPHD)
     601              : 
     602              : /*
     603              :  * Convert values of GUCs measured in megabytes to equiv. segment count.
     604              :  * Rounds down.
     605              :  */
     606              : #define ConvertToXSegs(x, segsize)  XLogMBVarToSegs((x), (segsize))
     607              : 
     608              : /* The number of bytes in a WAL segment usable for WAL data. */
     609              : static int  UsableBytesInSegment;
     610              : 
     611              : /*
     612              :  * Private, possibly out-of-date copy of shared LogwrtResult.
     613              :  * See discussion above.
     614              :  */
     615              : static XLogwrtResult LogwrtResult = {0, 0};
     616              : 
     617              : /*
     618              :  * Update local copy of shared XLogCtl->log{Write,Flush}Result
     619              :  *
     620              :  * It's critical that Flush always trails Write, so the order of the reads is
     621              :  * important, as is the barrier.  See also XLogWrite.
     622              :  */
     623              : #define RefreshXLogWriteResult(_target) \
     624              :     do { \
     625              :         _target.Flush = pg_atomic_read_u64(&XLogCtl->logFlushResult); \
     626              :         pg_read_barrier(); \
     627              :         _target.Write = pg_atomic_read_u64(&XLogCtl->logWriteResult); \
     628              :     } while (0)
     629              : 
     630              : /*
     631              :  * openLogFile is -1 or a kernel FD for an open log file segment.
     632              :  * openLogSegNo identifies the segment, and openLogTLI the corresponding TLI.
     633              :  * These variables are only used to write the XLOG, and so will normally refer
     634              :  * to the active segment.
     635              :  *
     636              :  * Note: call Reserve/ReleaseExternalFD to track consumption of this FD.
     637              :  */
     638              : static int  openLogFile = -1;
     639              : static XLogSegNo openLogSegNo = 0;
     640              : static TimeLineID openLogTLI = 0;
     641              : 
     642              : /*
     643              :  * Local copies of equivalent fields in the control file.  When running
     644              :  * crash recovery, LocalMinRecoveryPoint is set to InvalidXLogRecPtr as we
     645              :  * expect to replay all the WAL available, and updateMinRecoveryPoint is
     646              :  * switched to false to prevent any updates while replaying records.
     647              :  * Those values are kept consistent as long as crash recovery runs.
     648              :  */
     649              : static XLogRecPtr LocalMinRecoveryPoint;
     650              : static TimeLineID LocalMinRecoveryPointTLI;
     651              : static bool updateMinRecoveryPoint = true;
     652              : 
     653              : /* For WALInsertLockAcquire/Release functions */
     654              : static int  MyLockNo = 0;
     655              : static bool holdingAllLocks = false;
     656              : 
     657              : #ifdef WAL_DEBUG
     658              : static MemoryContext walDebugCxt = NULL;
     659              : #endif
     660              : 
     661              : static void CleanupAfterArchiveRecovery(TimeLineID EndOfLogTLI,
     662              :                                         XLogRecPtr EndOfLog,
     663              :                                         TimeLineID newTLI);
     664              : static void CheckRequiredParameterValues(void);
     665              : static void XLogReportParameters(void);
     666              : static int  LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed(void);
     667              : static void CreateEndOfRecoveryRecord(void);
     668              : static XLogRecPtr CreateOverwriteContrecordRecord(XLogRecPtr aborted_lsn,
     669              :                                                   XLogRecPtr pagePtr,
     670              :                                                   TimeLineID newTLI);
     671              : static void CheckPointGuts(XLogRecPtr checkPointRedo, int flags);
     672              : static void KeepLogSeg(XLogRecPtr recptr, XLogSegNo *logSegNo);
     673              : 
     674              : static void AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(XLogRecPtr upto, TimeLineID tli,
     675              :                                   bool opportunistic);
     676              : static void XLogWrite(XLogwrtRqst WriteRqst, TimeLineID tli, bool flexible);
     677              : static bool InstallXLogFileSegment(XLogSegNo *segno, char *tmppath,
     678              :                                    bool find_free, XLogSegNo max_segno,
     679              :                                    TimeLineID tli);
     680              : static void XLogFileClose(void);
     681              : static void PreallocXlogFiles(XLogRecPtr endptr, TimeLineID tli);
     682              : static void RemoveTempXlogFiles(void);
     683              : static void RemoveOldXlogFiles(XLogSegNo segno, XLogRecPtr lastredoptr,
     684              :                                XLogRecPtr endptr, TimeLineID insertTLI);
     685              : static void RemoveXlogFile(const struct dirent *segment_de,
     686              :                            XLogSegNo recycleSegNo, XLogSegNo *endlogSegNo,
     687              :                            TimeLineID insertTLI);
     688              : static void UpdateLastRemovedPtr(char *filename);
     689              : static void ValidateXLOGDirectoryStructure(void);
     690              : static void CleanupBackupHistory(void);
     691              : static void UpdateMinRecoveryPoint(XLogRecPtr lsn, bool force);
     692              : static bool PerformRecoveryXLogAction(void);
     693              : static void InitControlFile(uint64 sysidentifier, uint32 data_checksum_version);
     694              : static void WriteControlFile(void);
     695              : static void ReadControlFile(void);
     696              : static void UpdateControlFile(void);
     697              : static char *str_time(pg_time_t tnow, char *buf, size_t bufsize);
     698              : 
     699              : static int  get_sync_bit(int method);
     700              : 
     701              : static void CopyXLogRecordToWAL(int write_len, bool isLogSwitch,
     702              :                                 XLogRecData *rdata,
     703              :                                 XLogRecPtr StartPos, XLogRecPtr EndPos,
     704              :                                 TimeLineID tli);
     705              : static void ReserveXLogInsertLocation(int size, XLogRecPtr *StartPos,
     706              :                                       XLogRecPtr *EndPos, XLogRecPtr *PrevPtr);
     707              : static bool ReserveXLogSwitch(XLogRecPtr *StartPos, XLogRecPtr *EndPos,
     708              :                               XLogRecPtr *PrevPtr);
     709              : static XLogRecPtr WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(XLogRecPtr upto);
     710              : static char *GetXLogBuffer(XLogRecPtr ptr, TimeLineID tli);
     711              : static XLogRecPtr XLogBytePosToRecPtr(uint64 bytepos);
     712              : static XLogRecPtr XLogBytePosToEndRecPtr(uint64 bytepos);
     713              : static uint64 XLogRecPtrToBytePos(XLogRecPtr ptr);
     714              : 
     715              : static void WALInsertLockAcquire(void);
     716              : static void WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive(void);
     717              : static void WALInsertLockRelease(void);
     718              : static void WALInsertLockUpdateInsertingAt(XLogRecPtr insertingAt);
     719              : 
     720              : /*
     721              :  * Insert an XLOG record represented by an already-constructed chain of data
     722              :  * chunks.  This is a low-level routine; to construct the WAL record header
     723              :  * and data, use the higher-level routines in xloginsert.c.
     724              :  *
     725              :  * If 'fpw_lsn' is valid, it is the oldest LSN among the pages that this
     726              :  * WAL record applies to, that were not included in the record as full page
     727              :  * images.  If fpw_lsn <= RedoRecPtr, the function does not perform the
     728              :  * insertion and returns InvalidXLogRecPtr.  The caller can then recalculate
     729              :  * which pages need a full-page image, and retry.  If fpw_lsn is invalid, the
     730              :  * record is always inserted.
     731              :  *
     732              :  * 'flags' gives more in-depth control on the record being inserted. See
     733              :  * XLogSetRecordFlags() for details.
     734              :  *
     735              :  * 'topxid_included' tells whether the top-transaction id is logged along with
     736              :  * current subtransaction. See XLogRecordAssemble().
     737              :  *
     738              :  * The first XLogRecData in the chain must be for the record header, and its
     739              :  * data must be MAXALIGNed.  XLogInsertRecord fills in the xl_prev and
     740              :  * xl_crc fields in the header, the rest of the header must already be filled
     741              :  * by the caller.
     742              :  *
     743              :  * Returns XLOG pointer to end of record (beginning of next record).
     744              :  * This can be used as LSN for data pages affected by the logged action.
     745              :  * (LSN is the XLOG point up to which the XLOG must be flushed to disk
     746              :  * before the data page can be written out.  This implements the basic
     747              :  * WAL rule "write the log before the data".)
     748              :  */
     749              : XLogRecPtr
     750     18264115 : XLogInsertRecord(XLogRecData *rdata,
     751              :                  XLogRecPtr fpw_lsn,
     752              :                  uint8 flags,
     753              :                  int num_fpi,
     754              :                  uint64 fpi_bytes,
     755              :                  bool topxid_included)
     756              : {
     757     18264115 :     XLogCtlInsert *Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert;
     758              :     pg_crc32c   rdata_crc;
     759              :     bool        inserted;
     760     18264115 :     XLogRecord *rechdr = (XLogRecord *) rdata->data;
     761     18264115 :     uint8       info = rechdr->xl_info & ~XLR_INFO_MASK;
     762     18264115 :     WalInsertClass class = WALINSERT_NORMAL;
     763              :     XLogRecPtr  StartPos;
     764              :     XLogRecPtr  EndPos;
     765     18264115 :     bool        prevDoPageWrites = doPageWrites;
     766              :     TimeLineID  insertTLI;
     767              : 
     768              :     /* Does this record type require special handling? */
     769     18264115 :     if (unlikely(rechdr->xl_rmid == RM_XLOG_ID))
     770              :     {
     771       347067 :         if (info == XLOG_SWITCH)
     772          812 :             class = WALINSERT_SPECIAL_SWITCH;
     773       346255 :         else if (info == XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO)
     774          937 :             class = WALINSERT_SPECIAL_CHECKPOINT;
     775              :     }
     776              : 
     777              :     /* we assume that all of the record header is in the first chunk */
     778              :     Assert(rdata->len >= SizeOfXLogRecord);
     779              : 
     780              :     /* cross-check on whether we should be here or not */
     781     18264115 :     if (!XLogInsertAllowed())
     782            0 :         elog(ERROR, "cannot make new WAL entries during recovery");
     783              : 
     784              :     /*
     785              :      * Given that we're not in recovery, InsertTimeLineID is set and can't
     786              :      * change, so we can read it without a lock.
     787              :      */
     788     18264115 :     insertTLI = XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
     789              : 
     790              :     /*----------
     791              :      *
     792              :      * We have now done all the preparatory work we can without holding a
     793              :      * lock or modifying shared state. From here on, inserting the new WAL
     794              :      * record to the shared WAL buffer cache is a two-step process:
     795              :      *
     796              :      * 1. Reserve the right amount of space from the WAL. The current head of
     797              :      *    reserved space is kept in Insert->CurrBytePos, and is protected by
     798              :      *    insertpos_lck.
     799              :      *
     800              :      * 2. Copy the record to the reserved WAL space. This involves finding the
     801              :      *    correct WAL buffer containing the reserved space, and copying the
     802              :      *    record in place. This can be done concurrently in multiple processes.
     803              :      *
     804              :      * To keep track of which insertions are still in-progress, each concurrent
     805              :      * inserter acquires an insertion lock. In addition to just indicating that
     806              :      * an insertion is in progress, the lock tells others how far the inserter
     807              :      * has progressed. There is a small fixed number of insertion locks,
     808              :      * determined by NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS. When an inserter crosses a page
     809              :      * boundary, it updates the value stored in the lock to the how far it has
     810              :      * inserted, to allow the previous buffer to be flushed.
     811              :      *
     812              :      * Holding onto an insertion lock also protects RedoRecPtr and
     813              :      * fullPageWrites from changing until the insertion is finished.
     814              :      *
     815              :      * Step 2 can usually be done completely in parallel. If the required WAL
     816              :      * page is not initialized yet, you have to grab WALBufMappingLock to
     817              :      * initialize it, but the WAL writer tries to do that ahead of insertions
     818              :      * to avoid that from happening in the critical path.
     819              :      *
     820              :      *----------
     821              :      */
     822     18264115 :     START_CRIT_SECTION();
     823              : 
     824     18264115 :     if (likely(class == WALINSERT_NORMAL))
     825              :     {
     826     18262366 :         WALInsertLockAcquire();
     827              : 
     828              :         /*
     829              :          * Check to see if my copy of RedoRecPtr is out of date. If so, may
     830              :          * have to go back and have the caller recompute everything. This can
     831              :          * only happen just after a checkpoint, so it's better to be slow in
     832              :          * this case and fast otherwise.
     833              :          *
     834              :          * Also check to see if fullPageWrites was just turned on or there's a
     835              :          * running backup (which forces full-page writes); if we weren't
     836              :          * already doing full-page writes then go back and recompute.
     837              :          *
     838              :          * If we aren't doing full-page writes then RedoRecPtr doesn't
     839              :          * actually affect the contents of the XLOG record, so we'll update
     840              :          * our local copy but not force a recomputation.  (If doPageWrites was
     841              :          * just turned off, we could recompute the record without full pages,
     842              :          * but we choose not to bother.)
     843              :          */
     844     18262366 :         if (RedoRecPtr != Insert->RedoRecPtr)
     845              :         {
     846              :             Assert(RedoRecPtr < Insert->RedoRecPtr);
     847         7906 :             RedoRecPtr = Insert->RedoRecPtr;
     848              :         }
     849     18262366 :         doPageWrites = (Insert->fullPageWrites || Insert->runningBackups > 0);
     850              : 
     851     18262366 :         if (doPageWrites &&
     852     17994854 :             (!prevDoPageWrites ||
     853     16567656 :              (XLogRecPtrIsValid(fpw_lsn) && fpw_lsn <= RedoRecPtr)))
     854              :         {
     855              :             /*
     856              :              * Oops, some buffer now needs to be backed up that the caller
     857              :              * didn't back up.  Start over.
     858              :              */
     859         8568 :             WALInsertLockRelease();
     860         8568 :             END_CRIT_SECTION();
     861         8568 :             return InvalidXLogRecPtr;
     862              :         }
     863              : 
     864              :         /*
     865              :          * Reserve space for the record in the WAL. This also sets the xl_prev
     866              :          * pointer.
     867              :          */
     868     18253798 :         ReserveXLogInsertLocation(rechdr->xl_tot_len, &StartPos, &EndPos,
     869              :                                   &rechdr->xl_prev);
     870              : 
     871              :         /* Normal records are always inserted. */
     872     18253798 :         inserted = true;
     873              :     }
     874         1749 :     else if (class == WALINSERT_SPECIAL_SWITCH)
     875              :     {
     876              :         /*
     877              :          * In order to insert an XLOG_SWITCH record, we need to hold all of
     878              :          * the WAL insertion locks, not just one, so that no one else can
     879              :          * begin inserting a record until we've figured out how much space
     880              :          * remains in the current WAL segment and claimed all of it.
     881              :          *
     882              :          * Nonetheless, this case is simpler than the normal cases handled
     883              :          * below, which must check for changes in doPageWrites and RedoRecPtr.
     884              :          * Those checks are only needed for records that can contain buffer
     885              :          * references, and an XLOG_SWITCH record never does.
     886              :          */
     887              :         Assert(!XLogRecPtrIsValid(fpw_lsn));
     888          812 :         WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive();
     889          812 :         inserted = ReserveXLogSwitch(&StartPos, &EndPos, &rechdr->xl_prev);
     890              :     }
     891              :     else
     892              :     {
     893              :         Assert(class == WALINSERT_SPECIAL_CHECKPOINT);
     894              : 
     895              :         /*
     896              :          * We need to update both the local and shared copies of RedoRecPtr,
     897              :          * which means that we need to hold all the WAL insertion locks.
     898              :          * However, there can't be any buffer references, so as above, we need
     899              :          * not check RedoRecPtr before inserting the record; we just need to
     900              :          * update it afterwards.
     901              :          */
     902              :         Assert(!XLogRecPtrIsValid(fpw_lsn));
     903          937 :         WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive();
     904          937 :         ReserveXLogInsertLocation(rechdr->xl_tot_len, &StartPos, &EndPos,
     905              :                                   &rechdr->xl_prev);
     906          937 :         RedoRecPtr = Insert->RedoRecPtr = StartPos;
     907          937 :         inserted = true;
     908              :     }
     909              : 
     910     18255547 :     if (inserted)
     911              :     {
     912              :         /*
     913              :          * Now that xl_prev has been filled in, calculate CRC of the record
     914              :          * header.
     915              :          */
     916     18255485 :         rdata_crc = rechdr->xl_crc;
     917     18255485 :         COMP_CRC32C(rdata_crc, rechdr, offsetof(XLogRecord, xl_crc));
     918     18255485 :         FIN_CRC32C(rdata_crc);
     919     18255485 :         rechdr->xl_crc = rdata_crc;
     920              : 
     921              :         /*
     922              :          * All the record data, including the header, is now ready to be
     923              :          * inserted. Copy the record in the space reserved.
     924              :          */
     925     18255485 :         CopyXLogRecordToWAL(rechdr->xl_tot_len,
     926              :                             class == WALINSERT_SPECIAL_SWITCH, rdata,
     927              :                             StartPos, EndPos, insertTLI);
     928              : 
     929              :         /*
     930              :          * Unless record is flagged as not important, update LSN of last
     931              :          * important record in the current slot. When holding all locks, just
     932              :          * update the first one.
     933              :          */
     934     18255485 :         if ((flags & XLOG_MARK_UNIMPORTANT) == 0)
     935              :         {
     936     18036206 :             int         lockno = holdingAllLocks ? 0 : MyLockNo;
     937              : 
     938     18036206 :             WALInsertLocks[lockno].l.lastImportantAt = StartPos;
     939              :         }
     940              :     }
     941              :     else
     942              :     {
     943              :         /*
     944              :          * This was an xlog-switch record, but the current insert location was
     945              :          * already exactly at the beginning of a segment, so there was no need
     946              :          * to do anything.
     947              :          */
     948              :     }
     949              : 
     950              :     /*
     951              :      * Done! Let others know that we're finished.
     952              :      */
     953     18255547 :     WALInsertLockRelease();
     954              : 
     955     18255547 :     END_CRIT_SECTION();
     956              : 
     957     18255547 :     MarkCurrentTransactionIdLoggedIfAny();
     958              : 
     959              :     /*
     960              :      * Mark top transaction id is logged (if needed) so that we should not try
     961              :      * to log it again with the next WAL record in the current subtransaction.
     962              :      */
     963     18255547 :     if (topxid_included)
     964          219 :         MarkSubxactTopXidLogged();
     965              : 
     966              :     /*
     967              :      * Update shared LogwrtRqst.Write, if we crossed page boundary.
     968              :      */
     969     18255547 :     if (StartPos / XLOG_BLCKSZ != EndPos / XLOG_BLCKSZ)
     970              :     {
     971      1769865 :         SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
     972              :         /* advance global request to include new block(s) */
     973      1769865 :         if (XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write < EndPos)
     974      1710319 :             XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write = EndPos;
     975      1769865 :         SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
     976      1769865 :         RefreshXLogWriteResult(LogwrtResult);
     977              :     }
     978              : 
     979              :     /*
     980              :      * If this was an XLOG_SWITCH record, flush the record and the empty
     981              :      * padding space that fills the rest of the segment, and perform
     982              :      * end-of-segment actions (eg, notifying archiver).
     983              :      */
     984     18255547 :     if (class == WALINSERT_SPECIAL_SWITCH)
     985              :     {
     986              :         TRACE_POSTGRESQL_WAL_SWITCH();
     987          812 :         XLogFlush(EndPos);
     988              : 
     989              :         /*
     990              :          * Even though we reserved the rest of the segment for us, which is
     991              :          * reflected in EndPos, we return a pointer to just the end of the
     992              :          * xlog-switch record.
     993              :          */
     994          812 :         if (inserted)
     995              :         {
     996          750 :             EndPos = StartPos + SizeOfXLogRecord;
     997          750 :             if (StartPos / XLOG_BLCKSZ != EndPos / XLOG_BLCKSZ)
     998              :             {
     999            0 :                 uint64      offset = XLogSegmentOffset(EndPos, wal_segment_size);
    1000              : 
    1001            0 :                 if (offset == EndPos % XLOG_BLCKSZ)
    1002            0 :                     EndPos += SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
    1003              :                 else
    1004            0 :                     EndPos += SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
    1005              :             }
    1006              :         }
    1007              :     }
    1008              : 
    1009              : #ifdef WAL_DEBUG
    1010              :     if (XLOG_DEBUG)
    1011              :     {
    1012              :         static XLogReaderState *debug_reader = NULL;
    1013              :         XLogRecord *record;
    1014              :         DecodedXLogRecord *decoded;
    1015              :         StringInfoData buf;
    1016              :         StringInfoData recordBuf;
    1017              :         char       *errormsg = NULL;
    1018              :         MemoryContext oldCxt;
    1019              : 
    1020              :         oldCxt = MemoryContextSwitchTo(walDebugCxt);
    1021              : 
    1022              :         initStringInfo(&buf);
    1023              :         appendStringInfo(&buf, "INSERT @ %X/%08X: ", LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(EndPos));
    1024              : 
    1025              :         /*
    1026              :          * We have to piece together the WAL record data from the XLogRecData
    1027              :          * entries, so that we can pass it to the rm_desc function as one
    1028              :          * contiguous chunk.
    1029              :          */
    1030              :         initStringInfo(&recordBuf);
    1031              :         for (; rdata != NULL; rdata = rdata->next)
    1032              :             appendBinaryStringInfo(&recordBuf, rdata->data, rdata->len);
    1033              : 
    1034              :         /* We also need temporary space to decode the record. */
    1035              :         record = (XLogRecord *) recordBuf.data;
    1036              :         decoded = (DecodedXLogRecord *)
    1037              :             palloc(DecodeXLogRecordRequiredSpace(record->xl_tot_len));
    1038              : 
    1039              :         if (!debug_reader)
    1040              :             debug_reader = XLogReaderAllocate(wal_segment_size, NULL,
    1041              :                                               XL_ROUTINE(.page_read = NULL,
    1042              :                                                          .segment_open = NULL,
    1043              :                                                          .segment_close = NULL),
    1044              :                                               NULL);
    1045              :         if (!debug_reader)
    1046              :         {
    1047              :             appendStringInfoString(&buf, "error decoding record: out of memory while allocating a WAL reading processor");
    1048              :         }
    1049              :         else if (!DecodeXLogRecord(debug_reader,
    1050              :                                    decoded,
    1051              :                                    record,
    1052              :                                    EndPos,
    1053              :                                    &errormsg))
    1054              :         {
    1055              :             appendStringInfo(&buf, "error decoding record: %s",
    1056              :                              errormsg ? errormsg : "no error message");
    1057              :         }
    1058              :         else
    1059              :         {
    1060              :             appendStringInfoString(&buf, " - ");
    1061              : 
    1062              :             debug_reader->record = decoded;
    1063              :             xlog_outdesc(&buf, debug_reader);
    1064              :             debug_reader->record = NULL;
    1065              :         }
    1066              :         elog(LOG, "%s", buf.data);
    1067              : 
    1068              :         pfree(decoded);
    1069              :         pfree(buf.data);
    1070              :         pfree(recordBuf.data);
    1071              :         MemoryContextSwitchTo(oldCxt);
    1072              :     }
    1073              : #endif
    1074              : 
    1075              :     /*
    1076              :      * Update our global variables
    1077              :      */
    1078     18255547 :     ProcLastRecPtr = StartPos;
    1079     18255547 :     XactLastRecEnd = EndPos;
    1080              : 
    1081              :     /* Report WAL traffic to the instrumentation. */
    1082     18255547 :     if (inserted)
    1083              :     {
    1084     18255485 :         pgWalUsage.wal_bytes += rechdr->xl_tot_len;
    1085     18255485 :         pgWalUsage.wal_records++;
    1086     18255485 :         pgWalUsage.wal_fpi += num_fpi;
    1087     18255485 :         pgWalUsage.wal_fpi_bytes += fpi_bytes;
    1088              : 
    1089              :         /* Required for the flush of pending stats WAL data */
    1090     18255485 :         pgstat_report_fixed = true;
    1091              :     }
    1092              : 
    1093     18255547 :     return EndPos;
    1094              : }
    1095              : 
    1096              : /*
    1097              :  * Reserves the right amount of space for a record of given size from the WAL.
    1098              :  * *StartPos is set to the beginning of the reserved section, *EndPos to
    1099              :  * its end+1. *PrevPtr is set to the beginning of the previous record; it is
    1100              :  * used to set the xl_prev of this record.
    1101              :  *
    1102              :  * This is the performance critical part of XLogInsert that must be serialized
    1103              :  * across backends. The rest can happen mostly in parallel. Try to keep this
    1104              :  * section as short as possible, insertpos_lck can be heavily contended on a
    1105              :  * busy system.
    1106              :  *
    1107              :  * NB: The space calculation here must match the code in CopyXLogRecordToWAL,
    1108              :  * where we actually copy the record to the reserved space.
    1109              :  *
    1110              :  * NB: Testing shows that XLogInsertRecord runs faster if this code is inlined;
    1111              :  * however, because there are two call sites, the compiler is reluctant to
    1112              :  * inline. We use pg_attribute_always_inline here to try to convince it.
    1113              :  */
    1114              : static pg_attribute_always_inline void
    1115     18254735 : ReserveXLogInsertLocation(int size, XLogRecPtr *StartPos, XLogRecPtr *EndPos,
    1116              :                           XLogRecPtr *PrevPtr)
    1117              : {
    1118     18254735 :     XLogCtlInsert *Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert;
    1119              :     uint64      startbytepos;
    1120              :     uint64      endbytepos;
    1121              :     uint64      prevbytepos;
    1122              : 
    1123     18254735 :     size = MAXALIGN(size);
    1124              : 
    1125              :     /* All (non xlog-switch) records should contain data. */
    1126              :     Assert(size > SizeOfXLogRecord);
    1127              : 
    1128              :     /*
    1129              :      * The duration the spinlock needs to be held is minimized by minimizing
    1130              :      * the calculations that have to be done while holding the lock. The
    1131              :      * current tip of reserved WAL is kept in CurrBytePos, as a byte position
    1132              :      * that only counts "usable" bytes in WAL, that is, it excludes all WAL
    1133              :      * page headers. The mapping between "usable" byte positions and physical
    1134              :      * positions (XLogRecPtrs) can be done outside the locked region, and
    1135              :      * because the usable byte position doesn't include any headers, reserving
    1136              :      * X bytes from WAL is almost as simple as "CurrBytePos += X".
    1137              :      */
    1138     18254735 :     SpinLockAcquire(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
    1139              : 
    1140     18254735 :     startbytepos = Insert->CurrBytePos;
    1141     18254735 :     endbytepos = startbytepos + size;
    1142     18254735 :     prevbytepos = Insert->PrevBytePos;
    1143     18254735 :     Insert->CurrBytePos = endbytepos;
    1144     18254735 :     Insert->PrevBytePos = startbytepos;
    1145              : 
    1146     18254735 :     SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
    1147              : 
    1148     18254735 :     *StartPos = XLogBytePosToRecPtr(startbytepos);
    1149     18254735 :     *EndPos = XLogBytePosToEndRecPtr(endbytepos);
    1150     18254735 :     *PrevPtr = XLogBytePosToRecPtr(prevbytepos);
    1151              : 
    1152              :     /*
    1153              :      * Check that the conversions between "usable byte positions" and
    1154              :      * XLogRecPtrs work consistently in both directions.
    1155              :      */
    1156              :     Assert(XLogRecPtrToBytePos(*StartPos) == startbytepos);
    1157              :     Assert(XLogRecPtrToBytePos(*EndPos) == endbytepos);
    1158              :     Assert(XLogRecPtrToBytePos(*PrevPtr) == prevbytepos);
    1159     18254735 : }
    1160              : 
    1161              : /*
    1162              :  * Like ReserveXLogInsertLocation(), but for an xlog-switch record.
    1163              :  *
    1164              :  * A log-switch record is handled slightly differently. The rest of the
    1165              :  * segment will be reserved for this insertion, as indicated by the returned
    1166              :  * *EndPos value. However, if we are already at the beginning of the current
    1167              :  * segment, *StartPos and *EndPos are set to the current location without
    1168              :  * reserving any space, and the function returns false.
    1169              : */
    1170              : static bool
    1171          812 : ReserveXLogSwitch(XLogRecPtr *StartPos, XLogRecPtr *EndPos, XLogRecPtr *PrevPtr)
    1172              : {
    1173          812 :     XLogCtlInsert *Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert;
    1174              :     uint64      startbytepos;
    1175              :     uint64      endbytepos;
    1176              :     uint64      prevbytepos;
    1177          812 :     uint32      size = MAXALIGN(SizeOfXLogRecord);
    1178              :     XLogRecPtr  ptr;
    1179              :     uint32      segleft;
    1180              : 
    1181              :     /*
    1182              :      * These calculations are a bit heavy-weight to be done while holding a
    1183              :      * spinlock, but since we're holding all the WAL insertion locks, there
    1184              :      * are no other inserters competing for it. GetXLogInsertRecPtr() does
    1185              :      * compete for it, but that's not called very frequently.
    1186              :      */
    1187          812 :     SpinLockAcquire(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
    1188              : 
    1189          812 :     startbytepos = Insert->CurrBytePos;
    1190              : 
    1191          812 :     ptr = XLogBytePosToEndRecPtr(startbytepos);
    1192          812 :     if (XLogSegmentOffset(ptr, wal_segment_size) == 0)
    1193              :     {
    1194           62 :         SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
    1195           62 :         *EndPos = *StartPos = ptr;
    1196           62 :         return false;
    1197              :     }
    1198              : 
    1199          750 :     endbytepos = startbytepos + size;
    1200          750 :     prevbytepos = Insert->PrevBytePos;
    1201              : 
    1202          750 :     *StartPos = XLogBytePosToRecPtr(startbytepos);
    1203          750 :     *EndPos = XLogBytePosToEndRecPtr(endbytepos);
    1204              : 
    1205          750 :     segleft = wal_segment_size - XLogSegmentOffset(*EndPos, wal_segment_size);
    1206          750 :     if (segleft != wal_segment_size)
    1207              :     {
    1208              :         /* consume the rest of the segment */
    1209          750 :         *EndPos += segleft;
    1210          750 :         endbytepos = XLogRecPtrToBytePos(*EndPos);
    1211              :     }
    1212          750 :     Insert->CurrBytePos = endbytepos;
    1213          750 :     Insert->PrevBytePos = startbytepos;
    1214              : 
    1215          750 :     SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
    1216              : 
    1217          750 :     *PrevPtr = XLogBytePosToRecPtr(prevbytepos);
    1218              : 
    1219              :     Assert(XLogSegmentOffset(*EndPos, wal_segment_size) == 0);
    1220              :     Assert(XLogRecPtrToBytePos(*EndPos) == endbytepos);
    1221              :     Assert(XLogRecPtrToBytePos(*StartPos) == startbytepos);
    1222              :     Assert(XLogRecPtrToBytePos(*PrevPtr) == prevbytepos);
    1223              : 
    1224          750 :     return true;
    1225              : }
    1226              : 
    1227              : /*
    1228              :  * Subroutine of XLogInsertRecord.  Copies a WAL record to an already-reserved
    1229              :  * area in the WAL.
    1230              :  */
    1231              : static void
    1232     18255485 : CopyXLogRecordToWAL(int write_len, bool isLogSwitch, XLogRecData *rdata,
    1233              :                     XLogRecPtr StartPos, XLogRecPtr EndPos, TimeLineID tli)
    1234              : {
    1235              :     char       *currpos;
    1236              :     int         freespace;
    1237              :     int         written;
    1238              :     XLogRecPtr  CurrPos;
    1239              :     XLogPageHeader pagehdr;
    1240              : 
    1241              :     /*
    1242              :      * Get a pointer to the right place in the right WAL buffer to start
    1243              :      * inserting to.
    1244              :      */
    1245     18255485 :     CurrPos = StartPos;
    1246     18255485 :     currpos = GetXLogBuffer(CurrPos, tli);
    1247     18255485 :     freespace = INSERT_FREESPACE(CurrPos);
    1248              : 
    1249              :     /*
    1250              :      * there should be enough space for at least the first field (xl_tot_len)
    1251              :      * on this page.
    1252              :      */
    1253              :     Assert(freespace >= sizeof(uint32));
    1254              : 
    1255              :     /* Copy record data */
    1256     18255485 :     written = 0;
    1257     85050760 :     while (rdata != NULL)
    1258              :     {
    1259     66795275 :         const char *rdata_data = rdata->data;
    1260     66795275 :         int         rdata_len = rdata->len;
    1261              : 
    1262     68688712 :         while (rdata_len > freespace)
    1263              :         {
    1264              :             /*
    1265              :              * Write what fits on this page, and continue on the next page.
    1266              :              */
    1267              :             Assert(CurrPos % XLOG_BLCKSZ >= SizeOfXLogShortPHD || freespace == 0);
    1268      1893437 :             memcpy(currpos, rdata_data, freespace);
    1269      1893437 :             rdata_data += freespace;
    1270      1893437 :             rdata_len -= freespace;
    1271      1893437 :             written += freespace;
    1272      1893437 :             CurrPos += freespace;
    1273              : 
    1274              :             /*
    1275              :              * Get pointer to beginning of next page, and set the xlp_rem_len
    1276              :              * in the page header. Set XLP_FIRST_IS_CONTRECORD.
    1277              :              *
    1278              :              * It's safe to set the contrecord flag and xlp_rem_len without a
    1279              :              * lock on the page. All the other flags were already set when the
    1280              :              * page was initialized, in AdvanceXLInsertBuffer, and we're the
    1281              :              * only backend that needs to set the contrecord flag.
    1282              :              */
    1283      1893437 :             currpos = GetXLogBuffer(CurrPos, tli);
    1284      1893437 :             pagehdr = (XLogPageHeader) currpos;
    1285      1893437 :             pagehdr->xlp_rem_len = write_len - written;
    1286      1893437 :             pagehdr->xlp_info |= XLP_FIRST_IS_CONTRECORD;
    1287              : 
    1288              :             /* skip over the page header */
    1289      1893437 :             if (XLogSegmentOffset(CurrPos, wal_segment_size) == 0)
    1290              :             {
    1291         1223 :                 CurrPos += SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
    1292         1223 :                 currpos += SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
    1293              :             }
    1294              :             else
    1295              :             {
    1296      1892214 :                 CurrPos += SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
    1297      1892214 :                 currpos += SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
    1298              :             }
    1299      1893437 :             freespace = INSERT_FREESPACE(CurrPos);
    1300              :         }
    1301              : 
    1302              :         Assert(CurrPos % XLOG_BLCKSZ >= SizeOfXLogShortPHD || rdata_len == 0);
    1303     66795275 :         memcpy(currpos, rdata_data, rdata_len);
    1304     66795275 :         currpos += rdata_len;
    1305     66795275 :         CurrPos += rdata_len;
    1306     66795275 :         freespace -= rdata_len;
    1307     66795275 :         written += rdata_len;
    1308              : 
    1309     66795275 :         rdata = rdata->next;
    1310              :     }
    1311              :     Assert(written == write_len);
    1312              : 
    1313              :     /*
    1314              :      * If this was an xlog-switch, it's not enough to write the switch record,
    1315              :      * we also have to consume all the remaining space in the WAL segment.  We
    1316              :      * have already reserved that space, but we need to actually fill it.
    1317              :      */
    1318     18255485 :     if (isLogSwitch && XLogSegmentOffset(CurrPos, wal_segment_size) != 0)
    1319              :     {
    1320              :         /* An xlog-switch record doesn't contain any data besides the header */
    1321              :         Assert(write_len == SizeOfXLogRecord);
    1322              : 
    1323              :         /* Assert that we did reserve the right amount of space */
    1324              :         Assert(XLogSegmentOffset(EndPos, wal_segment_size) == 0);
    1325              : 
    1326              :         /* Use up all the remaining space on the current page */
    1327          750 :         CurrPos += freespace;
    1328              : 
    1329              :         /*
    1330              :          * Cause all remaining pages in the segment to be flushed, leaving the
    1331              :          * XLog position where it should be, at the start of the next segment.
    1332              :          * We do this one page at a time, to make sure we don't deadlock
    1333              :          * against ourselves if wal_buffers < wal_segment_size.
    1334              :          */
    1335       747642 :         while (CurrPos < EndPos)
    1336              :         {
    1337              :             /*
    1338              :              * The minimal action to flush the page would be to call
    1339              :              * WALInsertLockUpdateInsertingAt(CurrPos) followed by
    1340              :              * AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(...).  The page would be left initialized
    1341              :              * mostly to zeros, except for the page header (always the short
    1342              :              * variant, as this is never a segment's first page).
    1343              :              *
    1344              :              * The large vistas of zeros are good for compressibility, but the
    1345              :              * headers interrupting them every XLOG_BLCKSZ (with values that
    1346              :              * differ from page to page) are not.  The effect varies with
    1347              :              * compression tool, but bzip2 for instance compresses about an
    1348              :              * order of magnitude worse if those headers are left in place.
    1349              :              *
    1350              :              * Rather than complicating AdvanceXLInsertBuffer itself (which is
    1351              :              * called in heavily-loaded circumstances as well as this lightly-
    1352              :              * loaded one) with variant behavior, we just use GetXLogBuffer
    1353              :              * (which itself calls the two methods we need) to get the pointer
    1354              :              * and zero most of the page.  Then we just zero the page header.
    1355              :              */
    1356       746892 :             currpos = GetXLogBuffer(CurrPos, tli);
    1357      2987568 :             MemSet(currpos, 0, SizeOfXLogShortPHD);
    1358              : 
    1359       746892 :             CurrPos += XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    1360              :         }
    1361              :     }
    1362              :     else
    1363              :     {
    1364              :         /* Align the end position, so that the next record starts aligned */
    1365     18254735 :         CurrPos = MAXALIGN64(CurrPos);
    1366              :     }
    1367              : 
    1368     18255485 :     if (CurrPos != EndPos)
    1369            0 :         ereport(PANIC,
    1370              :                 errcode(ERRCODE_DATA_CORRUPTED),
    1371              :                 errmsg_internal("space reserved for WAL record does not match what was written"));
    1372     18255485 : }
    1373              : 
    1374              : /*
    1375              :  * Acquire a WAL insertion lock, for inserting to WAL.
    1376              :  */
    1377              : static void
    1378     18262376 : WALInsertLockAcquire(void)
    1379              : {
    1380              :     bool        immed;
    1381              : 
    1382              :     /*
    1383              :      * It doesn't matter which of the WAL insertion locks we acquire, so try
    1384              :      * the one we used last time.  If the system isn't particularly busy, it's
    1385              :      * a good bet that it's still available, and it's good to have some
    1386              :      * affinity to a particular lock so that you don't unnecessarily bounce
    1387              :      * cache lines between processes when there's no contention.
    1388              :      *
    1389              :      * If this is the first time through in this backend, pick a lock
    1390              :      * (semi-)randomly.  This allows the locks to be used evenly if you have a
    1391              :      * lot of very short connections.
    1392              :      */
    1393              :     static int  lockToTry = -1;
    1394              : 
    1395     18262376 :     if (lockToTry == -1)
    1396         9005 :         lockToTry = MyProcNumber % NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS;
    1397     18262376 :     MyLockNo = lockToTry;
    1398              : 
    1399              :     /*
    1400              :      * The insertingAt value is initially set to 0, as we don't know our
    1401              :      * insert location yet.
    1402              :      */
    1403     18262376 :     immed = LWLockAcquire(&WALInsertLocks[MyLockNo].l.lock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    1404     18262376 :     if (!immed)
    1405              :     {
    1406              :         /*
    1407              :          * If we couldn't get the lock immediately, try another lock next
    1408              :          * time.  On a system with more insertion locks than concurrent
    1409              :          * inserters, this causes all the inserters to eventually migrate to a
    1410              :          * lock that no-one else is using.  On a system with more inserters
    1411              :          * than locks, it still helps to distribute the inserters evenly
    1412              :          * across the locks.
    1413              :          */
    1414        18048 :         lockToTry = (lockToTry + 1) % NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS;
    1415              :     }
    1416     18262376 : }
    1417              : 
    1418              : /*
    1419              :  * Acquire all WAL insertion locks, to prevent other backends from inserting
    1420              :  * to WAL.
    1421              :  */
    1422              : static void
    1423         4603 : WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive(void)
    1424              : {
    1425              :     int         i;
    1426              : 
    1427              :     /*
    1428              :      * When holding all the locks, all but the last lock's insertingAt
    1429              :      * indicator is set to 0xFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFF, which is higher than any real
    1430              :      * XLogRecPtr value, to make sure that no-one blocks waiting on those.
    1431              :      */
    1432        36824 :     for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS - 1; i++)
    1433              :     {
    1434        32221 :         LWLockAcquire(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    1435        32221 :         LWLockUpdateVar(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock,
    1436        32221 :                         &WALInsertLocks[i].l.insertingAt,
    1437              :                         PG_UINT64_MAX);
    1438              :     }
    1439              :     /* Variable value reset to 0 at release */
    1440         4603 :     LWLockAcquire(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    1441              : 
    1442         4603 :     holdingAllLocks = true;
    1443         4603 : }
    1444              : 
    1445              : /*
    1446              :  * Release our insertion lock (or locks, if we're holding them all).
    1447              :  *
    1448              :  * NB: Reset all variables to 0, so they cause LWLockWaitForVar to block the
    1449              :  * next time the lock is acquired.
    1450              :  */
    1451              : static void
    1452     18266979 : WALInsertLockRelease(void)
    1453              : {
    1454     18266979 :     if (holdingAllLocks)
    1455              :     {
    1456              :         int         i;
    1457              : 
    1458        41427 :         for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS; i++)
    1459        36824 :             LWLockReleaseClearVar(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock,
    1460        36824 :                                   &WALInsertLocks[i].l.insertingAt,
    1461              :                                   0);
    1462              : 
    1463         4603 :         holdingAllLocks = false;
    1464              :     }
    1465              :     else
    1466              :     {
    1467     18262376 :         LWLockReleaseClearVar(&WALInsertLocks[MyLockNo].l.lock,
    1468     18262376 :                               &WALInsertLocks[MyLockNo].l.insertingAt,
    1469              :                               0);
    1470              :     }
    1471     18266979 : }
    1472              : 
    1473              : /*
    1474              :  * Update our insertingAt value, to let others know that we've finished
    1475              :  * inserting up to that point.
    1476              :  */
    1477              : static void
    1478      2592661 : WALInsertLockUpdateInsertingAt(XLogRecPtr insertingAt)
    1479              : {
    1480      2592661 :     if (holdingAllLocks)
    1481              :     {
    1482              :         /*
    1483              :          * We use the last lock to mark our actual position, see comments in
    1484              :          * WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive.
    1485              :          */
    1486       744146 :         LWLockUpdateVar(&WALInsertLocks[NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS - 1].l.lock,
    1487       744146 :                         &WALInsertLocks[NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS - 1].l.insertingAt,
    1488              :                         insertingAt);
    1489              :     }
    1490              :     else
    1491      1848515 :         LWLockUpdateVar(&WALInsertLocks[MyLockNo].l.lock,
    1492      1848515 :                         &WALInsertLocks[MyLockNo].l.insertingAt,
    1493              :                         insertingAt);
    1494      2592661 : }
    1495              : 
    1496              : /*
    1497              :  * Wait for any WAL insertions < upto to finish.
    1498              :  *
    1499              :  * Returns the location of the oldest insertion that is still in-progress.
    1500              :  * Any WAL prior to that point has been fully copied into WAL buffers, and
    1501              :  * can be flushed out to disk. Because this waits for any insertions older
    1502              :  * than 'upto' to finish, the return value is always >= 'upto'.
    1503              :  *
    1504              :  * Note: When you are about to write out WAL, you must call this function
    1505              :  * *before* acquiring WALWriteLock, to avoid deadlocks. This function might
    1506              :  * need to wait for an insertion to finish (or at least advance to next
    1507              :  * uninitialized page), and the inserter might need to evict an old WAL buffer
    1508              :  * to make room for a new one, which in turn requires WALWriteLock.
    1509              :  */
    1510              : static XLogRecPtr
    1511      2416807 : WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(XLogRecPtr upto)
    1512              : {
    1513              :     uint64      bytepos;
    1514              :     XLogRecPtr  inserted;
    1515              :     XLogRecPtr  reservedUpto;
    1516              :     XLogRecPtr  finishedUpto;
    1517      2416807 :     XLogCtlInsert *Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert;
    1518              :     int         i;
    1519              : 
    1520      2416807 :     if (MyProc == NULL)
    1521            0 :         elog(PANIC, "cannot wait without a PGPROC structure");
    1522              : 
    1523              :     /*
    1524              :      * Check if there's any work to do.  Use a barrier to ensure we get the
    1525              :      * freshest value.
    1526              :      */
    1527      2416807 :     inserted = pg_atomic_read_membarrier_u64(&XLogCtl->logInsertResult);
    1528      2416807 :     if (upto <= inserted)
    1529      1931186 :         return inserted;
    1530              : 
    1531              :     /* Read the current insert position */
    1532       485621 :     SpinLockAcquire(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
    1533       485621 :     bytepos = Insert->CurrBytePos;
    1534       485621 :     SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
    1535       485621 :     reservedUpto = XLogBytePosToEndRecPtr(bytepos);
    1536              : 
    1537              :     /*
    1538              :      * No-one should request to flush a piece of WAL that hasn't even been
    1539              :      * reserved yet. However, it can happen if there is a block with a bogus
    1540              :      * LSN on disk, for example. XLogFlush checks for that situation and
    1541              :      * complains, but only after the flush. Here we just assume that to mean
    1542              :      * that all WAL that has been reserved needs to be finished. In this
    1543              :      * corner-case, the return value can be smaller than 'upto' argument.
    1544              :      */
    1545       485621 :     if (upto > reservedUpto)
    1546              :     {
    1547            0 :         ereport(LOG,
    1548              :                 errmsg("request to flush past end of generated WAL; request %X/%08X, current position %X/%08X",
    1549              :                        LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(upto), LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(reservedUpto)));
    1550            0 :         upto = reservedUpto;
    1551              :     }
    1552              : 
    1553              :     /*
    1554              :      * Loop through all the locks, sleeping on any in-progress insert older
    1555              :      * than 'upto'.
    1556              :      *
    1557              :      * finishedUpto is our return value, indicating the point upto which all
    1558              :      * the WAL insertions have been finished. Initialize it to the head of
    1559              :      * reserved WAL, and as we iterate through the insertion locks, back it
    1560              :      * out for any insertion that's still in progress.
    1561              :      */
    1562       485621 :     finishedUpto = reservedUpto;
    1563      4370589 :     for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS; i++)
    1564              :     {
    1565      3884968 :         XLogRecPtr  insertingat = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
    1566              : 
    1567              :         do
    1568              :         {
    1569              :             /*
    1570              :              * See if this insertion is in progress.  LWLockWaitForVar will
    1571              :              * wait for the lock to be released, or for the 'value' to be set
    1572              :              * by a LWLockUpdateVar call.  When a lock is initially acquired,
    1573              :              * its value is 0 (InvalidXLogRecPtr), which means that we don't
    1574              :              * know where it's inserting yet.  We will have to wait for it. If
    1575              :              * it's a small insertion, the record will most likely fit on the
    1576              :              * same page and the inserter will release the lock without ever
    1577              :              * calling LWLockUpdateVar.  But if it has to sleep, it will
    1578              :              * advertise the insertion point with LWLockUpdateVar before
    1579              :              * sleeping.
    1580              :              *
    1581              :              * In this loop we are only waiting for insertions that started
    1582              :              * before WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish was called.  The lack of
    1583              :              * memory barriers in the loop means that we might see locks as
    1584              :              * "unused" that have since become used.  This is fine because
    1585              :              * they only can be used for later insertions that we would not
    1586              :              * want to wait on anyway.  Not taking a lock to acquire the
    1587              :              * current insertingAt value means that we might see older
    1588              :              * insertingAt values.  This is also fine, because if we read a
    1589              :              * value too old, we will add ourselves to the wait queue, which
    1590              :              * contains atomic operations.
    1591              :              */
    1592      3982705 :             if (LWLockWaitForVar(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock,
    1593      3982705 :                                  &WALInsertLocks[i].l.insertingAt,
    1594              :                                  insertingat, &insertingat))
    1595              :             {
    1596              :                 /* the lock was free, so no insertion in progress */
    1597      2786971 :                 insertingat = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
    1598      2786971 :                 break;
    1599              :             }
    1600              : 
    1601              :             /*
    1602              :              * This insertion is still in progress. Have to wait, unless the
    1603              :              * inserter has proceeded past 'upto'.
    1604              :              */
    1605      1195734 :         } while (insertingat < upto);
    1606              : 
    1607      3884968 :         if (XLogRecPtrIsValid(insertingat) && insertingat < finishedUpto)
    1608       390909 :             finishedUpto = insertingat;
    1609              :     }
    1610              : 
    1611              :     /*
    1612              :      * Advance the limit we know to have been inserted and return the freshest
    1613              :      * value we know of, which might be beyond what we requested if somebody
    1614              :      * is concurrently doing this with an 'upto' pointer ahead of us.
    1615              :      */
    1616       485621 :     finishedUpto = pg_atomic_monotonic_advance_u64(&XLogCtl->logInsertResult,
    1617              :                                                    finishedUpto);
    1618              : 
    1619       485621 :     return finishedUpto;
    1620              : }
    1621              : 
    1622              : /*
    1623              :  * Get a pointer to the right location in the WAL buffer containing the
    1624              :  * given XLogRecPtr.
    1625              :  *
    1626              :  * If the page is not initialized yet, it is initialized. That might require
    1627              :  * evicting an old dirty buffer from the buffer cache, which means I/O.
    1628              :  *
    1629              :  * The caller must ensure that the page containing the requested location
    1630              :  * isn't evicted yet, and won't be evicted. The way to ensure that is to
    1631              :  * hold onto a WAL insertion lock with the insertingAt position set to
    1632              :  * something <= ptr. GetXLogBuffer() will update insertingAt if it needs
    1633              :  * to evict an old page from the buffer. (This means that once you call
    1634              :  * GetXLogBuffer() with a given 'ptr', you must not access anything before
    1635              :  * that point anymore, and must not call GetXLogBuffer() with an older 'ptr'
    1636              :  * later, because older buffers might be recycled already)
    1637              :  */
    1638              : static char *
    1639     20895824 : GetXLogBuffer(XLogRecPtr ptr, TimeLineID tli)
    1640              : {
    1641              :     int         idx;
    1642              :     XLogRecPtr  endptr;
    1643              :     static uint64 cachedPage = 0;
    1644              :     static char *cachedPos = NULL;
    1645              :     XLogRecPtr  expectedEndPtr;
    1646              : 
    1647              :     /*
    1648              :      * Fast path for the common case that we need to access again the same
    1649              :      * page as last time.
    1650              :      */
    1651     20895824 :     if (ptr / XLOG_BLCKSZ == cachedPage)
    1652              :     {
    1653              :         Assert(((XLogPageHeader) cachedPos)->xlp_magic == XLOG_PAGE_MAGIC);
    1654              :         Assert(((XLogPageHeader) cachedPos)->xlp_pageaddr == ptr - (ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ));
    1655     17827609 :         return cachedPos + ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    1656              :     }
    1657              : 
    1658              :     /*
    1659              :      * The XLog buffer cache is organized so that a page is always loaded to a
    1660              :      * particular buffer.  That way we can easily calculate the buffer a given
    1661              :      * page must be loaded into, from the XLogRecPtr alone.
    1662              :      */
    1663      3068215 :     idx = XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(ptr);
    1664              : 
    1665              :     /*
    1666              :      * See what page is loaded in the buffer at the moment. It could be the
    1667              :      * page we're looking for, or something older. It can't be anything newer
    1668              :      * - that would imply the page we're looking for has already been written
    1669              :      * out to disk and evicted, and the caller is responsible for making sure
    1670              :      * that doesn't happen.
    1671              :      *
    1672              :      * We don't hold a lock while we read the value. If someone is just about
    1673              :      * to initialize or has just initialized the page, it's possible that we
    1674              :      * get InvalidXLogRecPtr. That's ok, we'll grab the mapping lock (in
    1675              :      * AdvanceXLInsertBuffer) and retry if we see anything other than the page
    1676              :      * we're looking for.
    1677              :      */
    1678      3068215 :     expectedEndPtr = ptr;
    1679      3068215 :     expectedEndPtr += XLOG_BLCKSZ - ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    1680              : 
    1681      3068215 :     endptr = pg_atomic_read_u64(&XLogCtl->xlblocks[idx]);
    1682      3068215 :     if (expectedEndPtr != endptr)
    1683              :     {
    1684              :         XLogRecPtr  initializedUpto;
    1685              : 
    1686              :         /*
    1687              :          * Before calling AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(), which can block, let others
    1688              :          * know how far we're finished with inserting the record.
    1689              :          *
    1690              :          * NB: If 'ptr' points to just after the page header, advertise a
    1691              :          * position at the beginning of the page rather than 'ptr' itself. If
    1692              :          * there are no other insertions running, someone might try to flush
    1693              :          * up to our advertised location. If we advertised a position after
    1694              :          * the page header, someone might try to flush the page header, even
    1695              :          * though page might actually not be initialized yet. As the first
    1696              :          * inserter on the page, we are effectively responsible for making
    1697              :          * sure that it's initialized, before we let insertingAt to move past
    1698              :          * the page header.
    1699              :          */
    1700      2592661 :         if (ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ == SizeOfXLogShortPHD &&
    1701         7326 :             XLogSegmentOffset(ptr, wal_segment_size) > XLOG_BLCKSZ)
    1702         7326 :             initializedUpto = ptr - SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
    1703      2585335 :         else if (ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ == SizeOfXLogLongPHD &&
    1704         1018 :                  XLogSegmentOffset(ptr, wal_segment_size) < XLOG_BLCKSZ)
    1705          623 :             initializedUpto = ptr - SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
    1706              :         else
    1707      2584712 :             initializedUpto = ptr;
    1708              : 
    1709      2592661 :         WALInsertLockUpdateInsertingAt(initializedUpto);
    1710              : 
    1711      2592661 :         AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(ptr, tli, false);
    1712      2592661 :         endptr = pg_atomic_read_u64(&XLogCtl->xlblocks[idx]);
    1713              : 
    1714      2592661 :         if (expectedEndPtr != endptr)
    1715            0 :             elog(PANIC, "could not find WAL buffer for %X/%08X",
    1716              :                  LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(ptr));
    1717              :     }
    1718              :     else
    1719              :     {
    1720              :         /*
    1721              :          * Make sure the initialization of the page is visible to us, and
    1722              :          * won't arrive later to overwrite the WAL data we write on the page.
    1723              :          */
    1724       475554 :         pg_memory_barrier();
    1725              :     }
    1726              : 
    1727              :     /*
    1728              :      * Found the buffer holding this page. Return a pointer to the right
    1729              :      * offset within the page.
    1730              :      */
    1731      3068215 :     cachedPage = ptr / XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    1732      3068215 :     cachedPos = XLogCtl->pages + idx * (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    1733              : 
    1734              :     Assert(((XLogPageHeader) cachedPos)->xlp_magic == XLOG_PAGE_MAGIC);
    1735              :     Assert(((XLogPageHeader) cachedPos)->xlp_pageaddr == ptr - (ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ));
    1736              : 
    1737      3068215 :     return cachedPos + ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    1738              : }
    1739              : 
    1740              : /*
    1741              :  * Read WAL data directly from WAL buffers, if available. Returns the number
    1742              :  * of bytes read successfully.
    1743              :  *
    1744              :  * Fewer than 'count' bytes may be read if some of the requested WAL data has
    1745              :  * already been evicted.
    1746              :  *
    1747              :  * No locks are taken.
    1748              :  *
    1749              :  * Caller should ensure that it reads no further than LogwrtResult.Write
    1750              :  * (which should have been updated by the caller when determining how far to
    1751              :  * read). The 'tli' argument is only used as a convenient safety check so that
    1752              :  * callers do not read from WAL buffers on a historical timeline.
    1753              :  */
    1754              : Size
    1755       105391 : WALReadFromBuffers(char *dstbuf, XLogRecPtr startptr, Size count,
    1756              :                    TimeLineID tli)
    1757              : {
    1758       105391 :     char       *pdst = dstbuf;
    1759       105391 :     XLogRecPtr  recptr = startptr;
    1760              :     XLogRecPtr  inserted;
    1761       105391 :     Size        nbytes = count;
    1762              : 
    1763       105391 :     if (RecoveryInProgress() || tli != GetWALInsertionTimeLine())
    1764          909 :         return 0;
    1765              : 
    1766              :     Assert(XLogRecPtrIsValid(startptr));
    1767              : 
    1768              :     /*
    1769              :      * Caller should ensure that the requested data has been inserted into WAL
    1770              :      * buffers before we try to read it.
    1771              :      */
    1772       104482 :     inserted = pg_atomic_read_u64(&XLogCtl->logInsertResult);
    1773       104482 :     if (startptr + count > inserted)
    1774            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    1775              :                 errmsg("cannot read past end of generated WAL: requested %X/%08X, current position %X/%08X",
    1776              :                        LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(startptr + count),
    1777              :                        LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(inserted)));
    1778              : 
    1779              :     /*
    1780              :      * Loop through the buffers without a lock. For each buffer, atomically
    1781              :      * read and verify the end pointer, then copy the data out, and finally
    1782              :      * re-read and re-verify the end pointer.
    1783              :      *
    1784              :      * Once a page is evicted, it never returns to the WAL buffers, so if the
    1785              :      * end pointer matches the expected end pointer before and after we copy
    1786              :      * the data, then the right page must have been present during the data
    1787              :      * copy. Read barriers are necessary to ensure that the data copy actually
    1788              :      * happens between the two verification steps.
    1789              :      *
    1790              :      * If either verification fails, we simply terminate the loop and return
    1791              :      * with the data that had been already copied out successfully.
    1792              :      */
    1793       134744 :     while (nbytes > 0)
    1794              :     {
    1795       125971 :         uint32      offset = recptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    1796       125971 :         int         idx = XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(recptr);
    1797              :         XLogRecPtr  expectedEndPtr;
    1798              :         XLogRecPtr  endptr;
    1799              :         const char *page;
    1800              :         const char *psrc;
    1801              :         Size        npagebytes;
    1802              : 
    1803              :         /*
    1804              :          * Calculate the end pointer we expect in the xlblocks array if the
    1805              :          * correct page is present.
    1806              :          */
    1807       125971 :         expectedEndPtr = recptr + (XLOG_BLCKSZ - offset);
    1808              : 
    1809              :         /*
    1810              :          * First verification step: check that the correct page is present in
    1811              :          * the WAL buffers.
    1812              :          */
    1813       125971 :         endptr = pg_atomic_read_u64(&XLogCtl->xlblocks[idx]);
    1814       125971 :         if (expectedEndPtr != endptr)
    1815        95705 :             break;
    1816              : 
    1817              :         /*
    1818              :          * The correct page is present (or was at the time the endptr was
    1819              :          * read; must re-verify later). Calculate pointer to source data and
    1820              :          * determine how much data to read from this page.
    1821              :          */
    1822        30266 :         page = XLogCtl->pages + idx * (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    1823        30266 :         psrc = page + offset;
    1824        30266 :         npagebytes = Min(nbytes, XLOG_BLCKSZ - offset);
    1825              : 
    1826              :         /*
    1827              :          * Ensure that the data copy and the first verification step are not
    1828              :          * reordered.
    1829              :          */
    1830        30266 :         pg_read_barrier();
    1831              : 
    1832              :         /* data copy */
    1833        30266 :         memcpy(pdst, psrc, npagebytes);
    1834              : 
    1835              :         /*
    1836              :          * Ensure that the data copy and the second verification step are not
    1837              :          * reordered.
    1838              :          */
    1839        30266 :         pg_read_barrier();
    1840              : 
    1841              :         /*
    1842              :          * Second verification step: check that the page we read from wasn't
    1843              :          * evicted while we were copying the data.
    1844              :          */
    1845        30266 :         endptr = pg_atomic_read_u64(&XLogCtl->xlblocks[idx]);
    1846        30266 :         if (expectedEndPtr != endptr)
    1847            4 :             break;
    1848              : 
    1849        30262 :         pdst += npagebytes;
    1850        30262 :         recptr += npagebytes;
    1851        30262 :         nbytes -= npagebytes;
    1852              :     }
    1853              : 
    1854              :     Assert(pdst - dstbuf <= count);
    1855              : 
    1856       104482 :     return pdst - dstbuf;
    1857              : }
    1858              : 
    1859              : /*
    1860              :  * Converts a "usable byte position" to XLogRecPtr. A usable byte position
    1861              :  * is the position starting from the beginning of WAL, excluding all WAL
    1862              :  * page headers.
    1863              :  */
    1864              : static XLogRecPtr
    1865     36513802 : XLogBytePosToRecPtr(uint64 bytepos)
    1866              : {
    1867              :     uint64      fullsegs;
    1868              :     uint64      fullpages;
    1869              :     uint64      bytesleft;
    1870              :     uint32      seg_offset;
    1871              :     XLogRecPtr  result;
    1872              : 
    1873     36513802 :     fullsegs = bytepos / UsableBytesInSegment;
    1874     36513802 :     bytesleft = bytepos % UsableBytesInSegment;
    1875              : 
    1876     36513802 :     if (bytesleft < XLOG_BLCKSZ - SizeOfXLogLongPHD)
    1877              :     {
    1878              :         /* fits on first page of segment */
    1879        63565 :         seg_offset = bytesleft + SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
    1880              :     }
    1881              :     else
    1882              :     {
    1883              :         /* account for the first page on segment with long header */
    1884     36450237 :         seg_offset = XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    1885     36450237 :         bytesleft -= XLOG_BLCKSZ - SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
    1886              : 
    1887     36450237 :         fullpages = bytesleft / UsableBytesInPage;
    1888     36450237 :         bytesleft = bytesleft % UsableBytesInPage;
    1889              : 
    1890     36450237 :         seg_offset += fullpages * XLOG_BLCKSZ + bytesleft + SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
    1891              :     }
    1892              : 
    1893     36513802 :     XLogSegNoOffsetToRecPtr(fullsegs, seg_offset, wal_segment_size, result);
    1894              : 
    1895     36513802 :     return result;
    1896              : }
    1897              : 
    1898              : /*
    1899              :  * Like XLogBytePosToRecPtr, but if the position is at a page boundary,
    1900              :  * returns a pointer to the beginning of the page (ie. before page header),
    1901              :  * not to where the first xlog record on that page would go to. This is used
    1902              :  * when converting a pointer to the end of a record.
    1903              :  */
    1904              : static XLogRecPtr
    1905     18842400 : XLogBytePosToEndRecPtr(uint64 bytepos)
    1906              : {
    1907              :     uint64      fullsegs;
    1908              :     uint64      fullpages;
    1909              :     uint64      bytesleft;
    1910              :     uint32      seg_offset;
    1911              :     XLogRecPtr  result;
    1912              : 
    1913     18842400 :     fullsegs = bytepos / UsableBytesInSegment;
    1914     18842400 :     bytesleft = bytepos % UsableBytesInSegment;
    1915              : 
    1916     18842400 :     if (bytesleft < XLOG_BLCKSZ - SizeOfXLogLongPHD)
    1917              :     {
    1918              :         /* fits on first page of segment */
    1919       104444 :         if (bytesleft == 0)
    1920        71247 :             seg_offset = 0;
    1921              :         else
    1922        33197 :             seg_offset = bytesleft + SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
    1923              :     }
    1924              :     else
    1925              :     {
    1926              :         /* account for the first page on segment with long header */
    1927     18737956 :         seg_offset = XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    1928     18737956 :         bytesleft -= XLOG_BLCKSZ - SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
    1929              : 
    1930     18737956 :         fullpages = bytesleft / UsableBytesInPage;
    1931     18737956 :         bytesleft = bytesleft % UsableBytesInPage;
    1932              : 
    1933     18737956 :         if (bytesleft == 0)
    1934        18259 :             seg_offset += fullpages * XLOG_BLCKSZ + bytesleft;
    1935              :         else
    1936     18719697 :             seg_offset += fullpages * XLOG_BLCKSZ + bytesleft + SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
    1937              :     }
    1938              : 
    1939     18842400 :     XLogSegNoOffsetToRecPtr(fullsegs, seg_offset, wal_segment_size, result);
    1940              : 
    1941     18842400 :     return result;
    1942              : }
    1943              : 
    1944              : /*
    1945              :  * Convert an XLogRecPtr to a "usable byte position".
    1946              :  */
    1947              : static uint64
    1948         2690 : XLogRecPtrToBytePos(XLogRecPtr ptr)
    1949              : {
    1950              :     uint64      fullsegs;
    1951              :     uint32      fullpages;
    1952              :     uint32      offset;
    1953              :     uint64      result;
    1954              : 
    1955         2690 :     XLByteToSeg(ptr, fullsegs, wal_segment_size);
    1956              : 
    1957         2690 :     fullpages = (XLogSegmentOffset(ptr, wal_segment_size)) / XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    1958         2690 :     offset = ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    1959              : 
    1960         2690 :     if (fullpages == 0)
    1961              :     {
    1962         1048 :         result = fullsegs * UsableBytesInSegment;
    1963         1048 :         if (offset > 0)
    1964              :         {
    1965              :             Assert(offset >= SizeOfXLogLongPHD);
    1966          275 :             result += offset - SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
    1967              :         }
    1968              :     }
    1969              :     else
    1970              :     {
    1971         1642 :         result = fullsegs * UsableBytesInSegment +
    1972         1642 :             (XLOG_BLCKSZ - SizeOfXLogLongPHD) + /* account for first page */
    1973         1642 :             (fullpages - 1) * UsableBytesInPage;    /* full pages */
    1974         1642 :         if (offset > 0)
    1975              :         {
    1976              :             Assert(offset >= SizeOfXLogShortPHD);
    1977         1633 :             result += offset - SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
    1978              :         }
    1979              :     }
    1980              : 
    1981         2690 :     return result;
    1982              : }
    1983              : 
    1984              : /*
    1985              :  * Initialize XLOG buffers, writing out old buffers if they still contain
    1986              :  * unwritten data, upto the page containing 'upto'. Or if 'opportunistic' is
    1987              :  * true, initialize as many pages as we can without having to write out
    1988              :  * unwritten data. Any new pages are initialized to zeros, with pages headers
    1989              :  * initialized properly.
    1990              :  */
    1991              : static void
    1992      2597136 : AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(XLogRecPtr upto, TimeLineID tli, bool opportunistic)
    1993              : {
    1994              :     int         nextidx;
    1995              :     XLogRecPtr  OldPageRqstPtr;
    1996              :     XLogwrtRqst WriteRqst;
    1997      2597136 :     XLogRecPtr  NewPageEndPtr = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
    1998              :     XLogRecPtr  NewPageBeginPtr;
    1999              :     XLogPageHeader NewPage;
    2000      2597136 :     int         npages pg_attribute_unused() = 0;
    2001              : 
    2002      2597136 :     LWLockAcquire(WALBufMappingLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    2003              : 
    2004              :     /*
    2005              :      * Now that we have the lock, check if someone initialized the page
    2006              :      * already.
    2007              :      */
    2008      7526933 :     while (upto >= XLogCtl->InitializedUpTo || opportunistic)
    2009              :     {
    2010      4934272 :         nextidx = XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(XLogCtl->InitializedUpTo);
    2011              : 
    2012              :         /*
    2013              :          * Get ending-offset of the buffer page we need to replace (this may
    2014              :          * be zero if the buffer hasn't been used yet).  Fall through if it's
    2015              :          * already written out.
    2016              :          */
    2017      4934272 :         OldPageRqstPtr = pg_atomic_read_u64(&XLogCtl->xlblocks[nextidx]);
    2018      4934272 :         if (LogwrtResult.Write < OldPageRqstPtr)
    2019              :         {
    2020              :             /*
    2021              :              * Nope, got work to do. If we just want to pre-initialize as much
    2022              :              * as we can without flushing, give up now.
    2023              :              */
    2024      2275509 :             if (opportunistic)
    2025         4475 :                 break;
    2026              : 
    2027              :             /* Advance shared memory write request position */
    2028      2271034 :             SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    2029      2271034 :             if (XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write < OldPageRqstPtr)
    2030       697478 :                 XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write = OldPageRqstPtr;
    2031      2271034 :             SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    2032              : 
    2033              :             /*
    2034              :              * Acquire an up-to-date LogwrtResult value and see if we still
    2035              :              * need to write it or if someone else already did.
    2036              :              */
    2037      2271034 :             RefreshXLogWriteResult(LogwrtResult);
    2038      2271034 :             if (LogwrtResult.Write < OldPageRqstPtr)
    2039              :             {
    2040              :                 /*
    2041              :                  * Must acquire write lock. Release WALBufMappingLock first,
    2042              :                  * to make sure that all insertions that we need to wait for
    2043              :                  * can finish (up to this same position). Otherwise we risk
    2044              :                  * deadlock.
    2045              :                  */
    2046      2253473 :                 LWLockRelease(WALBufMappingLock);
    2047              : 
    2048      2253473 :                 WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(OldPageRqstPtr);
    2049              : 
    2050      2253473 :                 LWLockAcquire(WALWriteLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    2051              : 
    2052      2253473 :                 RefreshXLogWriteResult(LogwrtResult);
    2053      2253473 :                 if (LogwrtResult.Write >= OldPageRqstPtr)
    2054              :                 {
    2055              :                     /* OK, someone wrote it already */
    2056       141278 :                     LWLockRelease(WALWriteLock);
    2057              :                 }
    2058              :                 else
    2059              :                 {
    2060              :                     /* Have to write it ourselves */
    2061              :                     TRACE_POSTGRESQL_WAL_BUFFER_WRITE_DIRTY_START();
    2062      2112195 :                     WriteRqst.Write = OldPageRqstPtr;
    2063      2112195 :                     WriteRqst.Flush = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
    2064      2112195 :                     XLogWrite(WriteRqst, tli, false);
    2065      2112195 :                     LWLockRelease(WALWriteLock);
    2066      2112195 :                     pgWalUsage.wal_buffers_full++;
    2067              :                     TRACE_POSTGRESQL_WAL_BUFFER_WRITE_DIRTY_DONE();
    2068              : 
    2069              :                     /*
    2070              :                      * Required for the flush of pending stats WAL data, per
    2071              :                      * update of pgWalUsage.
    2072              :                      */
    2073      2112195 :                     pgstat_report_fixed = true;
    2074              :                 }
    2075              :                 /* Re-acquire WALBufMappingLock and retry */
    2076      2253473 :                 LWLockAcquire(WALBufMappingLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    2077      2253473 :                 continue;
    2078              :             }
    2079              :         }
    2080              : 
    2081              :         /*
    2082              :          * Now the next buffer slot is free and we can set it up to be the
    2083              :          * next output page.
    2084              :          */
    2085      2676324 :         NewPageBeginPtr = XLogCtl->InitializedUpTo;
    2086      2676324 :         NewPageEndPtr = NewPageBeginPtr + XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    2087              : 
    2088              :         Assert(XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(NewPageBeginPtr) == nextidx);
    2089              : 
    2090      2676324 :         NewPage = (XLogPageHeader) (XLogCtl->pages + nextidx * (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ);
    2091              : 
    2092              :         /*
    2093              :          * Mark the xlblock with InvalidXLogRecPtr and issue a write barrier
    2094              :          * before initializing. Otherwise, the old page may be partially
    2095              :          * zeroed but look valid.
    2096              :          */
    2097      2676324 :         pg_atomic_write_u64(&XLogCtl->xlblocks[nextidx], InvalidXLogRecPtr);
    2098      2676324 :         pg_write_barrier();
    2099              : 
    2100              :         /*
    2101              :          * Be sure to re-zero the buffer so that bytes beyond what we've
    2102              :          * written will look like zeroes and not valid XLOG records...
    2103              :          */
    2104      2676324 :         MemSet(NewPage, 0, XLOG_BLCKSZ);
    2105              : 
    2106              :         /*
    2107              :          * Fill the new page's header
    2108              :          */
    2109      2676324 :         NewPage->xlp_magic = XLOG_PAGE_MAGIC;
    2110              : 
    2111              :         /* NewPage->xlp_info = 0; */ /* done by memset */
    2112      2676324 :         NewPage->xlp_tli = tli;
    2113      2676324 :         NewPage->xlp_pageaddr = NewPageBeginPtr;
    2114              : 
    2115              :         /* NewPage->xlp_rem_len = 0; */  /* done by memset */
    2116              : 
    2117              :         /*
    2118              :          * If first page of an XLOG segment file, make it a long header.
    2119              :          */
    2120      2676324 :         if ((XLogSegmentOffset(NewPage->xlp_pageaddr, wal_segment_size)) == 0)
    2121              :         {
    2122         1866 :             XLogLongPageHeader NewLongPage = (XLogLongPageHeader) NewPage;
    2123              : 
    2124         1866 :             NewLongPage->xlp_sysid = ControlFile->system_identifier;
    2125         1866 :             NewLongPage->xlp_seg_size = wal_segment_size;
    2126         1866 :             NewLongPage->xlp_xlog_blcksz = XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    2127         1866 :             NewPage->xlp_info |= XLP_LONG_HEADER;
    2128              :         }
    2129              : 
    2130              :         /*
    2131              :          * Make sure the initialization of the page becomes visible to others
    2132              :          * before the xlblocks update. GetXLogBuffer() reads xlblocks without
    2133              :          * holding a lock.
    2134              :          */
    2135      2676324 :         pg_write_barrier();
    2136              : 
    2137      2676324 :         pg_atomic_write_u64(&XLogCtl->xlblocks[nextidx], NewPageEndPtr);
    2138      2676324 :         XLogCtl->InitializedUpTo = NewPageEndPtr;
    2139              : 
    2140      2676324 :         npages++;
    2141              :     }
    2142      2597136 :     LWLockRelease(WALBufMappingLock);
    2143              : 
    2144              : #ifdef WAL_DEBUG
    2145              :     if (XLOG_DEBUG && npages > 0)
    2146              :     {
    2147              :         elog(DEBUG1, "initialized %d pages, up to %X/%08X",
    2148              :              npages, LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(NewPageEndPtr));
    2149              :     }
    2150              : #endif
    2151      2597136 : }
    2152              : 
    2153              : /*
    2154              :  * Calculate CheckPointSegments based on max_wal_size_mb and
    2155              :  * checkpoint_completion_target.
    2156              :  */
    2157              : static void
    2158         9507 : CalculateCheckpointSegments(void)
    2159              : {
    2160              :     double      target;
    2161              : 
    2162              :     /*-------
    2163              :      * Calculate the distance at which to trigger a checkpoint, to avoid
    2164              :      * exceeding max_wal_size_mb. This is based on two assumptions:
    2165              :      *
    2166              :      * a) we keep WAL for only one checkpoint cycle (prior to PG11 we kept
    2167              :      *    WAL for two checkpoint cycles to allow us to recover from the
    2168              :      *    secondary checkpoint if the first checkpoint failed, though we
    2169              :      *    only did this on the primary anyway, not on standby. Keeping just
    2170              :      *    one checkpoint simplifies processing and reduces disk space in
    2171              :      *    many smaller databases.)
    2172              :      * b) during checkpoint, we consume checkpoint_completion_target *
    2173              :      *    number of segments consumed between checkpoints.
    2174              :      *-------
    2175              :      */
    2176         9507 :     target = (double) ConvertToXSegs(max_wal_size_mb, wal_segment_size) /
    2177         9507 :         (1.0 + CheckPointCompletionTarget);
    2178              : 
    2179              :     /* round down */
    2180         9507 :     CheckPointSegments = (int) target;
    2181              : 
    2182         9507 :     if (CheckPointSegments < 1)
    2183           10 :         CheckPointSegments = 1;
    2184         9507 : }
    2185              : 
    2186              : void
    2187         7191 : assign_max_wal_size(int newval, void *extra)
    2188              : {
    2189         7191 :     max_wal_size_mb = newval;
    2190         7191 :     CalculateCheckpointSegments();
    2191         7191 : }
    2192              : 
    2193              : void
    2194         1222 : assign_checkpoint_completion_target(double newval, void *extra)
    2195              : {
    2196         1222 :     CheckPointCompletionTarget = newval;
    2197         1222 :     CalculateCheckpointSegments();
    2198         1222 : }
    2199              : 
    2200              : bool
    2201         2368 : check_wal_segment_size(int *newval, void **extra, GucSource source)
    2202              : {
    2203         2368 :     if (!IsValidWalSegSize(*newval))
    2204              :     {
    2205            0 :         GUC_check_errdetail("The WAL segment size must be a power of two between 1 MB and 1 GB.");
    2206            0 :         return false;
    2207              :     }
    2208              : 
    2209         2368 :     return true;
    2210              : }
    2211              : 
    2212              : /*
    2213              :  * At a checkpoint, how many WAL segments to recycle as preallocated future
    2214              :  * XLOG segments? Returns the highest segment that should be preallocated.
    2215              :  */
    2216              : static XLogSegNo
    2217         1835 : XLOGfileslop(XLogRecPtr lastredoptr)
    2218              : {
    2219              :     XLogSegNo   minSegNo;
    2220              :     XLogSegNo   maxSegNo;
    2221              :     double      distance;
    2222              :     XLogSegNo   recycleSegNo;
    2223              : 
    2224              :     /*
    2225              :      * Calculate the segment numbers that min_wal_size_mb and max_wal_size_mb
    2226              :      * correspond to. Always recycle enough segments to meet the minimum, and
    2227              :      * remove enough segments to stay below the maximum.
    2228              :      */
    2229         1835 :     minSegNo = lastredoptr / wal_segment_size +
    2230         1835 :         ConvertToXSegs(min_wal_size_mb, wal_segment_size) - 1;
    2231         1835 :     maxSegNo = lastredoptr / wal_segment_size +
    2232         1835 :         ConvertToXSegs(max_wal_size_mb, wal_segment_size) - 1;
    2233              : 
    2234              :     /*
    2235              :      * Between those limits, recycle enough segments to get us through to the
    2236              :      * estimated end of next checkpoint.
    2237              :      *
    2238              :      * To estimate where the next checkpoint will finish, assume that the
    2239              :      * system runs steadily consuming CheckPointDistanceEstimate bytes between
    2240              :      * every checkpoint.
    2241              :      */
    2242         1835 :     distance = (1.0 + CheckPointCompletionTarget) * CheckPointDistanceEstimate;
    2243              :     /* add 10% for good measure. */
    2244         1835 :     distance *= 1.10;
    2245              : 
    2246         1835 :     recycleSegNo = (XLogSegNo) ceil(((double) lastredoptr + distance) /
    2247              :                                     wal_segment_size);
    2248              : 
    2249         1835 :     if (recycleSegNo < minSegNo)
    2250         1301 :         recycleSegNo = minSegNo;
    2251         1835 :     if (recycleSegNo > maxSegNo)
    2252          407 :         recycleSegNo = maxSegNo;
    2253              : 
    2254         1835 :     return recycleSegNo;
    2255              : }
    2256              : 
    2257              : /*
    2258              :  * Check whether we've consumed enough xlog space that a checkpoint is needed.
    2259              :  *
    2260              :  * new_segno indicates a log file that has just been filled up (or read
    2261              :  * during recovery). We measure the distance from RedoRecPtr to new_segno
    2262              :  * and see if that exceeds CheckPointSegments.
    2263              :  *
    2264              :  * Note: it is caller's responsibility that RedoRecPtr is up-to-date.
    2265              :  */
    2266              : bool
    2267         5002 : XLogCheckpointNeeded(XLogSegNo new_segno)
    2268              : {
    2269              :     XLogSegNo   old_segno;
    2270              : 
    2271         5002 :     XLByteToSeg(RedoRecPtr, old_segno, wal_segment_size);
    2272              : 
    2273         5002 :     if (new_segno >= old_segno + (uint64) (CheckPointSegments - 1))
    2274         3135 :         return true;
    2275         1867 :     return false;
    2276              : }
    2277              : 
    2278              : /*
    2279              :  * Write and/or fsync the log at least as far as WriteRqst indicates.
    2280              :  *
    2281              :  * If flexible == true, we don't have to write as far as WriteRqst, but
    2282              :  * may stop at any convenient boundary (such as a cache or logfile boundary).
    2283              :  * This option allows us to avoid uselessly issuing multiple writes when a
    2284              :  * single one would do.
    2285              :  *
    2286              :  * Must be called with WALWriteLock held. WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(WriteRqst)
    2287              :  * must be called before grabbing the lock, to make sure the data is ready to
    2288              :  * write.
    2289              :  */
    2290              : static void
    2291      2269864 : XLogWrite(XLogwrtRqst WriteRqst, TimeLineID tli, bool flexible)
    2292              : {
    2293              :     bool        ispartialpage;
    2294              :     bool        last_iteration;
    2295              :     bool        finishing_seg;
    2296              :     int         curridx;
    2297              :     int         npages;
    2298              :     int         startidx;
    2299              :     uint32      startoffset;
    2300              : 
    2301              :     /* We should always be inside a critical section here */
    2302              :     Assert(CritSectionCount > 0);
    2303              : 
    2304              :     /*
    2305              :      * Update local LogwrtResult (caller probably did this already, but...)
    2306              :      */
    2307      2269864 :     RefreshXLogWriteResult(LogwrtResult);
    2308              : 
    2309              :     /*
    2310              :      * Since successive pages in the xlog cache are consecutively allocated,
    2311              :      * we can usually gather multiple pages together and issue just one
    2312              :      * write() call.  npages is the number of pages we have determined can be
    2313              :      * written together; startidx is the cache block index of the first one,
    2314              :      * and startoffset is the file offset at which it should go. The latter
    2315              :      * two variables are only valid when npages > 0, but we must initialize
    2316              :      * all of them to keep the compiler quiet.
    2317              :      */
    2318      2269864 :     npages = 0;
    2319      2269864 :     startidx = 0;
    2320      2269864 :     startoffset = 0;
    2321              : 
    2322              :     /*
    2323              :      * Within the loop, curridx is the cache block index of the page to
    2324              :      * consider writing.  Begin at the buffer containing the next unwritten
    2325              :      * page, or last partially written page.
    2326              :      */
    2327      2269864 :     curridx = XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(LogwrtResult.Write);
    2328              : 
    2329      4915327 :     while (LogwrtResult.Write < WriteRqst.Write)
    2330              :     {
    2331              :         /*
    2332              :          * Make sure we're not ahead of the insert process.  This could happen
    2333              :          * if we're passed a bogus WriteRqst.Write that is past the end of the
    2334              :          * last page that's been initialized by AdvanceXLInsertBuffer.
    2335              :          */
    2336      2798669 :         XLogRecPtr  EndPtr = pg_atomic_read_u64(&XLogCtl->xlblocks[curridx]);
    2337              : 
    2338      2798669 :         if (LogwrtResult.Write >= EndPtr)
    2339            0 :             elog(PANIC, "xlog write request %X/%08X is past end of log %X/%08X",
    2340              :                  LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(LogwrtResult.Write),
    2341              :                  LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(EndPtr));
    2342              : 
    2343              :         /* Advance LogwrtResult.Write to end of current buffer page */
    2344      2798669 :         LogwrtResult.Write = EndPtr;
    2345      2798669 :         ispartialpage = WriteRqst.Write < LogwrtResult.Write;
    2346              : 
    2347      2798669 :         if (!XLByteInPrevSeg(LogwrtResult.Write, openLogSegNo,
    2348              :                              wal_segment_size))
    2349              :         {
    2350              :             /*
    2351              :              * Switch to new logfile segment.  We cannot have any pending
    2352              :              * pages here (since we dump what we have at segment end).
    2353              :              */
    2354              :             Assert(npages == 0);
    2355        14695 :             if (openLogFile >= 0)
    2356         6603 :                 XLogFileClose();
    2357        14695 :             XLByteToPrevSeg(LogwrtResult.Write, openLogSegNo,
    2358              :                             wal_segment_size);
    2359        14695 :             openLogTLI = tli;
    2360              : 
    2361              :             /* create/use new log file */
    2362        14695 :             openLogFile = XLogFileInit(openLogSegNo, tli);
    2363        14695 :             ReserveExternalFD();
    2364              :         }
    2365              : 
    2366              :         /* Make sure we have the current logfile open */
    2367      2798669 :         if (openLogFile < 0)
    2368              :         {
    2369            0 :             XLByteToPrevSeg(LogwrtResult.Write, openLogSegNo,
    2370              :                             wal_segment_size);
    2371            0 :             openLogTLI = tli;
    2372            0 :             openLogFile = XLogFileOpen(openLogSegNo, tli);
    2373            0 :             ReserveExternalFD();
    2374              :         }
    2375              : 
    2376              :         /* Add current page to the set of pending pages-to-dump */
    2377      2798669 :         if (npages == 0)
    2378              :         {
    2379              :             /* first of group */
    2380      2284928 :             startidx = curridx;
    2381      2284928 :             startoffset = XLogSegmentOffset(LogwrtResult.Write - XLOG_BLCKSZ,
    2382              :                                             wal_segment_size);
    2383              :         }
    2384      2798669 :         npages++;
    2385              : 
    2386              :         /*
    2387              :          * Dump the set if this will be the last loop iteration, or if we are
    2388              :          * at the last page of the cache area (since the next page won't be
    2389              :          * contiguous in memory), or if we are at the end of the logfile
    2390              :          * segment.
    2391              :          */
    2392      2798669 :         last_iteration = WriteRqst.Write <= LogwrtResult.Write;
    2393              : 
    2394      5447647 :         finishing_seg = !ispartialpage &&
    2395      2648978 :             (startoffset + npages * XLOG_BLCKSZ) >= wal_segment_size;
    2396              : 
    2397      2798669 :         if (last_iteration ||
    2398       530141 :             curridx == XLogCtl->XLogCacheBlck ||
    2399              :             finishing_seg)
    2400              :         {
    2401              :             char       *from;
    2402              :             Size        nbytes;
    2403              :             Size        nleft;
    2404              :             ssize_t     written;
    2405              :             instr_time  start;
    2406              : 
    2407              :             /* OK to write the page(s) */
    2408      2284928 :             from = XLogCtl->pages + startidx * (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    2409      2284928 :             nbytes = npages * (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    2410      2284928 :             nleft = nbytes;
    2411              :             do
    2412              :             {
    2413      2284928 :                 errno = 0;
    2414              : 
    2415              :                 /*
    2416              :                  * Measure I/O timing to write WAL data, for pg_stat_io.
    2417              :                  */
    2418      2284928 :                 start = pgstat_prepare_io_time(track_wal_io_timing);
    2419              : 
    2420      2284928 :                 pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_WRITE);
    2421      2284928 :                 written = pg_pwrite(openLogFile, from, nleft, startoffset);
    2422      2284928 :                 pgstat_report_wait_end();
    2423              : 
    2424      2284928 :                 pgstat_count_io_op_time(IOOBJECT_WAL, IOCONTEXT_NORMAL,
    2425              :                                         IOOP_WRITE, start, 1, written);
    2426              : 
    2427      2284928 :                 if (written <= 0)
    2428              :                 {
    2429              :                     char        xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
    2430              :                     int         save_errno;
    2431              : 
    2432            0 :                     if (errno == EINTR)
    2433            0 :                         continue;
    2434              : 
    2435            0 :                     save_errno = errno;
    2436            0 :                     XLogFileName(xlogfname, tli, openLogSegNo,
    2437              :                                  wal_segment_size);
    2438            0 :                     errno = save_errno;
    2439            0 :                     ereport(PANIC,
    2440              :                             (errcode_for_file_access(),
    2441              :                              errmsg("could not write to log file \"%s\" at offset %u, length %zu: %m",
    2442              :                                     xlogfname, startoffset, nleft)));
    2443              :                 }
    2444      2284928 :                 nleft -= written;
    2445      2284928 :                 from += written;
    2446      2284928 :                 startoffset += written;
    2447      2284928 :             } while (nleft > 0);
    2448              : 
    2449      2284928 :             npages = 0;
    2450              : 
    2451              :             /*
    2452              :              * If we just wrote the whole last page of a logfile segment,
    2453              :              * fsync the segment immediately.  This avoids having to go back
    2454              :              * and re-open prior segments when an fsync request comes along
    2455              :              * later. Doing it here ensures that one and only one backend will
    2456              :              * perform this fsync.
    2457              :              *
    2458              :              * This is also the right place to notify the Archiver that the
    2459              :              * segment is ready to copy to archival storage, and to update the
    2460              :              * timer for archive_timeout, and to signal for a checkpoint if
    2461              :              * too many logfile segments have been used since the last
    2462              :              * checkpoint.
    2463              :              */
    2464      2284928 :             if (finishing_seg)
    2465              :             {
    2466         1993 :                 issue_xlog_fsync(openLogFile, openLogSegNo, tli);
    2467              : 
    2468              :                 /* signal that we need to wakeup walsenders later */
    2469         1993 :                 WalSndWakeupRequest();
    2470              : 
    2471         1993 :                 LogwrtResult.Flush = LogwrtResult.Write;    /* end of page */
    2472              : 
    2473         1993 :                 if (XLogArchivingActive())
    2474          412 :                     XLogArchiveNotifySeg(openLogSegNo, tli);
    2475              : 
    2476         1993 :                 XLogCtl->lastSegSwitchTime = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
    2477         1993 :                 XLogCtl->lastSegSwitchLSN = LogwrtResult.Flush;
    2478              : 
    2479              :                 /*
    2480              :                  * Request a checkpoint if we've consumed too much xlog since
    2481              :                  * the last one.  For speed, we first check using the local
    2482              :                  * copy of RedoRecPtr, which might be out of date; if it looks
    2483              :                  * like a checkpoint is needed, forcibly update RedoRecPtr and
    2484              :                  * recheck.
    2485              :                  */
    2486         1993 :                 if (IsUnderPostmaster && XLogCheckpointNeeded(openLogSegNo))
    2487              :                 {
    2488          269 :                     (void) GetRedoRecPtr();
    2489          269 :                     if (XLogCheckpointNeeded(openLogSegNo))
    2490          215 :                         RequestCheckpoint(CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_XLOG);
    2491              :                 }
    2492              :             }
    2493              :         }
    2494              : 
    2495      2798669 :         if (ispartialpage)
    2496              :         {
    2497              :             /* Only asked to write a partial page */
    2498       149691 :             LogwrtResult.Write = WriteRqst.Write;
    2499       149691 :             break;
    2500              :         }
    2501      2648978 :         curridx = NextBufIdx(curridx);
    2502              : 
    2503              :         /* If flexible, break out of loop as soon as we wrote something */
    2504      2648978 :         if (flexible && npages == 0)
    2505         3515 :             break;
    2506              :     }
    2507              : 
    2508              :     Assert(npages == 0);
    2509              : 
    2510              :     /*
    2511              :      * If asked to flush, do so
    2512              :      */
    2513      2269864 :     if (LogwrtResult.Flush < WriteRqst.Flush &&
    2514       156887 :         LogwrtResult.Flush < LogwrtResult.Write)
    2515              :     {
    2516              :         /*
    2517              :          * Could get here without iterating above loop, in which case we might
    2518              :          * have no open file or the wrong one.  However, we do not need to
    2519              :          * fsync more than one file.
    2520              :          */
    2521       156811 :         if (wal_sync_method != WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN &&
    2522       156811 :             wal_sync_method != WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN_DSYNC)
    2523              :         {
    2524       156811 :             if (openLogFile >= 0 &&
    2525       156800 :                 !XLByteInPrevSeg(LogwrtResult.Write, openLogSegNo,
    2526              :                                  wal_segment_size))
    2527           86 :                 XLogFileClose();
    2528       156811 :             if (openLogFile < 0)
    2529              :             {
    2530           97 :                 XLByteToPrevSeg(LogwrtResult.Write, openLogSegNo,
    2531              :                                 wal_segment_size);
    2532           97 :                 openLogTLI = tli;
    2533           97 :                 openLogFile = XLogFileOpen(openLogSegNo, tli);
    2534           97 :                 ReserveExternalFD();
    2535              :             }
    2536              : 
    2537       156811 :             issue_xlog_fsync(openLogFile, openLogSegNo, tli);
    2538              :         }
    2539              : 
    2540              :         /* signal that we need to wakeup walsenders later */
    2541       156811 :         WalSndWakeupRequest();
    2542              : 
    2543       156811 :         LogwrtResult.Flush = LogwrtResult.Write;
    2544              :     }
    2545              : 
    2546              :     /*
    2547              :      * Update shared-memory status
    2548              :      *
    2549              :      * We make sure that the shared 'request' values do not fall behind the
    2550              :      * 'result' values.  This is not absolutely essential, but it saves some
    2551              :      * code in a couple of places.
    2552              :      */
    2553      2269864 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    2554      2269864 :     if (XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write < LogwrtResult.Write)
    2555       140043 :         XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write = LogwrtResult.Write;
    2556      2269864 :     if (XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Flush < LogwrtResult.Flush)
    2557       158386 :         XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Flush = LogwrtResult.Flush;
    2558      2269864 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    2559              : 
    2560              :     /*
    2561              :      * We write Write first, bar, then Flush.  When reading, the opposite must
    2562              :      * be done (with a matching barrier in between), so that we always see a
    2563              :      * Flush value that trails behind the Write value seen.
    2564              :      */
    2565      2269864 :     pg_atomic_write_u64(&XLogCtl->logWriteResult, LogwrtResult.Write);
    2566      2269864 :     pg_write_barrier();
    2567      2269864 :     pg_atomic_write_u64(&XLogCtl->logFlushResult, LogwrtResult.Flush);
    2568              : 
    2569              : #ifdef USE_ASSERT_CHECKING
    2570              :     {
    2571              :         XLogRecPtr  Flush;
    2572              :         XLogRecPtr  Write;
    2573              :         XLogRecPtr  Insert;
    2574              : 
    2575              :         Flush = pg_atomic_read_u64(&XLogCtl->logFlushResult);
    2576              :         pg_read_barrier();
    2577              :         Write = pg_atomic_read_u64(&XLogCtl->logWriteResult);
    2578              :         pg_read_barrier();
    2579              :         Insert = pg_atomic_read_u64(&XLogCtl->logInsertResult);
    2580              : 
    2581              :         /* WAL written to disk is always ahead of WAL flushed */
    2582              :         Assert(Write >= Flush);
    2583              : 
    2584              :         /* WAL inserted to buffers is always ahead of WAL written */
    2585              :         Assert(Insert >= Write);
    2586              :     }
    2587              : #endif
    2588      2269864 : }
    2589              : 
    2590              : /*
    2591              :  * Record the LSN for an asynchronous transaction commit/abort
    2592              :  * and nudge the WALWriter if there is work for it to do.
    2593              :  * (This should not be called for synchronous commits.)
    2594              :  */
    2595              : void
    2596        55858 : XLogSetAsyncXactLSN(XLogRecPtr asyncXactLSN)
    2597              : {
    2598        55858 :     XLogRecPtr  WriteRqstPtr = asyncXactLSN;
    2599              :     bool        sleeping;
    2600        55858 :     bool        wakeup = false;
    2601              :     XLogRecPtr  prevAsyncXactLSN;
    2602              : 
    2603        55858 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    2604        55858 :     sleeping = XLogCtl->WalWriterSleeping;
    2605        55858 :     prevAsyncXactLSN = XLogCtl->asyncXactLSN;
    2606        55858 :     if (XLogCtl->asyncXactLSN < asyncXactLSN)
    2607        55339 :         XLogCtl->asyncXactLSN = asyncXactLSN;
    2608        55858 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    2609              : 
    2610              :     /*
    2611              :      * If somebody else already called this function with a more aggressive
    2612              :      * LSN, they will have done what we needed (and perhaps more).
    2613              :      */
    2614        55858 :     if (asyncXactLSN <= prevAsyncXactLSN)
    2615          519 :         return;
    2616              : 
    2617              :     /*
    2618              :      * If the WALWriter is sleeping, kick it to make it come out of low-power
    2619              :      * mode, so that this async commit will reach disk within the expected
    2620              :      * amount of time.  Otherwise, determine whether it has enough WAL
    2621              :      * available to flush, the same way that XLogBackgroundFlush() does.
    2622              :      */
    2623        55339 :     if (sleeping)
    2624           58 :         wakeup = true;
    2625              :     else
    2626              :     {
    2627              :         int         flushblocks;
    2628              : 
    2629        55281 :         RefreshXLogWriteResult(LogwrtResult);
    2630              : 
    2631        55281 :         flushblocks =
    2632        55281 :             WriteRqstPtr / XLOG_BLCKSZ - LogwrtResult.Flush / XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    2633              : 
    2634        55281 :         if (WalWriterFlushAfter == 0 || flushblocks >= WalWriterFlushAfter)
    2635         4615 :             wakeup = true;
    2636              :     }
    2637              : 
    2638        55339 :     if (wakeup)
    2639              :     {
    2640         4673 :         volatile PROC_HDR *procglobal = ProcGlobal;
    2641         4673 :         ProcNumber  walwriterProc = procglobal->walwriterProc;
    2642              : 
    2643         4673 :         if (walwriterProc != INVALID_PROC_NUMBER)
    2644          330 :             SetLatch(&GetPGProcByNumber(walwriterProc)->procLatch);
    2645              :     }
    2646              : }
    2647              : 
    2648              : /*
    2649              :  * Record the LSN up to which we can remove WAL because it's not required by
    2650              :  * any replication slot.
    2651              :  */
    2652              : void
    2653        43558 : XLogSetReplicationSlotMinimumLSN(XLogRecPtr lsn)
    2654              : {
    2655        43558 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    2656        43558 :     XLogCtl->replicationSlotMinLSN = lsn;
    2657        43558 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    2658        43558 : }
    2659              : 
    2660              : 
    2661              : /*
    2662              :  * Return the oldest LSN we must retain to satisfy the needs of some
    2663              :  * replication slot.
    2664              :  */
    2665              : XLogRecPtr
    2666         2460 : XLogGetReplicationSlotMinimumLSN(void)
    2667              : {
    2668              :     XLogRecPtr  retval;
    2669              : 
    2670         2460 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    2671         2460 :     retval = XLogCtl->replicationSlotMinLSN;
    2672         2460 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    2673              : 
    2674         2460 :     return retval;
    2675              : }
    2676              : 
    2677              : /*
    2678              :  * Advance minRecoveryPoint in control file.
    2679              :  *
    2680              :  * If we crash during recovery, we must reach this point again before the
    2681              :  * database is consistent.
    2682              :  *
    2683              :  * If 'force' is true, 'lsn' argument is ignored. Otherwise, minRecoveryPoint
    2684              :  * is only updated if it's not already greater than or equal to 'lsn'.
    2685              :  */
    2686              : static void
    2687       112979 : UpdateMinRecoveryPoint(XLogRecPtr lsn, bool force)
    2688              : {
    2689              :     /* Quick check using our local copy of the variable */
    2690       112979 :     if (!updateMinRecoveryPoint || (!force && lsn <= LocalMinRecoveryPoint))
    2691       105815 :         return;
    2692              : 
    2693              :     /*
    2694              :      * An invalid minRecoveryPoint means that we need to recover all the WAL,
    2695              :      * i.e., we're doing crash recovery.  We never modify the control file's
    2696              :      * value in that case, so we can short-circuit future checks here too. The
    2697              :      * local values of minRecoveryPoint and minRecoveryPointTLI should not be
    2698              :      * updated until crash recovery finishes.  We only do this for the startup
    2699              :      * process as it should not update its own reference of minRecoveryPoint
    2700              :      * until it has finished crash recovery to make sure that all WAL
    2701              :      * available is replayed in this case.  This also saves from extra locks
    2702              :      * taken on the control file from the startup process.
    2703              :      */
    2704         7164 :     if (!XLogRecPtrIsValid(LocalMinRecoveryPoint) && InRecovery)
    2705              :     {
    2706           31 :         updateMinRecoveryPoint = false;
    2707           31 :         return;
    2708              :     }
    2709              : 
    2710         7133 :     LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    2711              : 
    2712              :     /* update local copy */
    2713         7133 :     LocalMinRecoveryPoint = ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint;
    2714         7133 :     LocalMinRecoveryPointTLI = ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI;
    2715              : 
    2716         7133 :     if (!XLogRecPtrIsValid(LocalMinRecoveryPoint))
    2717            3 :         updateMinRecoveryPoint = false;
    2718         7130 :     else if (force || LocalMinRecoveryPoint < lsn)
    2719              :     {
    2720              :         XLogRecPtr  newMinRecoveryPoint;
    2721              :         TimeLineID  newMinRecoveryPointTLI;
    2722              : 
    2723              :         /*
    2724              :          * To avoid having to update the control file too often, we update it
    2725              :          * all the way to the last record being replayed, even though 'lsn'
    2726              :          * would suffice for correctness.  This also allows the 'force' case
    2727              :          * to not need a valid 'lsn' value.
    2728              :          *
    2729              :          * Another important reason for doing it this way is that the passed
    2730              :          * 'lsn' value could be bogus, i.e., past the end of available WAL, if
    2731              :          * the caller got it from a corrupted heap page.  Accepting such a
    2732              :          * value as the min recovery point would prevent us from coming up at
    2733              :          * all.  Instead, we just log a warning and continue with recovery.
    2734              :          * (See also the comments about corrupt LSNs in XLogFlush.)
    2735              :          */
    2736         5722 :         newMinRecoveryPoint = GetCurrentReplayRecPtr(&newMinRecoveryPointTLI);
    2737         5722 :         if (!force && newMinRecoveryPoint < lsn)
    2738            0 :             elog(WARNING,
    2739              :                  "xlog min recovery request %X/%08X is past current point %X/%08X",
    2740              :                  LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(lsn), LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(newMinRecoveryPoint));
    2741              : 
    2742              :         /* update control file */
    2743         5722 :         if (ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint < newMinRecoveryPoint)
    2744              :         {
    2745         5369 :             ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = newMinRecoveryPoint;
    2746         5369 :             ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = newMinRecoveryPointTLI;
    2747         5369 :             UpdateControlFile();
    2748         5369 :             LocalMinRecoveryPoint = newMinRecoveryPoint;
    2749         5369 :             LocalMinRecoveryPointTLI = newMinRecoveryPointTLI;
    2750              : 
    2751         5369 :             ereport(DEBUG2,
    2752              :                     errmsg_internal("updated min recovery point to %X/%08X on timeline %u",
    2753              :                                     LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(newMinRecoveryPoint),
    2754              :                                     newMinRecoveryPointTLI));
    2755              :         }
    2756              :     }
    2757         7133 :     LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    2758              : }
    2759              : 
    2760              : /*
    2761              :  * Ensure that all XLOG data through the given position is flushed to disk.
    2762              :  *
    2763              :  * NOTE: this differs from XLogWrite mainly in that the WALWriteLock is not
    2764              :  * already held, and we try to avoid acquiring it if possible.
    2765              :  */
    2766              : void
    2767       762321 : XLogFlush(XLogRecPtr record)
    2768              : {
    2769              :     XLogRecPtr  WriteRqstPtr;
    2770              :     XLogwrtRqst WriteRqst;
    2771       762321 :     TimeLineID  insertTLI = XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
    2772              : 
    2773              :     /*
    2774              :      * During REDO, we are reading not writing WAL.  Therefore, instead of
    2775              :      * trying to flush the WAL, we should update minRecoveryPoint instead. We
    2776              :      * test XLogInsertAllowed(), not InRecovery, because we need checkpointer
    2777              :      * to act this way too, and because when it tries to write the
    2778              :      * end-of-recovery checkpoint, it should indeed flush.
    2779              :      */
    2780       762321 :     if (!XLogInsertAllowed())
    2781              :     {
    2782       112514 :         UpdateMinRecoveryPoint(record, false);
    2783       593977 :         return;
    2784              :     }
    2785              : 
    2786              :     /* Quick exit if already known flushed */
    2787       649807 :     if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
    2788       481463 :         return;
    2789              : 
    2790              : #ifdef WAL_DEBUG
    2791              :     if (XLOG_DEBUG)
    2792              :         elog(LOG, "xlog flush request %X/%08X; write %X/%08X; flush %X/%08X",
    2793              :              LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(record),
    2794              :              LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(LogwrtResult.Write),
    2795              :              LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(LogwrtResult.Flush));
    2796              : #endif
    2797              : 
    2798       168344 :     START_CRIT_SECTION();
    2799              : 
    2800              :     /*
    2801              :      * Since fsync is usually a horribly expensive operation, we try to
    2802              :      * piggyback as much data as we can on each fsync: if we see any more data
    2803              :      * entered into the xlog buffer, we'll write and fsync that too, so that
    2804              :      * the final value of LogwrtResult.Flush is as large as possible. This
    2805              :      * gives us some chance of avoiding another fsync immediately after.
    2806              :      */
    2807              : 
    2808              :     /* initialize to given target; may increase below */
    2809       168344 :     WriteRqstPtr = record;
    2810              : 
    2811              :     /*
    2812              :      * Now wait until we get the write lock, or someone else does the flush
    2813              :      * for us.
    2814              :      */
    2815              :     for (;;)
    2816         3324 :     {
    2817              :         XLogRecPtr  insertpos;
    2818              : 
    2819              :         /* done already? */
    2820       171668 :         RefreshXLogWriteResult(LogwrtResult);
    2821       171668 :         if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
    2822        12809 :             break;
    2823              : 
    2824              :         /*
    2825              :          * Before actually performing the write, wait for all in-flight
    2826              :          * insertions to the pages we're about to write to finish.
    2827              :          */
    2828       158859 :         SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    2829       158859 :         if (WriteRqstPtr < XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write)
    2830         8923 :             WriteRqstPtr = XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write;
    2831       158859 :         SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    2832       158859 :         insertpos = WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(WriteRqstPtr);
    2833              : 
    2834              :         /*
    2835              :          * Try to get the write lock. If we can't get it immediately, wait
    2836              :          * until it's released, and recheck if we still need to do the flush
    2837              :          * or if the backend that held the lock did it for us already. This
    2838              :          * helps to maintain a good rate of group committing when the system
    2839              :          * is bottlenecked by the speed of fsyncing.
    2840              :          */
    2841       158859 :         if (!LWLockAcquireOrWait(WALWriteLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE))
    2842              :         {
    2843              :             /*
    2844              :              * The lock is now free, but we didn't acquire it yet. Before we
    2845              :              * do, loop back to check if someone else flushed the record for
    2846              :              * us already.
    2847              :              */
    2848         3324 :             continue;
    2849              :         }
    2850              : 
    2851              :         /* Got the lock; recheck whether request is satisfied */
    2852       155535 :         RefreshXLogWriteResult(LogwrtResult);
    2853       155535 :         if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
    2854              :         {
    2855         2259 :             LWLockRelease(WALWriteLock);
    2856         2259 :             break;
    2857              :         }
    2858              : 
    2859              :         /*
    2860              :          * Sleep before flush! By adding a delay here, we may give further
    2861              :          * backends the opportunity to join the backlog of group commit
    2862              :          * followers; this can significantly improve transaction throughput,
    2863              :          * at the risk of increasing transaction latency.
    2864              :          *
    2865              :          * We do not sleep if enableFsync is not turned on, nor if there are
    2866              :          * fewer than CommitSiblings other backends with active transactions.
    2867              :          */
    2868       153276 :         if (CommitDelay > 0 && enableFsync &&
    2869            0 :             MinimumActiveBackends(CommitSiblings))
    2870              :         {
    2871            0 :             pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_COMMIT_DELAY);
    2872            0 :             pg_usleep(CommitDelay);
    2873            0 :             pgstat_report_wait_end();
    2874              : 
    2875              :             /*
    2876              :              * Re-check how far we can now flush the WAL. It's generally not
    2877              :              * safe to call WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish while holding
    2878              :              * WALWriteLock, because an in-progress insertion might need to
    2879              :              * also grab WALWriteLock to make progress. But we know that all
    2880              :              * the insertions up to insertpos have already finished, because
    2881              :              * that's what the earlier WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish() returned.
    2882              :              * We're only calling it again to allow insertpos to be moved
    2883              :              * further forward, not to actually wait for anyone.
    2884              :              */
    2885            0 :             insertpos = WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(insertpos);
    2886              :         }
    2887              : 
    2888              :         /* try to write/flush later additions to XLOG as well */
    2889       153276 :         WriteRqst.Write = insertpos;
    2890       153276 :         WriteRqst.Flush = insertpos;
    2891              : 
    2892       153276 :         XLogWrite(WriteRqst, insertTLI, false);
    2893              : 
    2894       153276 :         LWLockRelease(WALWriteLock);
    2895              :         /* done */
    2896       153276 :         break;
    2897              :     }
    2898              : 
    2899       168344 :     END_CRIT_SECTION();
    2900              : 
    2901              :     /* wake up walsenders now that we've released heavily contended locks */
    2902       168344 :     WalSndWakeupProcessRequests(true, !RecoveryInProgress());
    2903              : 
    2904              :     /*
    2905              :      * If we flushed an LSN that someone was waiting for, notify the waiters.
    2906              :      */
    2907       336688 :     if (waitLSNState &&
    2908       168344 :         (LogwrtResult.Flush >=
    2909       168344 :          pg_atomic_read_u64(&waitLSNState->minWaitedLSN[WAIT_LSN_TYPE_PRIMARY_FLUSH])))
    2910            0 :         WaitLSNWakeup(WAIT_LSN_TYPE_PRIMARY_FLUSH, LogwrtResult.Flush);
    2911              : 
    2912              :     /*
    2913              :      * If we still haven't flushed to the request point then we have a
    2914              :      * problem; most likely, the requested flush point is past end of XLOG.
    2915              :      * This has been seen to occur when a disk page has a corrupted LSN.
    2916              :      *
    2917              :      * Formerly we treated this as a PANIC condition, but that hurts the
    2918              :      * system's robustness rather than helping it: we do not want to take down
    2919              :      * the whole system due to corruption on one data page.  In particular, if
    2920              :      * the bad page is encountered again during recovery then we would be
    2921              :      * unable to restart the database at all!  (This scenario actually
    2922              :      * happened in the field several times with 7.1 releases.)  As of 8.4, bad
    2923              :      * LSNs encountered during recovery are UpdateMinRecoveryPoint's problem;
    2924              :      * the only time we can reach here during recovery is while flushing the
    2925              :      * end-of-recovery checkpoint record, and we don't expect that to have a
    2926              :      * bad LSN.
    2927              :      *
    2928              :      * Note that for calls from xact.c, the ERROR will be promoted to PANIC
    2929              :      * since xact.c calls this routine inside a critical section.  However,
    2930              :      * calls from bufmgr.c are not within critical sections and so we will not
    2931              :      * force a restart for a bad LSN on a data page.
    2932              :      */
    2933       168344 :     if (LogwrtResult.Flush < record)
    2934            0 :         elog(ERROR,
    2935              :              "xlog flush request %X/%08X is not satisfied --- flushed only to %X/%08X",
    2936              :              LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(record),
    2937              :              LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(LogwrtResult.Flush));
    2938              : 
    2939              :     /*
    2940              :      * Cross-check XLogNeedsFlush().  Some of the checks of XLogFlush() and
    2941              :      * XLogNeedsFlush() are duplicated, and this assertion ensures that these
    2942              :      * remain consistent.
    2943              :      */
    2944              :     Assert(!XLogNeedsFlush(record));
    2945              : }
    2946              : 
    2947              : /*
    2948              :  * Write & flush xlog, but without specifying exactly where to.
    2949              :  *
    2950              :  * We normally write only completed blocks; but if there is nothing to do on
    2951              :  * that basis, we check for unwritten async commits in the current incomplete
    2952              :  * block, and write through the latest one of those.  Thus, if async commits
    2953              :  * are not being used, we will write complete blocks only.
    2954              :  *
    2955              :  * If, based on the above, there's anything to write we do so immediately. But
    2956              :  * to avoid calling fsync, fdatasync et. al. at a rate that'd impact
    2957              :  * concurrent IO, we only flush WAL every wal_writer_delay ms, or if there's
    2958              :  * more than wal_writer_flush_after unflushed blocks.
    2959              :  *
    2960              :  * We can guarantee that async commits reach disk after at most three
    2961              :  * wal_writer_delay cycles. (When flushing complete blocks, we allow XLogWrite
    2962              :  * to write "flexibly", meaning it can stop at the end of the buffer ring;
    2963              :  * this makes a difference only with very high load or long wal_writer_delay,
    2964              :  * but imposes one extra cycle for the worst case for async commits.)
    2965              :  *
    2966              :  * This routine is invoked periodically by the background walwriter process.
    2967              :  *
    2968              :  * Returns true if there was any work to do, even if we skipped flushing due
    2969              :  * to wal_writer_delay/wal_writer_flush_after.
    2970              :  */
    2971              : bool
    2972        15410 : XLogBackgroundFlush(void)
    2973              : {
    2974              :     XLogwrtRqst WriteRqst;
    2975        15410 :     bool        flexible = true;
    2976              :     static TimestampTz lastflush;
    2977              :     TimestampTz now;
    2978              :     int         flushblocks;
    2979              :     TimeLineID  insertTLI;
    2980              : 
    2981              :     /* XLOG doesn't need flushing during recovery */
    2982        15410 :     if (RecoveryInProgress())
    2983            0 :         return false;
    2984              : 
    2985              :     /*
    2986              :      * Since we're not in recovery, InsertTimeLineID is set and can't change,
    2987              :      * so we can read it without a lock.
    2988              :      */
    2989        15410 :     insertTLI = XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
    2990              : 
    2991              :     /* read updated LogwrtRqst */
    2992        15410 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    2993        15410 :     WriteRqst = XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst;
    2994        15410 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    2995              : 
    2996              :     /* back off to last completed page boundary */
    2997        15410 :     WriteRqst.Write -= WriteRqst.Write % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    2998              : 
    2999              :     /* if we have already flushed that far, consider async commit records */
    3000        15410 :     RefreshXLogWriteResult(LogwrtResult);
    3001        15410 :     if (WriteRqst.Write <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
    3002              :     {
    3003        11777 :         SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    3004        11777 :         WriteRqst.Write = XLogCtl->asyncXactLSN;
    3005        11777 :         SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    3006        11777 :         flexible = false;       /* ensure it all gets written */
    3007              :     }
    3008              : 
    3009              :     /*
    3010              :      * If already known flushed, we're done. Just need to check if we are
    3011              :      * holding an open file handle to a logfile that's no longer in use,
    3012              :      * preventing the file from being deleted.
    3013              :      */
    3014        15410 :     if (WriteRqst.Write <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
    3015              :     {
    3016        10935 :         if (openLogFile >= 0)
    3017              :         {
    3018         6767 :             if (!XLByteInPrevSeg(LogwrtResult.Write, openLogSegNo,
    3019              :                                  wal_segment_size))
    3020              :             {
    3021          186 :                 XLogFileClose();
    3022              :             }
    3023              :         }
    3024        10935 :         return false;
    3025              :     }
    3026              : 
    3027              :     /*
    3028              :      * Determine how far to flush WAL, based on the wal_writer_delay and
    3029              :      * wal_writer_flush_after GUCs.
    3030              :      *
    3031              :      * Note that XLogSetAsyncXactLSN() performs similar calculation based on
    3032              :      * wal_writer_flush_after, to decide when to wake us up.  Make sure the
    3033              :      * logic is the same in both places if you change this.
    3034              :      */
    3035         4475 :     now = GetCurrentTimestamp();
    3036         4475 :     flushblocks =
    3037         4475 :         WriteRqst.Write / XLOG_BLCKSZ - LogwrtResult.Flush / XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    3038              : 
    3039         4475 :     if (WalWriterFlushAfter == 0 || lastflush == 0)
    3040              :     {
    3041              :         /* first call, or block based limits disabled */
    3042          257 :         WriteRqst.Flush = WriteRqst.Write;
    3043          257 :         lastflush = now;
    3044              :     }
    3045         4218 :     else if (TimestampDifferenceExceeds(lastflush, now, WalWriterDelay))
    3046              :     {
    3047              :         /*
    3048              :          * Flush the writes at least every WalWriterDelay ms. This is
    3049              :          * important to bound the amount of time it takes for an asynchronous
    3050              :          * commit to hit disk.
    3051              :          */
    3052         4006 :         WriteRqst.Flush = WriteRqst.Write;
    3053         4006 :         lastflush = now;
    3054              :     }
    3055          212 :     else if (flushblocks >= WalWriterFlushAfter)
    3056              :     {
    3057              :         /* exceeded wal_writer_flush_after blocks, flush */
    3058          181 :         WriteRqst.Flush = WriteRqst.Write;
    3059          181 :         lastflush = now;
    3060              :     }
    3061              :     else
    3062              :     {
    3063              :         /* no flushing, this time round */
    3064           31 :         WriteRqst.Flush = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
    3065              :     }
    3066              : 
    3067              : #ifdef WAL_DEBUG
    3068              :     if (XLOG_DEBUG)
    3069              :         elog(LOG, "xlog bg flush request write %X/%08X; flush: %X/%08X, current is write %X/%08X; flush %X/%08X",
    3070              :              LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(WriteRqst.Write),
    3071              :              LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(WriteRqst.Flush),
    3072              :              LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(LogwrtResult.Write),
    3073              :              LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(LogwrtResult.Flush));
    3074              : #endif
    3075              : 
    3076         4475 :     START_CRIT_SECTION();
    3077              : 
    3078              :     /* now wait for any in-progress insertions to finish and get write lock */
    3079         4475 :     WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(WriteRqst.Write);
    3080         4475 :     LWLockAcquire(WALWriteLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    3081         4475 :     RefreshXLogWriteResult(LogwrtResult);
    3082         4475 :     if (WriteRqst.Write > LogwrtResult.Write ||
    3083          127 :         WriteRqst.Flush > LogwrtResult.Flush)
    3084              :     {
    3085         4393 :         XLogWrite(WriteRqst, insertTLI, flexible);
    3086              :     }
    3087         4475 :     LWLockRelease(WALWriteLock);
    3088              : 
    3089         4475 :     END_CRIT_SECTION();
    3090              : 
    3091              :     /* wake up walsenders now that we've released heavily contended locks */
    3092         4475 :     WalSndWakeupProcessRequests(true, !RecoveryInProgress());
    3093              : 
    3094              :     /*
    3095              :      * If we flushed an LSN that someone was waiting for, notify the waiters.
    3096              :      */
    3097         8950 :     if (waitLSNState &&
    3098         4475 :         (LogwrtResult.Flush >=
    3099         4475 :          pg_atomic_read_u64(&waitLSNState->minWaitedLSN[WAIT_LSN_TYPE_PRIMARY_FLUSH])))
    3100            0 :         WaitLSNWakeup(WAIT_LSN_TYPE_PRIMARY_FLUSH, LogwrtResult.Flush);
    3101              : 
    3102              :     /*
    3103              :      * Great, done. To take some work off the critical path, try to initialize
    3104              :      * as many of the no-longer-needed WAL buffers for future use as we can.
    3105              :      */
    3106         4475 :     AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(InvalidXLogRecPtr, insertTLI, true);
    3107              : 
    3108              :     /*
    3109              :      * If we determined that we need to write data, but somebody else
    3110              :      * wrote/flushed already, it should be considered as being active, to
    3111              :      * avoid hibernating too early.
    3112              :      */
    3113         4475 :     return true;
    3114              : }
    3115              : 
    3116              : /*
    3117              :  * Test whether XLOG data has been flushed up to (at least) the given
    3118              :  * position, or whether the minimum recovery point has been updated past
    3119              :  * the given position.
    3120              :  *
    3121              :  * Returns true if a flush is still needed, or if the minimum recovery point
    3122              :  * must be updated.
    3123              :  *
    3124              :  * It is possible that someone else is already in the process of flushing
    3125              :  * that far, or has updated the minimum recovery point up to the given
    3126              :  * position.
    3127              :  */
    3128              : bool
    3129     10629000 : XLogNeedsFlush(XLogRecPtr record)
    3130              : {
    3131              :     /*
    3132              :      * During recovery, we don't flush WAL but update minRecoveryPoint
    3133              :      * instead. So "needs flush" is taken to mean whether minRecoveryPoint
    3134              :      * would need to be updated.
    3135              :      *
    3136              :      * Using XLogInsertAllowed() rather than RecoveryInProgress() matters for
    3137              :      * the case of an end-of-recovery checkpoint, where WAL data is flushed.
    3138              :      * This check should be consistent with the one in XLogFlush().
    3139              :      */
    3140     10629000 :     if (!XLogInsertAllowed())
    3141              :     {
    3142              :         /* Quick exit if already known to be updated or cannot be updated */
    3143       496585 :         if (!updateMinRecoveryPoint || record <= LocalMinRecoveryPoint)
    3144       489136 :             return false;
    3145              : 
    3146              :         /*
    3147              :          * An invalid minRecoveryPoint means that we need to recover all the
    3148              :          * WAL, i.e., we're doing crash recovery.  We never modify the control
    3149              :          * file's value in that case, so we can short-circuit future checks
    3150              :          * here too.  This triggers a quick exit path for the startup process,
    3151              :          * which cannot update its local copy of minRecoveryPoint as long as
    3152              :          * it has not replayed all WAL available when doing crash recovery.
    3153              :          */
    3154         7449 :         if (!XLogRecPtrIsValid(LocalMinRecoveryPoint) && InRecovery)
    3155              :         {
    3156            0 :             updateMinRecoveryPoint = false;
    3157            0 :             return false;
    3158              :         }
    3159              : 
    3160              :         /*
    3161              :          * Update local copy of minRecoveryPoint. But if the lock is busy,
    3162              :          * just return a conservative guess.
    3163              :          */
    3164         7449 :         if (!LWLockConditionalAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_SHARED))
    3165            0 :             return true;
    3166         7449 :         LocalMinRecoveryPoint = ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint;
    3167         7449 :         LocalMinRecoveryPointTLI = ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI;
    3168         7449 :         LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    3169              : 
    3170              :         /*
    3171              :          * Check minRecoveryPoint for any other process than the startup
    3172              :          * process doing crash recovery, which should not update the control
    3173              :          * file value if crash recovery is still running.
    3174              :          */
    3175         7449 :         if (!XLogRecPtrIsValid(LocalMinRecoveryPoint))
    3176            0 :             updateMinRecoveryPoint = false;
    3177              : 
    3178              :         /* check again */
    3179         7449 :         if (record <= LocalMinRecoveryPoint || !updateMinRecoveryPoint)
    3180           88 :             return false;
    3181              :         else
    3182         7361 :             return true;
    3183              :     }
    3184              : 
    3185              :     /* Quick exit if already known flushed */
    3186     10132415 :     if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
    3187      9911513 :         return false;
    3188              : 
    3189              :     /* read LogwrtResult and update local state */
    3190       220902 :     RefreshXLogWriteResult(LogwrtResult);
    3191              : 
    3192              :     /* check again */
    3193       220902 :     if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
    3194         2843 :         return false;
    3195              : 
    3196       218059 :     return true;
    3197              : }
    3198              : 
    3199              : /*
    3200              :  * Try to make a given XLOG file segment exist.
    3201              :  *
    3202              :  * logsegno: identify segment.
    3203              :  *
    3204              :  * *added: on return, true if this call raised the number of extant segments.
    3205              :  *
    3206              :  * path: on return, this char[MAXPGPATH] has the path to the logsegno file.
    3207              :  *
    3208              :  * Returns -1 or FD of opened file.  A -1 here is not an error; a caller
    3209              :  * wanting an open segment should attempt to open "path", which usually will
    3210              :  * succeed.  (This is weird, but it's efficient for the callers.)
    3211              :  */
    3212              : static int
    3213        15853 : XLogFileInitInternal(XLogSegNo logsegno, TimeLineID logtli,
    3214              :                      bool *added, char *path)
    3215              : {
    3216              :     char        tmppath[MAXPGPATH];
    3217              :     XLogSegNo   installed_segno;
    3218              :     XLogSegNo   max_segno;
    3219              :     int         fd;
    3220              :     int         save_errno;
    3221        15853 :     int         open_flags = O_RDWR | O_CREAT | O_EXCL | PG_BINARY;
    3222              :     instr_time  io_start;
    3223              : 
    3224              :     Assert(logtli != 0);
    3225              : 
    3226        15853 :     XLogFilePath(path, logtli, logsegno, wal_segment_size);
    3227              : 
    3228              :     /*
    3229              :      * Try to use existent file (checkpoint maker may have created it already)
    3230              :      */
    3231        15853 :     *added = false;
    3232        15853 :     fd = BasicOpenFile(path, O_RDWR | PG_BINARY | O_CLOEXEC |
    3233        15853 :                        get_sync_bit(wal_sync_method));
    3234        15853 :     if (fd < 0)
    3235              :     {
    3236         1379 :         if (errno != ENOENT)
    3237            0 :             ereport(ERROR,
    3238              :                     (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3239              :                      errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m", path)));
    3240              :     }
    3241              :     else
    3242        14474 :         return fd;
    3243              : 
    3244              :     /*
    3245              :      * Initialize an empty (all zeroes) segment.  NOTE: it is possible that
    3246              :      * another process is doing the same thing.  If so, we will end up
    3247              :      * pre-creating an extra log segment.  That seems OK, and better than
    3248              :      * holding the lock throughout this lengthy process.
    3249              :      */
    3250         1379 :     elog(DEBUG2, "creating and filling new WAL file");
    3251              : 
    3252         1379 :     snprintf(tmppath, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/xlogtemp.%d", (int) getpid());
    3253              : 
    3254         1379 :     unlink(tmppath);
    3255              : 
    3256         1379 :     if (io_direct_flags & IO_DIRECT_WAL_INIT)
    3257            0 :         open_flags |= PG_O_DIRECT;
    3258              : 
    3259              :     /* do not use get_sync_bit() here --- want to fsync only at end of fill */
    3260         1379 :     fd = BasicOpenFile(tmppath, open_flags);
    3261         1379 :     if (fd < 0)
    3262            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    3263              :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3264              :                  errmsg("could not create file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
    3265              : 
    3266              :     /* Measure I/O timing when initializing segment */
    3267         1379 :     io_start = pgstat_prepare_io_time(track_wal_io_timing);
    3268              : 
    3269         1379 :     pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_INIT_WRITE);
    3270         1379 :     save_errno = 0;
    3271         1379 :     if (wal_init_zero)
    3272              :     {
    3273              :         ssize_t     rc;
    3274              : 
    3275              :         /*
    3276              :          * Zero-fill the file.  With this setting, we do this the hard way to
    3277              :          * ensure that all the file space has really been allocated.  On
    3278              :          * platforms that allow "holes" in files, just seeking to the end
    3279              :          * doesn't allocate intermediate space.  This way, we know that we
    3280              :          * have all the space and (after the fsync below) that all the
    3281              :          * indirect blocks are down on disk.  Therefore, fdatasync(2) or
    3282              :          * O_DSYNC will be sufficient to sync future writes to the log file.
    3283              :          */
    3284         1379 :         rc = pg_pwrite_zeros(fd, wal_segment_size, 0);
    3285              : 
    3286         1379 :         if (rc < 0)
    3287            0 :             save_errno = errno;
    3288              :     }
    3289              :     else
    3290              :     {
    3291              :         /*
    3292              :          * Otherwise, seeking to the end and writing a solitary byte is
    3293              :          * enough.
    3294              :          */
    3295            0 :         errno = 0;
    3296            0 :         if (pg_pwrite(fd, "\0", 1, wal_segment_size - 1) != 1)
    3297              :         {
    3298              :             /* if write didn't set errno, assume no disk space */
    3299            0 :             save_errno = errno ? errno : ENOSPC;
    3300              :         }
    3301              :     }
    3302         1379 :     pgstat_report_wait_end();
    3303              : 
    3304              :     /*
    3305              :      * A full segment worth of data is written when using wal_init_zero. One
    3306              :      * byte is written when not using it.
    3307              :      */
    3308         1379 :     pgstat_count_io_op_time(IOOBJECT_WAL, IOCONTEXT_INIT, IOOP_WRITE,
    3309              :                             io_start, 1,
    3310         1379 :                             wal_init_zero ? wal_segment_size : 1);
    3311              : 
    3312         1379 :     if (save_errno)
    3313              :     {
    3314              :         /*
    3315              :          * If we fail to make the file, delete it to release disk space
    3316              :          */
    3317            0 :         unlink(tmppath);
    3318              : 
    3319            0 :         close(fd);
    3320              : 
    3321            0 :         errno = save_errno;
    3322              : 
    3323            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    3324              :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3325              :                  errmsg("could not write to file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
    3326              :     }
    3327              : 
    3328              :     /* Measure I/O timing when flushing segment */
    3329         1379 :     io_start = pgstat_prepare_io_time(track_wal_io_timing);
    3330              : 
    3331         1379 :     pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_INIT_SYNC);
    3332         1379 :     if (pg_fsync(fd) != 0)
    3333              :     {
    3334            0 :         save_errno = errno;
    3335            0 :         close(fd);
    3336            0 :         errno = save_errno;
    3337            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    3338              :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3339              :                  errmsg("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
    3340              :     }
    3341         1379 :     pgstat_report_wait_end();
    3342              : 
    3343         1379 :     pgstat_count_io_op_time(IOOBJECT_WAL, IOCONTEXT_INIT,
    3344              :                             IOOP_FSYNC, io_start, 1, 0);
    3345              : 
    3346         1379 :     if (close(fd) != 0)
    3347            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    3348              :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3349              :                  errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
    3350              : 
    3351              :     /*
    3352              :      * Now move the segment into place with its final name.  Cope with
    3353              :      * possibility that someone else has created the file while we were
    3354              :      * filling ours: if so, use ours to pre-create a future log segment.
    3355              :      */
    3356         1379 :     installed_segno = logsegno;
    3357              : 
    3358              :     /*
    3359              :      * XXX: What should we use as max_segno? We used to use XLOGfileslop when
    3360              :      * that was a constant, but that was always a bit dubious: normally, at a
    3361              :      * checkpoint, XLOGfileslop was the offset from the checkpoint record, but
    3362              :      * here, it was the offset from the insert location. We can't do the
    3363              :      * normal XLOGfileslop calculation here because we don't have access to
    3364              :      * the prior checkpoint's redo location. So somewhat arbitrarily, just use
    3365              :      * CheckPointSegments.
    3366              :      */
    3367         1379 :     max_segno = logsegno + CheckPointSegments;
    3368         1379 :     if (InstallXLogFileSegment(&installed_segno, tmppath, true, max_segno,
    3369              :                                logtli))
    3370              :     {
    3371         1379 :         *added = true;
    3372         1379 :         elog(DEBUG2, "done creating and filling new WAL file");
    3373              :     }
    3374              :     else
    3375              :     {
    3376              :         /*
    3377              :          * No need for any more future segments, or InstallXLogFileSegment()
    3378              :          * failed to rename the file into place. If the rename failed, a
    3379              :          * caller opening the file may fail.
    3380              :          */
    3381            0 :         unlink(tmppath);
    3382            0 :         elog(DEBUG2, "abandoned new WAL file");
    3383              :     }
    3384              : 
    3385         1379 :     return -1;
    3386              : }
    3387              : 
    3388              : /*
    3389              :  * Create a new XLOG file segment, or open a pre-existing one.
    3390              :  *
    3391              :  * logsegno: identify segment to be created/opened.
    3392              :  *
    3393              :  * Returns FD of opened file.
    3394              :  *
    3395              :  * Note: errors here are ERROR not PANIC because we might or might not be
    3396              :  * inside a critical section (eg, during checkpoint there is no reason to
    3397              :  * take down the system on failure).  They will promote to PANIC if we are
    3398              :  * in a critical section.
    3399              :  */
    3400              : int
    3401        15629 : XLogFileInit(XLogSegNo logsegno, TimeLineID logtli)
    3402              : {
    3403              :     bool        ignore_added;
    3404              :     char        path[MAXPGPATH];
    3405              :     int         fd;
    3406              : 
    3407              :     Assert(logtli != 0);
    3408              : 
    3409        15629 :     fd = XLogFileInitInternal(logsegno, logtli, &ignore_added, path);
    3410        15629 :     if (fd >= 0)
    3411        14314 :         return fd;
    3412              : 
    3413              :     /* Now open original target segment (might not be file I just made) */
    3414         1315 :     fd = BasicOpenFile(path, O_RDWR | PG_BINARY | O_CLOEXEC |
    3415         1315 :                        get_sync_bit(wal_sync_method));
    3416         1315 :     if (fd < 0)
    3417            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    3418              :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3419              :                  errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m", path)));
    3420         1315 :     return fd;
    3421              : }
    3422              : 
    3423              : /*
    3424              :  * Create a new XLOG file segment by copying a pre-existing one.
    3425              :  *
    3426              :  * destsegno: identify segment to be created.
    3427              :  *
    3428              :  * srcTLI, srcsegno: identify segment to be copied (could be from
    3429              :  *      a different timeline)
    3430              :  *
    3431              :  * upto: how much of the source file to copy (the rest is filled with
    3432              :  *      zeros)
    3433              :  *
    3434              :  * Currently this is only used during recovery, and so there are no locking
    3435              :  * considerations.  But we should be just as tense as XLogFileInit to avoid
    3436              :  * emplacing a bogus file.
    3437              :  */
    3438              : static void
    3439           43 : XLogFileCopy(TimeLineID destTLI, XLogSegNo destsegno,
    3440              :              TimeLineID srcTLI, XLogSegNo srcsegno,
    3441              :              int upto)
    3442              : {
    3443              :     char        path[MAXPGPATH];
    3444              :     char        tmppath[MAXPGPATH];
    3445              :     PGAlignedXLogBlock buffer;
    3446              :     int         srcfd;
    3447              :     int         fd;
    3448              :     int         nbytes;
    3449              : 
    3450              :     /*
    3451              :      * Open the source file
    3452              :      */
    3453           43 :     XLogFilePath(path, srcTLI, srcsegno, wal_segment_size);
    3454           43 :     srcfd = OpenTransientFile(path, O_RDONLY | PG_BINARY);
    3455           43 :     if (srcfd < 0)
    3456            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    3457              :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3458              :                  errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m", path)));
    3459              : 
    3460              :     /*
    3461              :      * Copy into a temp file name.
    3462              :      */
    3463           43 :     snprintf(tmppath, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/xlogtemp.%d", (int) getpid());
    3464              : 
    3465           43 :     unlink(tmppath);
    3466              : 
    3467              :     /* do not use get_sync_bit() here --- want to fsync only at end of fill */
    3468           43 :     fd = OpenTransientFile(tmppath, O_RDWR | O_CREAT | O_EXCL | PG_BINARY);
    3469           43 :     if (fd < 0)
    3470            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    3471              :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3472              :                  errmsg("could not create file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
    3473              : 
    3474              :     /*
    3475              :      * Do the data copying.
    3476              :      */
    3477        88107 :     for (nbytes = 0; nbytes < wal_segment_size; nbytes += sizeof(buffer))
    3478              :     {
    3479              :         int         nread;
    3480              : 
    3481        88064 :         nread = upto - nbytes;
    3482              : 
    3483              :         /*
    3484              :          * The part that is not read from the source file is filled with
    3485              :          * zeros.
    3486              :          */
    3487        88064 :         if (nread < sizeof(buffer))
    3488           43 :             memset(buffer.data, 0, sizeof(buffer));
    3489              : 
    3490        88064 :         if (nread > 0)
    3491              :         {
    3492              :             int         r;
    3493              : 
    3494         2780 :             if (nread > sizeof(buffer))
    3495         2737 :                 nread = sizeof(buffer);
    3496         2780 :             pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_COPY_READ);
    3497         2780 :             r = read(srcfd, buffer.data, nread);
    3498         2780 :             if (r != nread)
    3499              :             {
    3500            0 :                 if (r < 0)
    3501            0 :                     ereport(ERROR,
    3502              :                             (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3503              :                              errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": %m",
    3504              :                                     path)));
    3505              :                 else
    3506            0 :                     ereport(ERROR,
    3507              :                             (errcode(ERRCODE_DATA_CORRUPTED),
    3508              :                              errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": read %d of %zu",
    3509              :                                     path, r, (Size) nread)));
    3510              :             }
    3511         2780 :             pgstat_report_wait_end();
    3512              :         }
    3513        88064 :         errno = 0;
    3514        88064 :         pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_COPY_WRITE);
    3515        88064 :         if ((int) write(fd, buffer.data, sizeof(buffer)) != (int) sizeof(buffer))
    3516              :         {
    3517            0 :             int         save_errno = errno;
    3518              : 
    3519              :             /*
    3520              :              * If we fail to make the file, delete it to release disk space
    3521              :              */
    3522            0 :             unlink(tmppath);
    3523              :             /* if write didn't set errno, assume problem is no disk space */
    3524            0 :             errno = save_errno ? save_errno : ENOSPC;
    3525              : 
    3526            0 :             ereport(ERROR,
    3527              :                     (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3528              :                      errmsg("could not write to file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
    3529              :         }
    3530        88064 :         pgstat_report_wait_end();
    3531              :     }
    3532              : 
    3533           43 :     pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_COPY_SYNC);
    3534           43 :     if (pg_fsync(fd) != 0)
    3535            0 :         ereport(data_sync_elevel(ERROR),
    3536              :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3537              :                  errmsg("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
    3538           43 :     pgstat_report_wait_end();
    3539              : 
    3540           43 :     if (CloseTransientFile(fd) != 0)
    3541            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    3542              :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3543              :                  errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
    3544              : 
    3545           43 :     if (CloseTransientFile(srcfd) != 0)
    3546            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    3547              :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3548              :                  errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", path)));
    3549              : 
    3550              :     /*
    3551              :      * Now move the segment into place with its final name.
    3552              :      */
    3553           43 :     if (!InstallXLogFileSegment(&destsegno, tmppath, false, 0, destTLI))
    3554            0 :         elog(ERROR, "InstallXLogFileSegment should not have failed");
    3555           43 : }
    3556              : 
    3557              : /*
    3558              :  * Install a new XLOG segment file as a current or future log segment.
    3559              :  *
    3560              :  * This is used both to install a newly-created segment (which has a temp
    3561              :  * filename while it's being created) and to recycle an old segment.
    3562              :  *
    3563              :  * *segno: identify segment to install as (or first possible target).
    3564              :  * When find_free is true, this is modified on return to indicate the
    3565              :  * actual installation location or last segment searched.
    3566              :  *
    3567              :  * tmppath: initial name of file to install.  It will be renamed into place.
    3568              :  *
    3569              :  * find_free: if true, install the new segment at the first empty segno
    3570              :  * number at or after the passed numbers.  If false, install the new segment
    3571              :  * exactly where specified, deleting any existing segment file there.
    3572              :  *
    3573              :  * max_segno: maximum segment number to install the new file as.  Fail if no
    3574              :  * free slot is found between *segno and max_segno. (Ignored when find_free
    3575              :  * is false.)
    3576              :  *
    3577              :  * tli: The timeline on which the new segment should be installed.
    3578              :  *
    3579              :  * Returns true if the file was installed successfully.  false indicates that
    3580              :  * max_segno limit was exceeded, the startup process has disabled this
    3581              :  * function for now, or an error occurred while renaming the file into place.
    3582              :  */
    3583              : static bool
    3584         3186 : InstallXLogFileSegment(XLogSegNo *segno, char *tmppath,
    3585              :                        bool find_free, XLogSegNo max_segno, TimeLineID tli)
    3586              : {
    3587              :     char        path[MAXPGPATH];
    3588              :     struct stat stat_buf;
    3589              : 
    3590              :     Assert(tli != 0);
    3591              : 
    3592         3186 :     XLogFilePath(path, tli, *segno, wal_segment_size);
    3593              : 
    3594         3186 :     LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    3595         3186 :     if (!XLogCtl->InstallXLogFileSegmentActive)
    3596              :     {
    3597            0 :         LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    3598            0 :         return false;
    3599              :     }
    3600              : 
    3601         3186 :     if (!find_free)
    3602              :     {
    3603              :         /* Force installation: get rid of any pre-existing segment file */
    3604           43 :         durable_unlink(path, DEBUG1);
    3605              :     }
    3606              :     else
    3607              :     {
    3608              :         /* Find a free slot to put it in */
    3609         4553 :         while (stat(path, &stat_buf) == 0)
    3610              :         {
    3611         1629 :             if ((*segno) >= max_segno)
    3612              :             {
    3613              :                 /* Failed to find a free slot within specified range */
    3614          219 :                 LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    3615          219 :                 return false;
    3616              :             }
    3617         1410 :             (*segno)++;
    3618         1410 :             XLogFilePath(path, tli, *segno, wal_segment_size);
    3619              :         }
    3620              :     }
    3621              : 
    3622              :     Assert(access(path, F_OK) != 0 && errno == ENOENT);
    3623         2967 :     if (durable_rename(tmppath, path, LOG) != 0)
    3624              :     {
    3625            0 :         LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    3626              :         /* durable_rename already emitted log message */
    3627            0 :         return false;
    3628              :     }
    3629              : 
    3630         2967 :     LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    3631              : 
    3632         2967 :     return true;
    3633              : }
    3634              : 
    3635              : /*
    3636              :  * Open a pre-existing logfile segment for writing.
    3637              :  */
    3638              : int
    3639           97 : XLogFileOpen(XLogSegNo segno, TimeLineID tli)
    3640              : {
    3641              :     char        path[MAXPGPATH];
    3642              :     int         fd;
    3643              : 
    3644           97 :     XLogFilePath(path, tli, segno, wal_segment_size);
    3645              : 
    3646           97 :     fd = BasicOpenFile(path, O_RDWR | PG_BINARY | O_CLOEXEC |
    3647           97 :                        get_sync_bit(wal_sync_method));
    3648           97 :     if (fd < 0)
    3649            0 :         ereport(PANIC,
    3650              :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3651              :                  errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m", path)));
    3652              : 
    3653           97 :     return fd;
    3654              : }
    3655              : 
    3656              : /*
    3657              :  * Close the current logfile segment for writing.
    3658              :  */
    3659              : static void
    3660         6875 : XLogFileClose(void)
    3661              : {
    3662              :     Assert(openLogFile >= 0);
    3663              : 
    3664              :     /*
    3665              :      * WAL segment files will not be re-read in normal operation, so we advise
    3666              :      * the OS to release any cached pages.  But do not do so if WAL archiving
    3667              :      * or streaming is active, because archiver and walsender process could
    3668              :      * use the cache to read the WAL segment.
    3669              :      */
    3670              : #if defined(USE_POSIX_FADVISE) && defined(POSIX_FADV_DONTNEED)
    3671         6875 :     if (!XLogIsNeeded() && (io_direct_flags & IO_DIRECT_WAL) == 0)
    3672          239 :         (void) posix_fadvise(openLogFile, 0, 0, POSIX_FADV_DONTNEED);
    3673              : #endif
    3674              : 
    3675         6875 :     if (close(openLogFile) != 0)
    3676              :     {
    3677              :         char        xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
    3678            0 :         int         save_errno = errno;
    3679              : 
    3680            0 :         XLogFileName(xlogfname, openLogTLI, openLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    3681            0 :         errno = save_errno;
    3682            0 :         ereport(PANIC,
    3683              :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3684              :                  errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", xlogfname)));
    3685              :     }
    3686              : 
    3687         6875 :     openLogFile = -1;
    3688         6875 :     ReleaseExternalFD();
    3689         6875 : }
    3690              : 
    3691              : /*
    3692              :  * Preallocate log files beyond the specified log endpoint.
    3693              :  *
    3694              :  * XXX this is currently extremely conservative, since it forces only one
    3695              :  * future log segment to exist, and even that only if we are 75% done with
    3696              :  * the current one.  This is only appropriate for very low-WAL-volume systems.
    3697              :  * High-volume systems will be OK once they've built up a sufficient set of
    3698              :  * recycled log segments, but the startup transient is likely to include
    3699              :  * a lot of segment creations by foreground processes, which is not so good.
    3700              :  *
    3701              :  * XLogFileInitInternal() can ereport(ERROR).  All known causes indicate big
    3702              :  * trouble; for example, a full filesystem is one cause.  The checkpoint WAL
    3703              :  * and/or ControlFile updates already completed.  If a RequestCheckpoint()
    3704              :  * initiated the present checkpoint and an ERROR ends this function, the
    3705              :  * command that called RequestCheckpoint() fails.  That's not ideal, but it's
    3706              :  * not worth contorting more functions to use caller-specified elevel values.
    3707              :  * (With or without RequestCheckpoint(), an ERROR forestalls some inessential
    3708              :  * reporting and resource reclamation.)
    3709              :  */
    3710              : static void
    3711         2112 : PreallocXlogFiles(XLogRecPtr endptr, TimeLineID tli)
    3712              : {
    3713              :     XLogSegNo   _logSegNo;
    3714              :     int         lf;
    3715              :     bool        added;
    3716              :     char        path[MAXPGPATH];
    3717              :     uint64      offset;
    3718              : 
    3719         2112 :     if (!XLogCtl->InstallXLogFileSegmentActive)
    3720           12 :         return;                 /* unlocked check says no */
    3721              : 
    3722         2100 :     XLByteToPrevSeg(endptr, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    3723         2100 :     offset = XLogSegmentOffset(endptr - 1, wal_segment_size);
    3724         2100 :     if (offset >= (uint32) (0.75 * wal_segment_size))
    3725              :     {
    3726          224 :         _logSegNo++;
    3727          224 :         lf = XLogFileInitInternal(_logSegNo, tli, &added, path);
    3728          224 :         if (lf >= 0)
    3729          160 :             close(lf);
    3730          224 :         if (added)
    3731           64 :             CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_added++;
    3732              :     }
    3733              : }
    3734              : 
    3735              : /*
    3736              :  * Throws an error if the given log segment has already been removed or
    3737              :  * recycled. The caller should only pass a segment that it knows to have
    3738              :  * existed while the server has been running, as this function always
    3739              :  * succeeds if no WAL segments have been removed since startup.
    3740              :  * 'tli' is only used in the error message.
    3741              :  *
    3742              :  * Note: this function guarantees to keep errno unchanged on return.
    3743              :  * This supports callers that use this to possibly deliver a better
    3744              :  * error message about a missing file, while still being able to throw
    3745              :  * a normal file-access error afterwards, if this does return.
    3746              :  */
    3747              : void
    3748       125269 : CheckXLogRemoved(XLogSegNo segno, TimeLineID tli)
    3749              : {
    3750       125269 :     int         save_errno = errno;
    3751              :     XLogSegNo   lastRemovedSegNo;
    3752              : 
    3753       125269 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    3754       125269 :     lastRemovedSegNo = XLogCtl->lastRemovedSegNo;
    3755       125269 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    3756              : 
    3757       125269 :     if (segno <= lastRemovedSegNo)
    3758              :     {
    3759              :         char        filename[MAXFNAMELEN];
    3760              : 
    3761            0 :         XLogFileName(filename, tli, segno, wal_segment_size);
    3762            0 :         errno = save_errno;
    3763            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    3764              :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3765              :                  errmsg("requested WAL segment %s has already been removed",
    3766              :                         filename)));
    3767              :     }
    3768       125269 :     errno = save_errno;
    3769       125269 : }
    3770              : 
    3771              : /*
    3772              :  * Return the last WAL segment removed, or 0 if no segment has been removed
    3773              :  * since startup.
    3774              :  *
    3775              :  * NB: the result can be out of date arbitrarily fast, the caller has to deal
    3776              :  * with that.
    3777              :  */
    3778              : XLogSegNo
    3779         1271 : XLogGetLastRemovedSegno(void)
    3780              : {
    3781              :     XLogSegNo   lastRemovedSegNo;
    3782              : 
    3783         1271 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    3784         1271 :     lastRemovedSegNo = XLogCtl->lastRemovedSegNo;
    3785         1271 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    3786              : 
    3787         1271 :     return lastRemovedSegNo;
    3788              : }
    3789              : 
    3790              : /*
    3791              :  * Return the oldest WAL segment on the given TLI that still exists in
    3792              :  * XLOGDIR, or 0 if none.
    3793              :  */
    3794              : XLogSegNo
    3795            7 : XLogGetOldestSegno(TimeLineID tli)
    3796              : {
    3797              :     DIR        *xldir;
    3798              :     struct dirent *xlde;
    3799            7 :     XLogSegNo   oldest_segno = 0;
    3800              : 
    3801            7 :     xldir = AllocateDir(XLOGDIR);
    3802           50 :     while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL)
    3803              :     {
    3804              :         TimeLineID  file_tli;
    3805              :         XLogSegNo   file_segno;
    3806              : 
    3807              :         /* Ignore files that are not XLOG segments. */
    3808           43 :         if (!IsXLogFileName(xlde->d_name))
    3809           29 :             continue;
    3810              : 
    3811              :         /* Parse filename to get TLI and segno. */
    3812           14 :         XLogFromFileName(xlde->d_name, &file_tli, &file_segno,
    3813              :                          wal_segment_size);
    3814              : 
    3815              :         /* Ignore anything that's not from the TLI of interest. */
    3816           14 :         if (tli != file_tli)
    3817            0 :             continue;
    3818              : 
    3819              :         /* If it's the oldest so far, update oldest_segno. */
    3820           14 :         if (oldest_segno == 0 || file_segno < oldest_segno)
    3821            9 :             oldest_segno = file_segno;
    3822              :     }
    3823              : 
    3824            7 :     FreeDir(xldir);
    3825            7 :     return oldest_segno;
    3826              : }
    3827              : 
    3828              : /*
    3829              :  * Update the last removed segno pointer in shared memory, to reflect that the
    3830              :  * given XLOG file has been removed.
    3831              :  */
    3832              : static void
    3833         2708 : UpdateLastRemovedPtr(char *filename)
    3834              : {
    3835              :     uint32      tli;
    3836              :     XLogSegNo   segno;
    3837              : 
    3838         2708 :     XLogFromFileName(filename, &tli, &segno, wal_segment_size);
    3839              : 
    3840         2708 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    3841         2708 :     if (segno > XLogCtl->lastRemovedSegNo)
    3842         1271 :         XLogCtl->lastRemovedSegNo = segno;
    3843         2708 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    3844         2708 : }
    3845              : 
    3846              : /*
    3847              :  * Remove all temporary log files in pg_wal
    3848              :  *
    3849              :  * This is called at the beginning of recovery after a previous crash,
    3850              :  * at a point where no other processes write fresh WAL data.
    3851              :  */
    3852              : static void
    3853          186 : RemoveTempXlogFiles(void)
    3854              : {
    3855              :     DIR        *xldir;
    3856              :     struct dirent *xlde;
    3857              : 
    3858          186 :     elog(DEBUG2, "removing all temporary WAL segments");
    3859              : 
    3860          186 :     xldir = AllocateDir(XLOGDIR);
    3861         1259 :     while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL)
    3862              :     {
    3863              :         char        path[MAXPGPATH];
    3864              : 
    3865         1073 :         if (strncmp(xlde->d_name, "xlogtemp.", 9) != 0)
    3866         1073 :             continue;
    3867              : 
    3868            0 :         snprintf(path, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/%s", xlde->d_name);
    3869            0 :         unlink(path);
    3870            0 :         elog(DEBUG2, "removed temporary WAL segment \"%s\"", path);
    3871              :     }
    3872          186 :     FreeDir(xldir);
    3873          186 : }
    3874              : 
    3875              : /*
    3876              :  * Recycle or remove all log files older or equal to passed segno.
    3877              :  *
    3878              :  * endptr is current (or recent) end of xlog, and lastredoptr is the
    3879              :  * redo pointer of the last checkpoint. These are used to determine
    3880              :  * whether we want to recycle rather than delete no-longer-wanted log files.
    3881              :  *
    3882              :  * insertTLI is the current timeline for XLOG insertion. Any recycled
    3883              :  * segments should be reused for this timeline.
    3884              :  */
    3885              : static void
    3886         1835 : RemoveOldXlogFiles(XLogSegNo segno, XLogRecPtr lastredoptr, XLogRecPtr endptr,
    3887              :                    TimeLineID insertTLI)
    3888              : {
    3889              :     DIR        *xldir;
    3890              :     struct dirent *xlde;
    3891              :     char        lastoff[MAXFNAMELEN];
    3892              :     XLogSegNo   endlogSegNo;
    3893              :     XLogSegNo   recycleSegNo;
    3894              : 
    3895              :     /* Initialize info about where to try to recycle to */
    3896         1835 :     XLByteToSeg(endptr, endlogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    3897         1835 :     recycleSegNo = XLOGfileslop(lastredoptr);
    3898              : 
    3899              :     /*
    3900              :      * Construct a filename of the last segment to be kept. The timeline ID
    3901              :      * doesn't matter, we ignore that in the comparison. (During recovery,
    3902              :      * InsertTimeLineID isn't set, so we can't use that.)
    3903              :      */
    3904         1835 :     XLogFileName(lastoff, 0, segno, wal_segment_size);
    3905              : 
    3906         1835 :     elog(DEBUG2, "attempting to remove WAL segments older than log file %s",
    3907              :          lastoff);
    3908              : 
    3909         1835 :     xldir = AllocateDir(XLOGDIR);
    3910              : 
    3911        20799 :     while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL)
    3912              :     {
    3913              :         /* Ignore files that are not XLOG segments */
    3914        18964 :         if (!IsXLogFileName(xlde->d_name) &&
    3915         7794 :             !IsPartialXLogFileName(xlde->d_name))
    3916         7792 :             continue;
    3917              : 
    3918              :         /*
    3919              :          * We ignore the timeline part of the XLOG segment identifiers in
    3920              :          * deciding whether a segment is still needed.  This ensures that we
    3921              :          * won't prematurely remove a segment from a parent timeline. We could
    3922              :          * probably be a little more proactive about removing segments of
    3923              :          * non-parent timelines, but that would be a whole lot more
    3924              :          * complicated.
    3925              :          *
    3926              :          * We use the alphanumeric sorting property of the filenames to decide
    3927              :          * which ones are earlier than the lastoff segment.
    3928              :          */
    3929        11172 :         if (strcmp(xlde->d_name + 8, lastoff + 8) <= 0)
    3930              :         {
    3931         4536 :             if (XLogArchiveCheckDone(xlde->d_name))
    3932              :             {
    3933              :                 /* Update the last removed location in shared memory first */
    3934         2708 :                 UpdateLastRemovedPtr(xlde->d_name);
    3935              : 
    3936         2708 :                 RemoveXlogFile(xlde, recycleSegNo, &endlogSegNo, insertTLI);
    3937              :             }
    3938              :         }
    3939              :     }
    3940              : 
    3941         1835 :     FreeDir(xldir);
    3942         1835 : }
    3943              : 
    3944              : /*
    3945              :  * Recycle or remove WAL files that are not part of the given timeline's
    3946              :  * history.
    3947              :  *
    3948              :  * This is called during recovery, whenever we switch to follow a new
    3949              :  * timeline, and at the end of recovery when we create a new timeline. We
    3950              :  * wouldn't otherwise care about extra WAL files lying in pg_wal, but they
    3951              :  * might be leftover pre-allocated or recycled WAL segments on the old timeline
    3952              :  * that we haven't used yet, and contain garbage. If we just leave them in
    3953              :  * pg_wal, they will eventually be archived, and we can't let that happen.
    3954              :  * Files that belong to our timeline history are valid, because we have
    3955              :  * successfully replayed them, but from others we can't be sure.
    3956              :  *
    3957              :  * 'switchpoint' is the current point in WAL where we switch to new timeline,
    3958              :  * and 'newTLI' is the new timeline we switch to.
    3959              :  */
    3960              : void
    3961           66 : RemoveNonParentXlogFiles(XLogRecPtr switchpoint, TimeLineID newTLI)
    3962              : {
    3963              :     DIR        *xldir;
    3964              :     struct dirent *xlde;
    3965              :     char        switchseg[MAXFNAMELEN];
    3966              :     XLogSegNo   endLogSegNo;
    3967              :     XLogSegNo   switchLogSegNo;
    3968              :     XLogSegNo   recycleSegNo;
    3969              : 
    3970              :     /*
    3971              :      * Initialize info about where to begin the work.  This will recycle,
    3972              :      * somewhat arbitrarily, 10 future segments.
    3973              :      */
    3974           66 :     XLByteToPrevSeg(switchpoint, switchLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    3975           66 :     XLByteToSeg(switchpoint, endLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    3976           66 :     recycleSegNo = endLogSegNo + 10;
    3977              : 
    3978              :     /*
    3979              :      * Construct a filename of the last segment to be kept.
    3980              :      */
    3981           66 :     XLogFileName(switchseg, newTLI, switchLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    3982              : 
    3983           66 :     elog(DEBUG2, "attempting to remove WAL segments newer than log file %s",
    3984              :          switchseg);
    3985              : 
    3986           66 :     xldir = AllocateDir(XLOGDIR);
    3987              : 
    3988          625 :     while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL)
    3989              :     {
    3990              :         /* Ignore files that are not XLOG segments */
    3991          559 :         if (!IsXLogFileName(xlde->d_name))
    3992          348 :             continue;
    3993              : 
    3994              :         /*
    3995              :          * Remove files that are on a timeline older than the new one we're
    3996              :          * switching to, but with a segment number >= the first segment on the
    3997              :          * new timeline.
    3998              :          */
    3999          211 :         if (strncmp(xlde->d_name, switchseg, 8) < 0 &&
    4000          137 :             strcmp(xlde->d_name + 8, switchseg + 8) > 0)
    4001              :         {
    4002              :             /*
    4003              :              * If the file has already been marked as .ready, however, don't
    4004              :              * remove it yet. It should be OK to remove it - files that are
    4005              :              * not part of our timeline history are not required for recovery
    4006              :              * - but seems safer to let them be archived and removed later.
    4007              :              */
    4008           16 :             if (!XLogArchiveIsReady(xlde->d_name))
    4009           16 :                 RemoveXlogFile(xlde, recycleSegNo, &endLogSegNo, newTLI);
    4010              :         }
    4011              :     }
    4012              : 
    4013           66 :     FreeDir(xldir);
    4014           66 : }
    4015              : 
    4016              : /*
    4017              :  * Recycle or remove a log file that's no longer needed.
    4018              :  *
    4019              :  * segment_de is the dirent structure of the segment to recycle or remove.
    4020              :  * recycleSegNo is the segment number to recycle up to.  endlogSegNo is
    4021              :  * the segment number of the current (or recent) end of WAL.
    4022              :  *
    4023              :  * endlogSegNo gets incremented if the segment is recycled so as it is not
    4024              :  * checked again with future callers of this function.
    4025              :  *
    4026              :  * insertTLI is the current timeline for XLOG insertion. Any recycled segments
    4027              :  * should be used for this timeline.
    4028              :  */
    4029              : static void
    4030         2724 : RemoveXlogFile(const struct dirent *segment_de,
    4031              :                XLogSegNo recycleSegNo, XLogSegNo *endlogSegNo,
    4032              :                TimeLineID insertTLI)
    4033              : {
    4034              :     char        path[MAXPGPATH];
    4035              : #ifdef WIN32
    4036              :     char        newpath[MAXPGPATH];
    4037              : #endif
    4038         2724 :     const char *segname = segment_de->d_name;
    4039              : 
    4040         2724 :     snprintf(path, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/%s", segname);
    4041              : 
    4042              :     /*
    4043              :      * Before deleting the file, see if it can be recycled as a future log
    4044              :      * segment. Only recycle normal files, because we don't want to recycle
    4045              :      * symbolic links pointing to a separate archive directory.
    4046              :      */
    4047         2724 :     if (wal_recycle &&
    4048         2724 :         *endlogSegNo <= recycleSegNo &&
    4049         3856 :         XLogCtl->InstallXLogFileSegmentActive && /* callee rechecks this */
    4050         3528 :         get_dirent_type(path, segment_de, false, DEBUG2) == PGFILETYPE_REG &&
    4051         1764 :         InstallXLogFileSegment(endlogSegNo, path,
    4052              :                                true, recycleSegNo, insertTLI))
    4053              :     {
    4054         1545 :         ereport(DEBUG2,
    4055              :                 (errmsg_internal("recycled write-ahead log file \"%s\"",
    4056              :                                  segname)));
    4057         1545 :         CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_recycled++;
    4058              :         /* Needn't recheck that slot on future iterations */
    4059         1545 :         (*endlogSegNo)++;
    4060              :     }
    4061              :     else
    4062              :     {
    4063              :         /* No need for any more future segments, or recycling failed ... */
    4064              :         int         rc;
    4065              : 
    4066         1179 :         ereport(DEBUG2,
    4067              :                 (errmsg_internal("removing write-ahead log file \"%s\"",
    4068              :                                  segname)));
    4069              : 
    4070              : #ifdef WIN32
    4071              : 
    4072              :         /*
    4073              :          * On Windows, if another process (e.g another backend) holds the file
    4074              :          * open in FILE_SHARE_DELETE mode, unlink will succeed, but the file
    4075              :          * will still show up in directory listing until the last handle is
    4076              :          * closed. To avoid confusing the lingering deleted file for a live
    4077              :          * WAL file that needs to be archived, rename it before deleting it.
    4078              :          *
    4079              :          * If another process holds the file open without FILE_SHARE_DELETE
    4080              :          * flag, rename will fail. We'll try again at the next checkpoint.
    4081              :          */
    4082              :         snprintf(newpath, MAXPGPATH, "%s.deleted", path);
    4083              :         if (rename(path, newpath) != 0)
    4084              :         {
    4085              :             ereport(LOG,
    4086              :                     (errcode_for_file_access(),
    4087              :                      errmsg("could not rename file \"%s\": %m",
    4088              :                             path)));
    4089              :             return;
    4090              :         }
    4091              :         rc = durable_unlink(newpath, LOG);
    4092              : #else
    4093         1179 :         rc = durable_unlink(path, LOG);
    4094              : #endif
    4095         1179 :         if (rc != 0)
    4096              :         {
    4097              :             /* Message already logged by durable_unlink() */
    4098            0 :             return;
    4099              :         }
    4100         1179 :         CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_removed++;
    4101              :     }
    4102              : 
    4103         2724 :     XLogArchiveCleanup(segname);
    4104              : }
    4105              : 
    4106              : /*
    4107              :  * Verify whether pg_wal, pg_wal/archive_status, and pg_wal/summaries exist.
    4108              :  * If the latter do not exist, recreate them.
    4109              :  *
    4110              :  * It is not the goal of this function to verify the contents of these
    4111              :  * directories, but to help in cases where someone has performed a cluster
    4112              :  * copy for PITR purposes but omitted pg_wal from the copy.
    4113              :  *
    4114              :  * We could also recreate pg_wal if it doesn't exist, but a deliberate
    4115              :  * policy decision was made not to.  It is fairly common for pg_wal to be
    4116              :  * a symlink, and if that was the DBA's intent then automatically making a
    4117              :  * plain directory would result in degraded performance with no notice.
    4118              :  */
    4119              : static void
    4120         1035 : ValidateXLOGDirectoryStructure(void)
    4121              : {
    4122              :     char        path[MAXPGPATH];
    4123              :     struct stat stat_buf;
    4124              : 
    4125              :     /* Check for pg_wal; if it doesn't exist, error out */
    4126         1035 :     if (stat(XLOGDIR, &stat_buf) != 0 ||
    4127         1035 :         !S_ISDIR(stat_buf.st_mode))
    4128            0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    4129              :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    4130              :                  errmsg("required WAL directory \"%s\" does not exist",
    4131              :                         XLOGDIR)));
    4132              : 
    4133              :     /* Check for archive_status */
    4134         1035 :     snprintf(path, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/archive_status");
    4135         1035 :     if (stat(path, &stat_buf) == 0)
    4136              :     {
    4137              :         /* Check for weird cases where it exists but isn't a directory */
    4138         1034 :         if (!S_ISDIR(stat_buf.st_mode))
    4139            0 :             ereport(FATAL,
    4140              :                     (errcode_for_file_access(),
    4141              :                      errmsg("required WAL directory \"%s\" does not exist",
    4142              :                             path)));
    4143              :     }
    4144              :     else
    4145              :     {
    4146            1 :         ereport(LOG,
    4147              :                 (errmsg("creating missing WAL directory \"%s\"", path)));
    4148            1 :         if (MakePGDirectory(path) < 0)
    4149            0 :             ereport(FATAL,
    4150              :                     (errcode_for_file_access(),
    4151              :                      errmsg("could not create missing directory \"%s\": %m",
    4152              :                             path)));
    4153              :     }
    4154              : 
    4155              :     /* Check for summaries */
    4156         1035 :     snprintf(path, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/summaries");
    4157         1035 :     if (stat(path, &stat_buf) == 0)
    4158              :     {
    4159              :         /* Check for weird cases where it exists but isn't a directory */
    4160         1034 :         if (!S_ISDIR(stat_buf.st_mode))
    4161            0 :             ereport(FATAL,
    4162              :                     (errmsg("required WAL directory \"%s\" does not exist",
    4163              :                             path)));
    4164              :     }
    4165              :     else
    4166              :     {
    4167            1 :         ereport(LOG,
    4168              :                 (errmsg("creating missing WAL directory \"%s\"", path)));
    4169            1 :         if (MakePGDirectory(path) < 0)
    4170            0 :             ereport(FATAL,
    4171              :                     (errmsg("could not create missing directory \"%s\": %m",
    4172              :                             path)));
    4173              :     }
    4174         1035 : }
    4175              : 
    4176              : /*
    4177              :  * Remove previous backup history files.  This also retries creation of
    4178              :  * .ready files for any backup history files for which XLogArchiveNotify
    4179              :  * failed earlier.
    4180              :  */
    4181              : static void
    4182          161 : CleanupBackupHistory(void)
    4183              : {
    4184              :     DIR        *xldir;
    4185              :     struct dirent *xlde;
    4186              :     char        path[MAXPGPATH + sizeof(XLOGDIR)];
    4187              : 
    4188          161 :     xldir = AllocateDir(XLOGDIR);
    4189              : 
    4190         1664 :     while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL)
    4191              :     {
    4192         1342 :         if (IsBackupHistoryFileName(xlde->d_name))
    4193              :         {
    4194          171 :             if (XLogArchiveCheckDone(xlde->d_name))
    4195              :             {
    4196          135 :                 elog(DEBUG2, "removing WAL backup history file \"%s\"",
    4197              :                      xlde->d_name);
    4198          135 :                 snprintf(path, sizeof(path), XLOGDIR "/%s", xlde->d_name);
    4199          135 :                 unlink(path);
    4200          135 :                 XLogArchiveCleanup(xlde->d_name);
    4201              :             }
    4202              :         }
    4203              :     }
    4204              : 
    4205          161 :     FreeDir(xldir);
    4206          161 : }
    4207              : 
    4208              : /*
    4209              :  * I/O routines for pg_control
    4210              :  *
    4211              :  * *ControlFile is a buffer in shared memory that holds an image of the
    4212              :  * contents of pg_control.  WriteControlFile() initializes pg_control
    4213              :  * given a preloaded buffer, ReadControlFile() loads the buffer from
    4214              :  * the pg_control file (during postmaster or standalone-backend startup),
    4215              :  * and UpdateControlFile() rewrites pg_control after we modify xlog state.
    4216              :  * InitControlFile() fills the buffer with initial values.
    4217              :  *
    4218              :  * For simplicity, WriteControlFile() initializes the fields of pg_control
    4219              :  * that are related to checking backend/database compatibility, and
    4220              :  * ReadControlFile() verifies they are correct.  We could split out the
    4221              :  * I/O and compatibility-check functions, but there seems no need currently.
    4222              :  */
    4223              : 
    4224              : static void
    4225           51 : InitControlFile(uint64 sysidentifier, uint32 data_checksum_version)
    4226              : {
    4227              :     char        mock_auth_nonce[MOCK_AUTH_NONCE_LEN];
    4228              : 
    4229              :     /*
    4230              :      * Generate a random nonce. This is used for authentication requests that
    4231              :      * will fail because the user does not exist. The nonce is used to create
    4232              :      * a genuine-looking password challenge for the non-existent user, in lieu
    4233              :      * of an actual stored password.
    4234              :      */
    4235           51 :     if (!pg_strong_random(mock_auth_nonce, MOCK_AUTH_NONCE_LEN))
    4236            0 :         ereport(PANIC,
    4237              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_INTERNAL_ERROR),
    4238              :                  errmsg("could not generate secret authorization token")));
    4239              : 
    4240           51 :     memset(ControlFile, 0, sizeof(ControlFileData));
    4241              :     /* Initialize pg_control status fields */
    4242           51 :     ControlFile->system_identifier = sysidentifier;
    4243           51 :     memcpy(ControlFile->mock_authentication_nonce, mock_auth_nonce, MOCK_AUTH_NONCE_LEN);
    4244           51 :     ControlFile->state = DB_SHUTDOWNED;
    4245           51 :     ControlFile->unloggedLSN = FirstNormalUnloggedLSN;
    4246              : 
    4247              :     /* Set important parameter values for use when replaying WAL */
    4248           51 :     ControlFile->MaxConnections = MaxConnections;
    4249           51 :     ControlFile->max_worker_processes = max_worker_processes;
    4250           51 :     ControlFile->max_wal_senders = max_wal_senders;
    4251           51 :     ControlFile->max_prepared_xacts = max_prepared_xacts;
    4252           51 :     ControlFile->max_locks_per_xact = max_locks_per_xact;
    4253           51 :     ControlFile->wal_level = wal_level;
    4254           51 :     ControlFile->wal_log_hints = wal_log_hints;
    4255           51 :     ControlFile->track_commit_timestamp = track_commit_timestamp;
    4256           51 :     ControlFile->data_checksum_version = data_checksum_version;
    4257           51 : }
    4258              : 
    4259              : static void
    4260           51 : WriteControlFile(void)
    4261              : {
    4262              :     int         fd;
    4263              :     char        buffer[PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE];   /* need not be aligned */
    4264              : 
    4265              :     /*
    4266              :      * Initialize version and compatibility-check fields
    4267              :      */
    4268           51 :     ControlFile->pg_control_version = PG_CONTROL_VERSION;
    4269           51 :     ControlFile->catalog_version_no = CATALOG_VERSION_NO;
    4270              : 
    4271           51 :     ControlFile->maxAlign = MAXIMUM_ALIGNOF;
    4272           51 :     ControlFile->floatFormat = FLOATFORMAT_VALUE;
    4273              : 
    4274           51 :     ControlFile->blcksz = BLCKSZ;
    4275           51 :     ControlFile->relseg_size = RELSEG_SIZE;
    4276           51 :     ControlFile->slru_pages_per_segment = SLRU_PAGES_PER_SEGMENT;
    4277           51 :     ControlFile->xlog_blcksz = XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    4278           51 :     ControlFile->xlog_seg_size = wal_segment_size;
    4279              : 
    4280           51 :     ControlFile->nameDataLen = NAMEDATALEN;
    4281           51 :     ControlFile->indexMaxKeys = INDEX_MAX_KEYS;
    4282              : 
    4283           51 :     ControlFile->toast_max_chunk_size = TOAST_MAX_CHUNK_SIZE;
    4284           51 :     ControlFile->loblksize = LOBLKSIZE;
    4285              : 
    4286           51 :     ControlFile->float8ByVal = true; /* vestigial */
    4287              : 
    4288              :     /*
    4289              :      * Initialize the default 'char' signedness.
    4290              :      *
    4291              :      * The signedness of the char type is implementation-defined. For instance
    4292              :      * on x86 architecture CPUs, the char data type is typically treated as
    4293              :      * signed by default, whereas on aarch architecture CPUs, it is typically
    4294              :      * treated as unsigned by default. In v17 or earlier, we accidentally let
    4295              :      * C implementation signedness affect persistent data. This led to
    4296              :      * inconsistent results when comparing char data across different
    4297              :      * platforms.
    4298              :      *
    4299              :      * This flag can be used as a hint to ensure consistent behavior for
    4300              :      * pre-v18 data files that store data sorted by the 'char' type on disk,
    4301              :      * especially in cross-platform replication scenarios.
    4302              :      *
    4303              :      * Newly created database clusters unconditionally set the default char
    4304              :      * signedness to true. pg_upgrade changes this flag for clusters that were
    4305              :      * initialized on signedness=false platforms. As a result,
    4306              :      * signedness=false setting will become rare over time. If we had known
    4307              :      * about this problem during the last development cycle that forced initdb
    4308              :      * (v8.3), we would have made all clusters signed or all clusters
    4309              :      * unsigned. Making pg_upgrade the only source of signedness=false will
    4310              :      * cause the population of database clusters to converge toward that
    4311              :      * retrospective ideal.
    4312              :      */
    4313           51 :     ControlFile->default_char_signedness = true;
    4314              : 
    4315              :     /* Contents are protected with a CRC */
    4316           51 :     INIT_CRC32C(ControlFile->crc);
    4317           51 :     COMP_CRC32C(ControlFile->crc,
    4318              :                 ControlFile,
    4319              :                 offsetof(ControlFileData, crc));
    4320           51 :     FIN_CRC32C(ControlFile->crc);
    4321              : 
    4322              :     /*
    4323              :      * We write out PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE bytes into pg_control, zero-padding
    4324              :      * the excess over sizeof(ControlFileData).  This reduces the odds of
    4325              :      * premature-EOF errors when reading pg_control.  We'll still fail when we
    4326              :      * check the contents of the file, but hopefully with a more specific
    4327              :      * error than "couldn't read pg_control".
    4328              :      */
    4329           51 :     memset(buffer, 0, PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE);
    4330           51 :     memcpy(buffer, ControlFile, sizeof(ControlFileData));
    4331              : 
    4332           51 :     fd = BasicOpenFile(XLOG_CONTROL_FILE,
    4333              :                        O_RDWR | O_CREAT | O_EXCL | PG_BINARY);
    4334           51 :     if (fd < 0)
    4335            0 :         ereport(PANIC,
    4336              :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    4337              :                  errmsg("could not create file \"%s\": %m",
    4338              :                         XLOG_CONTROL_FILE)));
    4339              : 
    4340           51 :     errno = 0;
    4341           51 :     pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_CONTROL_FILE_WRITE);
    4342           51 :     if (write(fd, buffer, PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE) != PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE)
    4343              :     {
    4344              :         /* if write didn't set errno, assume problem is no disk space */
    4345            0 :         if (errno == 0)
    4346            0 :             errno = ENOSPC;
    4347            0 :         ereport(PANIC,
    4348              :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    4349              :                  errmsg("could not write to file \"%s\": %m",
    4350              :                         XLOG_CONTROL_FILE)));
    4351              :     }
    4352           51 :     pgstat_report_wait_end();
    4353              : 
    4354           51 :     pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_CONTROL_FILE_SYNC);
    4355           51 :     if (pg_fsync(fd) != 0)
    4356            0 :         ereport(PANIC,
    4357              :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    4358              :                  errmsg("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m",
    4359              :                         XLOG_CONTROL_FILE)));
    4360           51 :     pgstat_report_wait_end();
    4361              : 
    4362           51 :     if (close(fd) != 0)
    4363            0 :         ereport(PANIC,
    4364              :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    4365              :                  errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m",
    4366              :                         XLOG_CONTROL_FILE)));
    4367           51 : }
    4368              : 
    4369              : static void
    4370         1094 : ReadControlFile(void)
    4371              : {
    4372              :     pg_crc32c   crc;
    4373              :     int         fd;
    4374              :     char        wal_segsz_str[20];
    4375              :     int         r;
    4376              : 
    4377              :     /*
    4378              :      * Read data...
    4379              :      */
    4380         1094 :     fd = BasicOpenFile(XLOG_CONTROL_FILE,
    4381              :                        O_RDWR | PG_BINARY);
    4382         1094 :     if (fd < 0)
    4383            0 :         ereport(PANIC,
    4384              :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    4385              :                  errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m",
    4386              :                         XLOG_CONTROL_FILE)));
    4387              : 
    4388         1094 :     pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_CONTROL_FILE_READ);
    4389         1094 :     r = read(fd, ControlFile, sizeof(ControlFileData));
    4390         1094 :     if (r != sizeof(ControlFileData))
    4391              :     {
    4392            0 :         if (r < 0)
    4393            0 :             ereport(PANIC,
    4394              :                     (errcode_for_file_access(),
    4395              :                      errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": %m",
    4396              :                             XLOG_CONTROL_FILE)));
    4397              :         else
    4398            0 :             ereport(PANIC,
    4399              :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_DATA_CORRUPTED),
    4400              :                      errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": read %d of %zu",
    4401              :                             XLOG_CONTROL_FILE, r, sizeof(ControlFileData))));
    4402              :     }
    4403         1094 :     pgstat_report_wait_end();
    4404              : 
    4405         1094 :     close(fd);
    4406              : 
    4407              :     /*
    4408              :      * Check for expected pg_control format version.  If this is wrong, the
    4409              :      * CRC check will likely fail because we'll be checking the wrong number
    4410              :      * of bytes.  Complaining about wrong version will probably be more
    4411              :      * enlightening than complaining about wrong CRC.
    4412              :      */
    4413              : 
    4414         1094 :     if (ControlFile->pg_control_version != PG_CONTROL_VERSION && ControlFile->pg_control_version % 65536 == 0 && ControlFile->pg_control_version / 65536 != 0)
    4415            0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    4416              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    4417              :                  errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
    4418              :                  errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with PG_CONTROL_VERSION %d (0x%08x),"
    4419              :                            " but the server was compiled with PG_CONTROL_VERSION %d (0x%08x).",
    4420              :                            ControlFile->pg_control_version, ControlFile->pg_control_version,
    4421              :                            PG_CONTROL_VERSION, PG_CONTROL_VERSION),
    4422              :                  errhint("This could be a problem of mismatched byte ordering.  It looks like you need to initdb.")));
    4423              : 
    4424         1094 :     if (ControlFile->pg_control_version != PG_CONTROL_VERSION)
    4425            0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    4426              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    4427              :                  errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
    4428              :                  errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with PG_CONTROL_VERSION %d,"
    4429              :                            " but the server was compiled with PG_CONTROL_VERSION %d.",
    4430              :                            ControlFile->pg_control_version, PG_CONTROL_VERSION),
    4431              :                  errhint("It looks like you need to initdb.")));
    4432              : 
    4433              :     /* Now check the CRC. */
    4434         1094 :     INIT_CRC32C(crc);
    4435         1094 :     COMP_CRC32C(crc,
    4436              :                 ControlFile,
    4437              :                 offsetof(ControlFileData, crc));
    4438         1094 :     FIN_CRC32C(crc);
    4439              : 
    4440         1094 :     if (!EQ_CRC32C(crc, ControlFile->crc))
    4441            0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    4442              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    4443              :                  errmsg("incorrect checksum in control file")));
    4444              : 
    4445              :     /*
    4446              :      * Do compatibility checking immediately.  If the database isn't
    4447              :      * compatible with the backend executable, we want to abort before we can
    4448              :      * possibly do any damage.
    4449              :      */
    4450         1094 :     if (ControlFile->catalog_version_no != CATALOG_VERSION_NO)
    4451            0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    4452              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    4453              :                  errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
    4454              :         /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
    4455              :                  errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
    4456              :                            " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
    4457              :                            "CATALOG_VERSION_NO", ControlFile->catalog_version_no,
    4458              :                            "CATALOG_VERSION_NO", CATALOG_VERSION_NO),
    4459              :                  errhint("It looks like you need to initdb.")));
    4460         1094 :     if (ControlFile->maxAlign != MAXIMUM_ALIGNOF)
    4461            0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    4462              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    4463              :                  errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
    4464              :         /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
    4465              :                  errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
    4466              :                            " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
    4467              :                            "MAXALIGN", ControlFile->maxAlign,
    4468              :                            "MAXALIGN", MAXIMUM_ALIGNOF),
    4469              :                  errhint("It looks like you need to initdb.")));
    4470         1094 :     if (ControlFile->floatFormat != FLOATFORMAT_VALUE)
    4471            0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    4472              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    4473              :                  errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
    4474              :                  errdetail("The database cluster appears to use a different floating-point number format than the server executable."),
    4475              :                  errhint("It looks like you need to initdb.")));
    4476         1094 :     if (ControlFile->blcksz != BLCKSZ)
    4477            0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    4478              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    4479              :                  errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
    4480              :         /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
    4481              :                  errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
    4482              :                            " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
    4483              :                            "BLCKSZ", ControlFile->blcksz,
    4484              :                            "BLCKSZ", BLCKSZ),
    4485              :                  errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
    4486         1094 :     if (ControlFile->relseg_size != RELSEG_SIZE)
    4487            0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    4488              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    4489              :                  errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
    4490              :         /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
    4491              :                  errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
    4492              :                            " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
    4493              :                            "RELSEG_SIZE", ControlFile->relseg_size,
    4494              :                            "RELSEG_SIZE", RELSEG_SIZE),
    4495              :                  errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
    4496         1094 :     if (ControlFile->slru_pages_per_segment != SLRU_PAGES_PER_SEGMENT)
    4497            0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    4498              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    4499              :                  errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
    4500              :         /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
    4501              :                  errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
    4502              :                            " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
    4503              :                            "SLRU_PAGES_PER_SEGMENT", ControlFile->slru_pages_per_segment,
    4504              :                            "SLRU_PAGES_PER_SEGMENT", SLRU_PAGES_PER_SEGMENT),
    4505              :                  errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
    4506         1094 :     if (ControlFile->xlog_blcksz != XLOG_BLCKSZ)
    4507            0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    4508              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    4509              :                  errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
    4510              :         /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
    4511              :                  errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
    4512              :                            " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
    4513              :                            "XLOG_BLCKSZ", ControlFile->xlog_blcksz,
    4514              :                            "XLOG_BLCKSZ", XLOG_BLCKSZ),
    4515              :                  errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
    4516         1094 :     if (ControlFile->nameDataLen != NAMEDATALEN)
    4517            0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    4518              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    4519              :                  errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
    4520              :         /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
    4521              :                  errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
    4522              :                            " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
    4523              :                            "NAMEDATALEN", ControlFile->nameDataLen,
    4524              :                            "NAMEDATALEN", NAMEDATALEN),
    4525              :                  errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
    4526         1094 :     if (ControlFile->indexMaxKeys != INDEX_MAX_KEYS)
    4527            0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    4528              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    4529              :                  errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
    4530              :         /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
    4531              :                  errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
    4532              :                            " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
    4533              :                            "INDEX_MAX_KEYS", ControlFile->indexMaxKeys,
    4534              :                            "INDEX_MAX_KEYS", INDEX_MAX_KEYS),
    4535              :                  errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
    4536         1094 :     if (ControlFile->toast_max_chunk_size != TOAST_MAX_CHUNK_SIZE)
    4537            0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    4538              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    4539              :                  errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
    4540              :         /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
    4541              :                  errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
    4542              :                            " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
    4543              :                            "TOAST_MAX_CHUNK_SIZE", ControlFile->toast_max_chunk_size,
    4544              :                            "TOAST_MAX_CHUNK_SIZE", (int) TOAST_MAX_CHUNK_SIZE),
    4545              :                  errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
    4546         1094 :     if (ControlFile->loblksize != LOBLKSIZE)
    4547            0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    4548              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    4549              :                  errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
    4550              :         /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
    4551              :                  errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
    4552              :                            " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
    4553              :                            "LOBLKSIZE", ControlFile->loblksize,
    4554              :                            "LOBLKSIZE", (int) LOBLKSIZE),
    4555              :                  errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
    4556              : 
    4557              :     Assert(ControlFile->float8ByVal);    /* vestigial, not worth an error msg */
    4558              : 
    4559         1094 :     wal_segment_size = ControlFile->xlog_seg_size;
    4560              : 
    4561         1094 :     if (!IsValidWalSegSize(wal_segment_size))
    4562            0 :         ereport(ERROR, (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE),
    4563              :                         errmsg_plural("invalid WAL segment size in control file (%d byte)",
    4564              :                                       "invalid WAL segment size in control file (%d bytes)",
    4565              :                                       wal_segment_size,
    4566              :                                       wal_segment_size),
    4567              :                         errdetail("The WAL segment size must be a power of two between 1 MB and 1 GB.")));
    4568              : 
    4569         1094 :     snprintf(wal_segsz_str, sizeof(wal_segsz_str), "%d", wal_segment_size);
    4570         1094 :     SetConfigOption("wal_segment_size", wal_segsz_str, PGC_INTERNAL,
    4571              :                     PGC_S_DYNAMIC_DEFAULT);
    4572              : 
    4573              :     /* check and update variables dependent on wal_segment_size */
    4574         1094 :     if (ConvertToXSegs(min_wal_size_mb, wal_segment_size) < 2)
    4575            0 :         ereport(ERROR, (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE),
    4576              :         /* translator: both %s are GUC names */
    4577              :                         errmsg("\"%s\" must be at least twice \"%s\"",
    4578              :                                "min_wal_size", "wal_segment_size")));
    4579              : 
    4580         1094 :     if (ConvertToXSegs(max_wal_size_mb, wal_segment_size) < 2)
    4581            0 :         ereport(ERROR, (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE),
    4582              :         /* translator: both %s are GUC names */
    4583              :                         errmsg("\"%s\" must be at least twice \"%s\"",
    4584              :                                "max_wal_size", "wal_segment_size")));
    4585              : 
    4586         1094 :     UsableBytesInSegment =
    4587         1094 :         (wal_segment_size / XLOG_BLCKSZ * UsableBytesInPage) -
    4588              :         (SizeOfXLogLongPHD - SizeOfXLogShortPHD);
    4589              : 
    4590         1094 :     CalculateCheckpointSegments();
    4591              : 
    4592              :     /* Make the initdb settings visible as GUC variables, too */
    4593         1094 :     SetConfigOption("data_checksums", DataChecksumsEnabled() ? "yes" : "no",
    4594              :                     PGC_INTERNAL, PGC_S_DYNAMIC_DEFAULT);
    4595         1094 : }
    4596              : 
    4597              : /*
    4598              :  * Utility wrapper to update the control file.  Note that the control
    4599              :  * file gets flushed.
    4600              :  */
    4601              : static void
    4602         9789 : UpdateControlFile(void)
    4603              : {
    4604         9789 :     update_controlfile(DataDir, ControlFile, true);
    4605         9789 : }
    4606              : 
    4607              : /*
    4608              :  * Returns the unique system identifier from control file.
    4609              :  */
    4610              : uint64
    4611         1542 : GetSystemIdentifier(void)
    4612              : {
    4613              :     Assert(ControlFile != NULL);
    4614         1542 :     return ControlFile->system_identifier;
    4615              : }
    4616              : 
    4617              : /*
    4618              :  * Returns the random nonce from control file.
    4619              :  */
    4620              : char *
    4621            2 : GetMockAuthenticationNonce(void)
    4622              : {
    4623              :     Assert(ControlFile != NULL);
    4624            2 :     return ControlFile->mock_authentication_nonce;
    4625              : }
    4626              : 
    4627              : /*
    4628              :  * Are checksums enabled for data pages?
    4629              :  */
    4630              : bool
    4631      2960466 : DataChecksumsEnabled(void)
    4632              : {
    4633              :     Assert(ControlFile != NULL);
    4634      2960466 :     return (ControlFile->data_checksum_version > 0);
    4635              : }
    4636              : 
    4637              : /*
    4638              :  * Return true if the cluster was initialized on a platform where the
    4639              :  * default signedness of char is "signed". This function exists for code
    4640              :  * that deals with pre-v18 data files that store data sorted by the 'char'
    4641              :  * type on disk (e.g., GIN and GiST indexes). See the comments in
    4642              :  * WriteControlFile() for details.
    4643              :  */
    4644              : bool
    4645            4 : GetDefaultCharSignedness(void)
    4646              : {
    4647            4 :     return ControlFile->default_char_signedness;
    4648              : }
    4649              : 
    4650              : /*
    4651              :  * Returns a fake LSN for unlogged relations.
    4652              :  *
    4653              :  * Each call generates an LSN that is greater than any previous value
    4654              :  * returned. The current counter value is saved and restored across clean
    4655              :  * shutdowns, but like unlogged relations, does not survive a crash. This can
    4656              :  * be used in lieu of real LSN values returned by XLogInsert, if you need an
    4657              :  * LSN-like increasing sequence of numbers without writing any WAL.
    4658              :  */
    4659              : XLogRecPtr
    4660       201460 : GetFakeLSNForUnloggedRel(void)
    4661              : {
    4662       201460 :     return pg_atomic_fetch_add_u64(&XLogCtl->unloggedLSN, 1);
    4663              : }
    4664              : 
    4665              : /*
    4666              :  * Auto-tune the number of XLOG buffers.
    4667              :  *
    4668              :  * The preferred setting for wal_buffers is about 3% of shared_buffers, with
    4669              :  * a maximum of one XLOG segment (there is little reason to think that more
    4670              :  * is helpful, at least so long as we force an fsync when switching log files)
    4671              :  * and a minimum of 8 blocks (which was the default value prior to PostgreSQL
    4672              :  * 9.1, when auto-tuning was added).
    4673              :  *
    4674              :  * This should not be called until NBuffers has received its final value.
    4675              :  */
    4676              : static int
    4677         1178 : XLOGChooseNumBuffers(void)
    4678              : {
    4679              :     int         xbuffers;
    4680              : 
    4681         1178 :     xbuffers = NBuffers / 32;
    4682         1178 :     if (xbuffers > (wal_segment_size / XLOG_BLCKSZ))
    4683           24 :         xbuffers = (wal_segment_size / XLOG_BLCKSZ);
    4684         1178 :     if (xbuffers < 8)
    4685          448 :         xbuffers = 8;
    4686         1178 :     return xbuffers;
    4687              : }
    4688              : 
    4689              : /*
    4690              :  * GUC check_hook for wal_buffers
    4691              :  */
    4692              : bool
    4693         2400 : check_wal_buffers(int *newval, void **extra, GucSource source)
    4694              : {
    4695              :     /*
    4696              :      * -1 indicates a request for auto-tune.
    4697              :      */
    4698         2400 :     if (*newval == -1)
    4699              :     {
    4700              :         /*
    4701              :          * If we haven't yet changed the boot_val default of -1, just let it
    4702              :          * be.  We'll fix it when XLOGShmemSize is called.
    4703              :          */
    4704         1222 :         if (XLOGbuffers == -1)
    4705         1222 :             return true;
    4706              : 
    4707              :         /* Otherwise, substitute the auto-tune value */
    4708            0 :         *newval = XLOGChooseNumBuffers();
    4709              :     }
    4710              : 
    4711              :     /*
    4712              :      * We clamp manually-set values to at least 4 blocks.  Prior to PostgreSQL
    4713              :      * 9.1, a minimum of 4 was enforced by guc.c, but since that is no longer
    4714              :      * the case, we just silently treat such values as a request for the
    4715              :      * minimum.  (We could throw an error instead, but that doesn't seem very
    4716              :      * helpful.)
    4717              :      */
    4718         1178 :     if (*newval < 4)
    4719            0 :         *newval = 4;
    4720              : 
    4721         1178 :     return true;
    4722              : }
    4723              : 
    4724              : /*
    4725              :  * GUC check_hook for wal_consistency_checking
    4726              :  */
    4727              : bool
    4728         2204 : check_wal_consistency_checking(char **newval, void **extra, GucSource source)
    4729              : {
    4730              :     char       *rawstring;
    4731              :     List       *elemlist;
    4732              :     ListCell   *l;
    4733              :     bool        newwalconsistency[RM_MAX_ID + 1];
    4734              : 
    4735              :     /* Initialize the array */
    4736        72732 :     MemSet(newwalconsistency, 0, (RM_MAX_ID + 1) * sizeof(bool));
    4737              : 
    4738              :     /* Need a modifiable copy of string */
    4739         2204 :     rawstring = pstrdup(*newval);
    4740              : 
    4741              :     /* Parse string into list of identifiers */
    4742         2204 :     if (!SplitIdentifierString(rawstring, ',', &elemlist))
    4743              :     {
    4744              :         /* syntax error in list */
    4745            0 :         GUC_check_errdetail("List syntax is invalid.");
    4746            0 :         pfree(rawstring);
    4747            0 :         list_free(elemlist);
    4748            0 :         return false;
    4749              :     }
    4750              : 
    4751         2698 :     foreach(l, elemlist)
    4752              :     {
    4753          494 :         char       *tok = (char *) lfirst(l);
    4754              :         int         rmid;
    4755              : 
    4756              :         /* Check for 'all'. */
    4757          494 :         if (pg_strcasecmp(tok, "all") == 0)
    4758              :         {
    4759       126444 :             for (rmid = 0; rmid <= RM_MAX_ID; rmid++)
    4760       125952 :                 if (RmgrIdExists(rmid) && GetRmgr(rmid).rm_mask != NULL)
    4761         4920 :                     newwalconsistency[rmid] = true;
    4762              :         }
    4763              :         else
    4764              :         {
    4765              :             /* Check if the token matches any known resource manager. */
    4766            2 :             bool        found = false;
    4767              : 
    4768           36 :             for (rmid = 0; rmid <= RM_MAX_ID; rmid++)
    4769              :             {
    4770           54 :                 if (RmgrIdExists(rmid) && GetRmgr(rmid).rm_mask != NULL &&
    4771           18 :                     pg_strcasecmp(tok, GetRmgr(rmid).rm_name) == 0)
    4772              :                 {
    4773            2 :                     newwalconsistency[rmid] = true;
    4774            2 :                     found = true;
    4775            2 :                     break;
    4776              :                 }
    4777              :             }
    4778            2 :             if (!found)
    4779              :             {
    4780              :                 /*
    4781              :                  * During startup, it might be a not-yet-loaded custom
    4782              :                  * resource manager.  Defer checking until
    4783              :                  * InitializeWalConsistencyChecking().
    4784              :                  */
    4785            0 :                 if (!process_shared_preload_libraries_done)
    4786              :                 {
    4787            0 :                     check_wal_consistency_checking_deferred = true;
    4788              :                 }
    4789              :                 else
    4790              :                 {
    4791            0 :                     GUC_check_errdetail("Unrecognized key word: \"%s\".", tok);
    4792            0 :                     pfree(rawstring);
    4793            0 :                     list_free(elemlist);
    4794            0 :                     return false;
    4795              :                 }
    4796              :             }
    4797              :         }
    4798              :     }
    4799              : 
    4800         2204 :     pfree(rawstring);
    4801         2204 :     list_free(elemlist);
    4802              : 
    4803              :     /* assign new value */
    4804         2204 :     *extra = guc_malloc(LOG, (RM_MAX_ID + 1) * sizeof(bool));
    4805         2204 :     if (!*extra)
    4806            0 :         return false;
    4807         2204 :     memcpy(*extra, newwalconsistency, (RM_MAX_ID + 1) * sizeof(bool));
    4808         2204 :     return true;
    4809              : }
    4810              : 
    4811              : /*
    4812              :  * GUC assign_hook for wal_consistency_checking
    4813              :  */
    4814              : void
    4815         2203 : assign_wal_consistency_checking(const char *newval, void *extra)
    4816              : {
    4817              :     /*
    4818              :      * If some checks were deferred, it's possible that the checks will fail
    4819              :      * later during InitializeWalConsistencyChecking(). But in that case, the
    4820              :      * postmaster will exit anyway, so it's safe to proceed with the
    4821              :      * assignment.
    4822              :      *
    4823              :      * Any built-in resource managers specified are assigned immediately,
    4824              :      * which affects WAL created before shared_preload_libraries are
    4825              :      * processed. Any custom resource managers specified won't be assigned
    4826              :      * until after shared_preload_libraries are processed, but that's OK
    4827              :      * because WAL for a custom resource manager can't be written before the
    4828              :      * module is loaded anyway.
    4829              :      */
    4830         2203 :     wal_consistency_checking = extra;
    4831         2203 : }
    4832              : 
    4833              : /*
    4834              :  * InitializeWalConsistencyChecking: run after loading custom resource managers
    4835              :  *
    4836              :  * If any unknown resource managers were specified in the
    4837              :  * wal_consistency_checking GUC, processing was deferred.  Now that
    4838              :  * shared_preload_libraries have been loaded, process wal_consistency_checking
    4839              :  * again.
    4840              :  */
    4841              : void
    4842         1025 : InitializeWalConsistencyChecking(void)
    4843              : {
    4844              :     Assert(process_shared_preload_libraries_done);
    4845              : 
    4846         1025 :     if (check_wal_consistency_checking_deferred)
    4847              :     {
    4848              :         struct config_generic *guc;
    4849              : 
    4850            0 :         guc = find_option("wal_consistency_checking", false, false, ERROR);
    4851              : 
    4852            0 :         check_wal_consistency_checking_deferred = false;
    4853              : 
    4854            0 :         set_config_option_ext("wal_consistency_checking",
    4855              :                               wal_consistency_checking_string,
    4856              :                               guc->scontext, guc->source, guc->srole,
    4857              :                               GUC_ACTION_SET, true, ERROR, false);
    4858              : 
    4859              :         /* checking should not be deferred again */
    4860              :         Assert(!check_wal_consistency_checking_deferred);
    4861              :     }
    4862         1025 : }
    4863              : 
    4864              : /*
    4865              :  * GUC show_hook for archive_command
    4866              :  */
    4867              : const char *
    4868         1900 : show_archive_command(void)
    4869              : {
    4870         1900 :     if (XLogArchivingActive())
    4871          106 :         return XLogArchiveCommand;
    4872              :     else
    4873         1794 :         return "(disabled)";
    4874              : }
    4875              : 
    4876              : /*
    4877              :  * GUC show_hook for in_hot_standby
    4878              :  */
    4879              : const char *
    4880        16590 : show_in_hot_standby(void)
    4881              : {
    4882              :     /*
    4883              :      * We display the actual state based on shared memory, so that this GUC
    4884              :      * reports up-to-date state if examined intra-query.  The underlying
    4885              :      * variable (in_hot_standby_guc) changes only when we transmit a new value
    4886              :      * to the client.
    4887              :      */
    4888        16590 :     return RecoveryInProgress() ? "on" : "off";
    4889              : }
    4890              : 
    4891              : /*
    4892              :  * GUC show_hook for effective_wal_level
    4893              :  */
    4894              : const char *
    4895         1933 : show_effective_wal_level(void)
    4896              : {
    4897         1933 :     if (wal_level == WAL_LEVEL_MINIMAL)
    4898          276 :         return "minimal";
    4899              : 
    4900              :     /*
    4901              :      * During recovery, effective_wal_level reflects the primary's
    4902              :      * configuration rather than the local wal_level value.
    4903              :      */
    4904         1657 :     if (RecoveryInProgress())
    4905           22 :         return IsXLogLogicalInfoEnabled() ? "logical" : "replica";
    4906              : 
    4907         1635 :     return XLogLogicalInfoActive() ? "logical" : "replica";
    4908              : }
    4909              : 
    4910              : /*
    4911              :  * Read the control file, set respective GUCs.
    4912              :  *
    4913              :  * This is to be called during startup, including a crash recovery cycle,
    4914              :  * unless in bootstrap mode, where no control file yet exists.  As there's no
    4915              :  * usable shared memory yet (its sizing can depend on the contents of the
    4916              :  * control file!), first store the contents in local memory. XLOGShmemInit()
    4917              :  * will then copy it to shared memory later.
    4918              :  *
    4919              :  * reset just controls whether previous contents are to be expected (in the
    4920              :  * reset case, there's a dangling pointer into old shared memory), or not.
    4921              :  */
    4922              : void
    4923         1043 : LocalProcessControlFile(bool reset)
    4924              : {
    4925              :     Assert(reset || ControlFile == NULL);
    4926         1043 :     ControlFile = palloc_object(ControlFileData);
    4927         1043 :     ReadControlFile();
    4928         1043 : }
    4929              : 
    4930              : /*
    4931              :  * Get the wal_level from the control file. For a standby, this value should be
    4932              :  * considered as its active wal_level, because it may be different from what
    4933              :  * was originally configured on standby.
    4934              :  */
    4935              : WalLevel
    4936            0 : GetActiveWalLevelOnStandby(void)
    4937              : {
    4938            0 :     return ControlFile->wal_level;
    4939              : }
    4940              : 
    4941              : /*
    4942              :  * Initialization of shared memory for XLOG
    4943              :  */
    4944              : Size
    4945         3387 : XLOGShmemSize(void)
    4946              : {
    4947              :     Size        size;
    4948              : 
    4949              :     /*
    4950              :      * If the value of wal_buffers is -1, use the preferred auto-tune value.
    4951              :      * This isn't an amazingly clean place to do this, but we must wait till
    4952              :      * NBuffers has received its final value, and must do it before using the
    4953              :      * value of XLOGbuffers to do anything important.
    4954              :      *
    4955              :      * We prefer to report this value's source as PGC_S_DYNAMIC_DEFAULT.
    4956              :      * However, if the DBA explicitly set wal_buffers = -1 in the config file,
    4957              :      * then PGC_S_DYNAMIC_DEFAULT will fail to override that and we must force
    4958              :      * the matter with PGC_S_OVERRIDE.
    4959              :      */
    4960         3387 :     if (XLOGbuffers == -1)
    4961              :     {
    4962              :         char        buf[32];
    4963              : 
    4964         1178 :         snprintf(buf, sizeof(buf), "%d", XLOGChooseNumBuffers());
    4965         1178 :         SetConfigOption("wal_buffers", buf, PGC_POSTMASTER,
    4966              :                         PGC_S_DYNAMIC_DEFAULT);
    4967         1178 :         if (XLOGbuffers == -1)  /* failed to apply it? */
    4968            0 :             SetConfigOption("wal_buffers", buf, PGC_POSTMASTER,
    4969              :                             PGC_S_OVERRIDE);
    4970              :     }
    4971              :     Assert(XLOGbuffers > 0);
    4972              : 
    4973              :     /* XLogCtl */
    4974         3387 :     size = sizeof(XLogCtlData);
    4975              : 
    4976              :     /* WAL insertion locks, plus alignment */
    4977         3387 :     size = add_size(size, mul_size(sizeof(WALInsertLockPadded), NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS + 1));
    4978              :     /* xlblocks array */
    4979         3387 :     size = add_size(size, mul_size(sizeof(pg_atomic_uint64), XLOGbuffers));
    4980              :     /* extra alignment padding for XLOG I/O buffers */
    4981         3387 :     size = add_size(size, Max(XLOG_BLCKSZ, PG_IO_ALIGN_SIZE));
    4982              :     /* and the buffers themselves */
    4983         3387 :     size = add_size(size, mul_size(XLOG_BLCKSZ, XLOGbuffers));
    4984              : 
    4985              :     /*
    4986              :      * Note: we don't count ControlFileData, it comes out of the "slop factor"
    4987              :      * added by CreateSharedMemoryAndSemaphores.  This lets us use this
    4988              :      * routine again below to compute the actual allocation size.
    4989              :      */
    4990              : 
    4991         3387 :     return size;
    4992              : }
    4993              : 
    4994              : void
    4995         1180 : XLOGShmemInit(void)
    4996              : {
    4997              :     bool        foundCFile,
    4998              :                 foundXLog;
    4999              :     char       *allocptr;
    5000              :     int         i;
    5001              :     ControlFileData *localControlFile;
    5002              : 
    5003              : #ifdef WAL_DEBUG
    5004              : 
    5005              :     /*
    5006              :      * Create a memory context for WAL debugging that's exempt from the normal
    5007              :      * "no pallocs in critical section" rule. Yes, that can lead to a PANIC if
    5008              :      * an allocation fails, but wal_debug is not for production use anyway.
    5009              :      */
    5010              :     if (walDebugCxt == NULL)
    5011              :     {
    5012              :         walDebugCxt = AllocSetContextCreate(TopMemoryContext,
    5013              :                                             "WAL Debug",
    5014              :                                             ALLOCSET_DEFAULT_SIZES);
    5015              :         MemoryContextAllowInCriticalSection(walDebugCxt, true);
    5016              :     }
    5017              : #endif
    5018              : 
    5019              : 
    5020         1180 :     XLogCtl = (XLogCtlData *)
    5021         1180 :         ShmemInitStruct("XLOG Ctl", XLOGShmemSize(), &foundXLog);
    5022              : 
    5023         1180 :     localControlFile = ControlFile;
    5024         1180 :     ControlFile = (ControlFileData *)
    5025         1180 :         ShmemInitStruct("Control File", sizeof(ControlFileData), &foundCFile);
    5026              : 
    5027         1180 :     if (foundCFile || foundXLog)
    5028              :     {
    5029              :         /* both should be present or neither */
    5030              :         Assert(foundCFile && foundXLog);
    5031              : 
    5032              :         /* Initialize local copy of WALInsertLocks */
    5033            0 :         WALInsertLocks = XLogCtl->Insert.WALInsertLocks;
    5034              : 
    5035            0 :         if (localControlFile)
    5036            0 :             pfree(localControlFile);
    5037            0 :         return;
    5038              :     }
    5039         1180 :     memset(XLogCtl, 0, sizeof(XLogCtlData));
    5040              : 
    5041              :     /*
    5042              :      * Already have read control file locally, unless in bootstrap mode. Move
    5043              :      * contents into shared memory.
    5044              :      */
    5045         1180 :     if (localControlFile)
    5046              :     {
    5047         1027 :         memcpy(ControlFile, localControlFile, sizeof(ControlFileData));
    5048         1027 :         pfree(localControlFile);
    5049              :     }
    5050              : 
    5051              :     /*
    5052              :      * Since XLogCtlData contains XLogRecPtr fields, its sizeof should be a
    5053              :      * multiple of the alignment for same, so no extra alignment padding is
    5054              :      * needed here.
    5055              :      */
    5056         1180 :     allocptr = ((char *) XLogCtl) + sizeof(XLogCtlData);
    5057         1180 :     XLogCtl->xlblocks = (pg_atomic_uint64 *) allocptr;
    5058         1180 :     allocptr += sizeof(pg_atomic_uint64) * XLOGbuffers;
    5059              : 
    5060       344289 :     for (i = 0; i < XLOGbuffers; i++)
    5061              :     {
    5062       343109 :         pg_atomic_init_u64(&XLogCtl->xlblocks[i], InvalidXLogRecPtr);
    5063              :     }
    5064              : 
    5065              :     /* WAL insertion locks. Ensure they're aligned to the full padded size */
    5066         1180 :     allocptr += sizeof(WALInsertLockPadded) -
    5067         1180 :         ((uintptr_t) allocptr) % sizeof(WALInsertLockPadded);
    5068         1180 :     WALInsertLocks = XLogCtl->Insert.WALInsertLocks =
    5069              :         (WALInsertLockPadded *) allocptr;
    5070         1180 :     allocptr += sizeof(WALInsertLockPadded) * NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS;
    5071              : 
    5072        10620 :     for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS; i++)
    5073              :     {
    5074         9440 :         LWLockInitialize(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock, LWTRANCHE_WAL_INSERT);
    5075         9440 :         pg_atomic_init_u64(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.insertingAt, InvalidXLogRecPtr);
    5076         9440 :         WALInsertLocks[i].l.lastImportantAt = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
    5077              :     }
    5078              : 
    5079              :     /*
    5080              :      * Align the start of the page buffers to a full xlog block size boundary.
    5081              :      * This simplifies some calculations in XLOG insertion. It is also
    5082              :      * required for O_DIRECT.
    5083              :      */
    5084         1180 :     allocptr = (char *) TYPEALIGN(XLOG_BLCKSZ, allocptr);
    5085         1180 :     XLogCtl->pages = allocptr;
    5086         1180 :     memset(XLogCtl->pages, 0, (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ * XLOGbuffers);
    5087              : 
    5088              :     /*
    5089              :      * Do basic initialization of XLogCtl shared data. (StartupXLOG will fill
    5090              :      * in additional info.)
    5091              :      */
    5092         1180 :     XLogCtl->XLogCacheBlck = XLOGbuffers - 1;
    5093         1180 :     XLogCtl->SharedRecoveryState = RECOVERY_STATE_CRASH;
    5094         1180 :     XLogCtl->InstallXLogFileSegmentActive = false;
    5095         1180 :     XLogCtl->WalWriterSleeping = false;
    5096              : 
    5097         1180 :     SpinLockInit(&XLogCtl->Insert.insertpos_lck);
    5098         1180 :     SpinLockInit(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    5099         1180 :     pg_atomic_init_u64(&XLogCtl->logInsertResult, InvalidXLogRecPtr);
    5100         1180 :     pg_atomic_init_u64(&XLogCtl->logWriteResult, InvalidXLogRecPtr);
    5101         1180 :     pg_atomic_init_u64(&XLogCtl->logFlushResult, InvalidXLogRecPtr);
    5102         1180 :     pg_atomic_init_u64(&XLogCtl->unloggedLSN, InvalidXLogRecPtr);
    5103              : }
    5104              : 
    5105              : /*
    5106              :  * This func must be called ONCE on system install.  It creates pg_control
    5107              :  * and the initial XLOG segment.
    5108              :  */
    5109              : void
    5110           51 : BootStrapXLOG(uint32 data_checksum_version)
    5111              : {
    5112              :     CheckPoint  checkPoint;
    5113              :     PGAlignedXLogBlock buffer;
    5114              :     XLogPageHeader page;
    5115              :     XLogLongPageHeader longpage;
    5116              :     XLogRecord *record;
    5117              :     char       *recptr;
    5118              :     uint64      sysidentifier;
    5119              :     struct timeval tv;
    5120              :     pg_crc32c   crc;
    5121              : 
    5122              :     /* allow ordinary WAL segment creation, like StartupXLOG() would */
    5123           51 :     SetInstallXLogFileSegmentActive();
    5124              : 
    5125              :     /*
    5126              :      * Select a hopefully-unique system identifier code for this installation.
    5127              :      * We use the result of gettimeofday(), including the fractional seconds
    5128              :      * field, as being about as unique as we can easily get.  (Think not to
    5129              :      * use random(), since it hasn't been seeded and there's no portable way
    5130              :      * to seed it other than the system clock value...)  The upper half of the
    5131              :      * uint64 value is just the tv_sec part, while the lower half contains the
    5132              :      * tv_usec part (which must fit in 20 bits), plus 12 bits from our current
    5133              :      * PID for a little extra uniqueness.  A person knowing this encoding can
    5134              :      * determine the initialization time of the installation, which could
    5135              :      * perhaps be useful sometimes.
    5136              :      */
    5137           51 :     gettimeofday(&tv, NULL);
    5138           51 :     sysidentifier = ((uint64) tv.tv_sec) << 32;
    5139           51 :     sysidentifier |= ((uint64) tv.tv_usec) << 12;
    5140           51 :     sysidentifier |= getpid() & 0xFFF;
    5141              : 
    5142           51 :     memset(&buffer, 0, sizeof buffer);
    5143           51 :     page = (XLogPageHeader) &buffer;
    5144              : 
    5145              :     /*
    5146              :      * Set up information for the initial checkpoint record
    5147              :      *
    5148              :      * The initial checkpoint record is written to the beginning of the WAL
    5149              :      * segment with logid=0 logseg=1. The very first WAL segment, 0/0, is not
    5150              :      * used, so that we can use 0/0 to mean "before any valid WAL segment".
    5151              :      */
    5152           51 :     checkPoint.redo = wal_segment_size + SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
    5153           51 :     checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID = BootstrapTimeLineID;
    5154           51 :     checkPoint.PrevTimeLineID = BootstrapTimeLineID;
    5155           51 :     checkPoint.fullPageWrites = fullPageWrites;
    5156           51 :     checkPoint.logicalDecodingEnabled = (wal_level == WAL_LEVEL_LOGICAL);
    5157           51 :     checkPoint.wal_level = wal_level;
    5158              :     checkPoint.nextXid =
    5159           51 :         FullTransactionIdFromEpochAndXid(0, FirstNormalTransactionId);
    5160           51 :     checkPoint.nextOid = FirstGenbkiObjectId;
    5161           51 :     checkPoint.nextMulti = FirstMultiXactId;
    5162           51 :     checkPoint.nextMultiOffset = 1;
    5163           51 :     checkPoint.oldestXid = FirstNormalTransactionId;
    5164           51 :     checkPoint.oldestXidDB = Template1DbOid;
    5165           51 :     checkPoint.oldestMulti = FirstMultiXactId;
    5166           51 :     checkPoint.oldestMultiDB = Template1DbOid;
    5167           51 :     checkPoint.oldestCommitTsXid = InvalidTransactionId;
    5168           51 :     checkPoint.newestCommitTsXid = InvalidTransactionId;
    5169           51 :     checkPoint.time = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
    5170           51 :     checkPoint.oldestActiveXid = InvalidTransactionId;
    5171              : 
    5172           51 :     TransamVariables->nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
    5173           51 :     TransamVariables->nextOid = checkPoint.nextOid;
    5174           51 :     TransamVariables->oidCount = 0;
    5175           51 :     MultiXactSetNextMXact(checkPoint.nextMulti, checkPoint.nextMultiOffset);
    5176           51 :     AdvanceOldestClogXid(checkPoint.oldestXid);
    5177           51 :     SetTransactionIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestXid, checkPoint.oldestXidDB);
    5178           51 :     SetMultiXactIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestMulti, checkPoint.oldestMultiDB);
    5179           51 :     SetCommitTsLimit(InvalidTransactionId, InvalidTransactionId);
    5180              : 
    5181              :     /* Set up the XLOG page header */
    5182           51 :     page->xlp_magic = XLOG_PAGE_MAGIC;
    5183           51 :     page->xlp_info = XLP_LONG_HEADER;
    5184           51 :     page->xlp_tli = BootstrapTimeLineID;
    5185           51 :     page->xlp_pageaddr = wal_segment_size;
    5186           51 :     longpage = (XLogLongPageHeader) page;
    5187           51 :     longpage->xlp_sysid = sysidentifier;
    5188           51 :     longpage->xlp_seg_size = wal_segment_size;
    5189           51 :     longpage->xlp_xlog_blcksz = XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    5190              : 
    5191              :     /* Insert the initial checkpoint record */
    5192           51 :     recptr = ((char *) page + SizeOfXLogLongPHD);
    5193           51 :     record = (XLogRecord *) recptr;
    5194           51 :     record->xl_prev = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
    5195           51 :     record->xl_xid = InvalidTransactionId;
    5196           51 :     record->xl_tot_len = SizeOfXLogRecord + SizeOfXLogRecordDataHeaderShort + sizeof(checkPoint);
    5197           51 :     record->xl_info = XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN;
    5198           51 :     record->xl_rmid = RM_XLOG_ID;
    5199           51 :     recptr += SizeOfXLogRecord;
    5200              :     /* fill the XLogRecordDataHeaderShort struct */
    5201           51 :     *(recptr++) = (char) XLR_BLOCK_ID_DATA_SHORT;
    5202           51 :     *(recptr++) = sizeof(checkPoint);
    5203           51 :     memcpy(recptr, &checkPoint, sizeof(checkPoint));
    5204           51 :     recptr += sizeof(checkPoint);
    5205              :     Assert(recptr - (char *) record == record->xl_tot_len);
    5206              : 
    5207           51 :     INIT_CRC32C(crc);
    5208           51 :     COMP_CRC32C(crc, ((char *) record) + SizeOfXLogRecord, record->xl_tot_len - SizeOfXLogRecord);
    5209           51 :     COMP_CRC32C(crc, (char *) record, offsetof(XLogRecord, xl_crc));
    5210           51 :     FIN_CRC32C(crc);
    5211           51 :     record->xl_crc = crc;
    5212              : 
    5213              :     /* Create first XLOG segment file */
    5214           51 :     openLogTLI = BootstrapTimeLineID;
    5215           51 :     openLogFile = XLogFileInit(1, BootstrapTimeLineID);
    5216              : 
    5217              :     /*
    5218              :      * We needn't bother with Reserve/ReleaseExternalFD here, since we'll
    5219              :      * close the file again in a moment.
    5220              :      */
    5221              : 
    5222              :     /* Write the first page with the initial record */
    5223           51 :     errno = 0;
    5224           51 :     pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_BOOTSTRAP_WRITE);
    5225           51 :     if (write(openLogFile, &buffer, XLOG_BLCKSZ) != XLOG_BLCKSZ)
    5226              :     {
    5227              :         /* if write didn't set errno, assume problem is no disk space */
    5228            0 :         if (errno == 0)
    5229            0 :             errno = ENOSPC;
    5230            0 :         ereport(PANIC,
    5231              :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    5232              :                  errmsg("could not write bootstrap write-ahead log file: %m")));
    5233              :     }
    5234           51 :     pgstat_report_wait_end();
    5235              : 
    5236           51 :     pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_BOOTSTRAP_SYNC);
    5237           51 :     if (pg_fsync(openLogFile) != 0)
    5238            0 :         ereport(PANIC,
    5239              :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    5240              :                  errmsg("could not fsync bootstrap write-ahead log file: %m")));
    5241           51 :     pgstat_report_wait_end();
    5242              : 
    5243           51 :     if (close(openLogFile) != 0)
    5244            0 :         ereport(PANIC,
    5245              :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    5246              :                  errmsg("could not close bootstrap write-ahead log file: %m")));
    5247              : 
    5248           51 :     openLogFile = -1;
    5249              : 
    5250              :     /* Now create pg_control */
    5251           51 :     InitControlFile(sysidentifier, data_checksum_version);
    5252           51 :     ControlFile->time = checkPoint.time;
    5253           51 :     ControlFile->checkPoint = checkPoint.redo;
    5254           51 :     ControlFile->checkPointCopy = checkPoint;
    5255              : 
    5256              :     /* some additional ControlFile fields are set in WriteControlFile() */
    5257           51 :     WriteControlFile();
    5258              : 
    5259              :     /* Bootstrap the commit log, too */
    5260           51 :     BootStrapCLOG();
    5261           51 :     BootStrapCommitTs();
    5262           51 :     BootStrapSUBTRANS();
    5263           51 :     BootStrapMultiXact();
    5264              : 
    5265              :     /*
    5266              :      * Force control file to be read - in contrast to normal processing we'd
    5267              :      * otherwise never run the checks and GUC related initializations therein.
    5268              :      */
    5269           51 :     ReadControlFile();
    5270           51 : }
    5271              : 
    5272              : static char *
    5273          923 : str_time(pg_time_t tnow, char *buf, size_t bufsize)
    5274              : {
    5275          923 :     pg_strftime(buf, bufsize,
    5276              :                 "%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S %Z",
    5277          923 :                 pg_localtime(&tnow, log_timezone));
    5278              : 
    5279          923 :     return buf;
    5280              : }
    5281              : 
    5282              : /*
    5283              :  * Initialize the first WAL segment on new timeline.
    5284              :  */
    5285              : static void
    5286           55 : XLogInitNewTimeline(TimeLineID endTLI, XLogRecPtr endOfLog, TimeLineID newTLI)
    5287              : {
    5288              :     char        xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
    5289              :     XLogSegNo   endLogSegNo;
    5290              :     XLogSegNo   startLogSegNo;
    5291              : 
    5292              :     /* we always switch to a new timeline after archive recovery */
    5293              :     Assert(endTLI != newTLI);
    5294              : 
    5295              :     /*
    5296              :      * Update min recovery point one last time.
    5297              :      */
    5298           55 :     UpdateMinRecoveryPoint(InvalidXLogRecPtr, true);
    5299              : 
    5300              :     /*
    5301              :      * Calculate the last segment on the old timeline, and the first segment
    5302              :      * on the new timeline. If the switch happens in the middle of a segment,
    5303              :      * they are the same, but if the switch happens exactly at a segment
    5304              :      * boundary, startLogSegNo will be endLogSegNo + 1.
    5305              :      */
    5306           55 :     XLByteToPrevSeg(endOfLog, endLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    5307           55 :     XLByteToSeg(endOfLog, startLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    5308              : 
    5309              :     /*
    5310              :      * Initialize the starting WAL segment for the new timeline. If the switch
    5311              :      * happens in the middle of a segment, copy data from the last WAL segment
    5312              :      * of the old timeline up to the switch point, to the starting WAL segment
    5313              :      * on the new timeline.
    5314              :      */
    5315           55 :     if (endLogSegNo == startLogSegNo)
    5316              :     {
    5317              :         /*
    5318              :          * Make a copy of the file on the new timeline.
    5319              :          *
    5320              :          * Writing WAL isn't allowed yet, so there are no locking
    5321              :          * considerations. But we should be just as tense as XLogFileInit to
    5322              :          * avoid emplacing a bogus file.
    5323              :          */
    5324           43 :         XLogFileCopy(newTLI, endLogSegNo, endTLI, endLogSegNo,
    5325           43 :                      XLogSegmentOffset(endOfLog, wal_segment_size));
    5326              :     }
    5327              :     else
    5328              :     {
    5329              :         /*
    5330              :          * The switch happened at a segment boundary, so just create the next
    5331              :          * segment on the new timeline.
    5332              :          */
    5333              :         int         fd;
    5334              : 
    5335           12 :         fd = XLogFileInit(startLogSegNo, newTLI);
    5336              : 
    5337           12 :         if (close(fd) != 0)
    5338              :         {
    5339            0 :             int         save_errno = errno;
    5340              : 
    5341            0 :             XLogFileName(xlogfname, newTLI, startLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    5342            0 :             errno = save_errno;
    5343            0 :             ereport(ERROR,
    5344              :                     (errcode_for_file_access(),
    5345              :                      errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", xlogfname)));
    5346              :         }
    5347              :     }
    5348              : 
    5349              :     /*
    5350              :      * Let's just make real sure there are not .ready or .done flags posted
    5351              :      * for the new segment.
    5352              :      */
    5353           55 :     XLogFileName(xlogfname, newTLI, startLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    5354           55 :     XLogArchiveCleanup(xlogfname);
    5355           55 : }
    5356              : 
    5357              : /*
    5358              :  * Perform cleanup actions at the conclusion of archive recovery.
    5359              :  */
    5360              : static void
    5361           55 : CleanupAfterArchiveRecovery(TimeLineID EndOfLogTLI, XLogRecPtr EndOfLog,
    5362              :                             TimeLineID newTLI)
    5363              : {
    5364              :     /*
    5365              :      * Execute the recovery_end_command, if any.
    5366              :      */
    5367           55 :     if (recoveryEndCommand && strcmp(recoveryEndCommand, "") != 0)
    5368            2 :         ExecuteRecoveryCommand(recoveryEndCommand,
    5369              :                                "recovery_end_command",
    5370              :                                true,
    5371              :                                WAIT_EVENT_RECOVERY_END_COMMAND);
    5372              : 
    5373              :     /*
    5374              :      * We switched to a new timeline. Clean up segments on the old timeline.
    5375              :      *
    5376              :      * If there are any higher-numbered segments on the old timeline, remove
    5377              :      * them. They might contain valid WAL, but they might also be
    5378              :      * pre-allocated files containing garbage. In any case, they are not part
    5379              :      * of the new timeline's history so we don't need them.
    5380              :      */
    5381           55 :     RemoveNonParentXlogFiles(EndOfLog, newTLI);
    5382              : 
    5383              :     /*
    5384              :      * If the switch happened in the middle of a segment, what to do with the
    5385              :      * last, partial segment on the old timeline? If we don't archive it, and
    5386              :      * the server that created the WAL never archives it either (e.g. because
    5387              :      * it was hit by a meteor), it will never make it to the archive. That's
    5388              :      * OK from our point of view, because the new segment that we created with
    5389              :      * the new TLI contains all the WAL from the old timeline up to the switch
    5390              :      * point. But if you later try to do PITR to the "missing" WAL on the old
    5391              :      * timeline, recovery won't find it in the archive. It's physically
    5392              :      * present in the new file with new TLI, but recovery won't look there
    5393              :      * when it's recovering to the older timeline. On the other hand, if we
    5394              :      * archive the partial segment, and the original server on that timeline
    5395              :      * is still running and archives the completed version of the same segment
    5396              :      * later, it will fail. (We used to do that in 9.4 and below, and it
    5397              :      * caused such problems).
    5398              :      *
    5399              :      * As a compromise, we rename the last segment with the .partial suffix,
    5400              :      * and archive it. Archive recovery will never try to read .partial
    5401              :      * segments, so they will normally go unused. But in the odd PITR case,
    5402              :      * the administrator can copy them manually to the pg_wal directory
    5403              :      * (removing the suffix). They can be useful in debugging, too.
    5404              :      *
    5405              :      * If a .done or .ready file already exists for the old timeline, however,
    5406              :      * we had already determined that the segment is complete, so we can let
    5407              :      * it be archived normally. (In particular, if it was restored from the
    5408              :      * archive to begin with, it's expected to have a .done file).
    5409              :      */
    5410           55 :     if (XLogSegmentOffset(EndOfLog, wal_segment_size) != 0 &&
    5411              :         XLogArchivingActive())
    5412              :     {
    5413              :         char        origfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
    5414              :         XLogSegNo   endLogSegNo;
    5415              : 
    5416            9 :         XLByteToPrevSeg(EndOfLog, endLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    5417            9 :         XLogFileName(origfname, EndOfLogTLI, endLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    5418              : 
    5419            9 :         if (!XLogArchiveIsReadyOrDone(origfname))
    5420              :         {
    5421              :             char        origpath[MAXPGPATH];
    5422              :             char        partialfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
    5423              :             char        partialpath[MAXPGPATH];
    5424              : 
    5425              :             /*
    5426              :              * If we're summarizing WAL, we can't rename the partial file
    5427              :              * until the summarizer finishes with it, else it will fail.
    5428              :              */
    5429            5 :             if (summarize_wal)
    5430            1 :                 WaitForWalSummarization(EndOfLog);
    5431              : 
    5432            5 :             XLogFilePath(origpath, EndOfLogTLI, endLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    5433            5 :             snprintf(partialfname, MAXFNAMELEN, "%s.partial", origfname);
    5434            5 :             snprintf(partialpath, MAXPGPATH, "%s.partial", origpath);
    5435              : 
    5436              :             /*
    5437              :              * Make sure there's no .done or .ready file for the .partial
    5438              :              * file.
    5439              :              */
    5440            5 :             XLogArchiveCleanup(partialfname);
    5441              : 
    5442            5 :             durable_rename(origpath, partialpath, ERROR);
    5443            5 :             XLogArchiveNotify(partialfname);
    5444              :         }
    5445              :     }
    5446           55 : }
    5447              : 
    5448              : /*
    5449              :  * Check to see if required parameters are set high enough on this server
    5450              :  * for various aspects of recovery operation.
    5451              :  *
    5452              :  * Note that all the parameters which this function tests need to be
    5453              :  * listed in Administrator's Overview section in high-availability.sgml.
    5454              :  * If you change them, don't forget to update the list.
    5455              :  */
    5456              : static void
    5457          262 : CheckRequiredParameterValues(void)
    5458              : {
    5459              :     /*
    5460              :      * For archive recovery, the WAL must be generated with at least 'replica'
    5461              :      * wal_level.
    5462              :      */
    5463          262 :     if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested && ControlFile->wal_level == WAL_LEVEL_MINIMAL)
    5464              :     {
    5465            2 :         ereport(FATAL,
    5466              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    5467              :                  errmsg("WAL was generated with \"wal_level=minimal\", cannot continue recovering"),
    5468              :                  errdetail("This happens if you temporarily set \"wal_level=minimal\" on the server."),
    5469              :                  errhint("Use a backup taken after setting \"wal_level\" to higher than \"minimal\".")));
    5470              :     }
    5471              : 
    5472              :     /*
    5473              :      * For Hot Standby, the WAL must be generated with 'replica' mode, and we
    5474              :      * must have at least as many backend slots as the primary.
    5475              :      */
    5476          260 :     if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested && EnableHotStandby)
    5477              :     {
    5478              :         /* We ignore autovacuum_worker_slots when we make this test. */
    5479          136 :         RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_connections",
    5480              :                                      MaxConnections,
    5481          136 :                                      ControlFile->MaxConnections);
    5482          136 :         RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_worker_processes",
    5483              :                                      max_worker_processes,
    5484          136 :                                      ControlFile->max_worker_processes);
    5485          136 :         RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_wal_senders",
    5486              :                                      max_wal_senders,
    5487          136 :                                      ControlFile->max_wal_senders);
    5488          136 :         RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_prepared_transactions",
    5489              :                                      max_prepared_xacts,
    5490          136 :                                      ControlFile->max_prepared_xacts);
    5491          136 :         RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_locks_per_transaction",
    5492              :                                      max_locks_per_xact,
    5493          136 :                                      ControlFile->max_locks_per_xact);
    5494              :     }
    5495          260 : }
    5496              : 
    5497              : /*
    5498              :  * This must be called ONCE during postmaster or standalone-backend startup
    5499              :  */
    5500              : void
    5501         1035 : StartupXLOG(void)
    5502              : {
    5503              :     XLogCtlInsert *Insert;
    5504              :     CheckPoint  checkPoint;
    5505              :     bool        wasShutdown;
    5506              :     bool        didCrash;
    5507              :     bool        haveTblspcMap;
    5508              :     bool        haveBackupLabel;
    5509              :     XLogRecPtr  EndOfLog;
    5510              :     TimeLineID  EndOfLogTLI;
    5511              :     TimeLineID  newTLI;
    5512              :     bool        performedWalRecovery;
    5513              :     EndOfWalRecoveryInfo *endOfRecoveryInfo;
    5514              :     XLogRecPtr  abortedRecPtr;
    5515              :     XLogRecPtr  missingContrecPtr;
    5516              :     TransactionId oldestActiveXID;
    5517         1035 :     bool        promoted = false;
    5518              :     char        timebuf[128];
    5519              : 
    5520              :     /*
    5521              :      * We should have an aux process resource owner to use, and we should not
    5522              :      * be in a transaction that's installed some other resowner.
    5523              :      */
    5524              :     Assert(AuxProcessResourceOwner != NULL);
    5525              :     Assert(CurrentResourceOwner == NULL ||
    5526              :            CurrentResourceOwner == AuxProcessResourceOwner);
    5527         1035 :     CurrentResourceOwner = AuxProcessResourceOwner;
    5528              : 
    5529              :     /*
    5530              :      * Check that contents look valid.
    5531              :      */
    5532         1035 :     if (!XRecOffIsValid(ControlFile->checkPoint))
    5533            0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    5534              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_DATA_CORRUPTED),
    5535              :                  errmsg("control file contains invalid checkpoint location")));
    5536              : 
    5537         1035 :     switch (ControlFile->state)
    5538              :     {
    5539          816 :         case DB_SHUTDOWNED:
    5540              : 
    5541              :             /*
    5542              :              * This is the expected case, so don't be chatty in standalone
    5543              :              * mode
    5544              :              */
    5545          816 :             ereport(IsPostmasterEnvironment ? LOG : NOTICE,
    5546              :                     (errmsg("database system was shut down at %s",
    5547              :                             str_time(ControlFile->time,
    5548              :                                      timebuf, sizeof(timebuf)))));
    5549          816 :             break;
    5550              : 
    5551           33 :         case DB_SHUTDOWNED_IN_RECOVERY:
    5552           33 :             ereport(LOG,
    5553              :                     (errmsg("database system was shut down in recovery at %s",
    5554              :                             str_time(ControlFile->time,
    5555              :                                      timebuf, sizeof(timebuf)))));
    5556           33 :             break;
    5557              : 
    5558            0 :         case DB_SHUTDOWNING:
    5559            0 :             ereport(LOG,
    5560              :                     (errmsg("database system shutdown was interrupted; last known up at %s",
    5561              :                             str_time(ControlFile->time,
    5562              :                                      timebuf, sizeof(timebuf)))));
    5563            0 :             break;
    5564              : 
    5565            0 :         case DB_IN_CRASH_RECOVERY:
    5566            0 :             ereport(LOG,
    5567              :                     (errmsg("database system was interrupted while in recovery at %s",
    5568              :                             str_time(ControlFile->time,
    5569              :                                      timebuf, sizeof(timebuf))),
    5570              :                      errhint("This probably means that some data is corrupted and"
    5571              :                              " you will have to use the last backup for recovery.")));
    5572            0 :             break;
    5573              : 
    5574            7 :         case DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY:
    5575            7 :             ereport(LOG,
    5576              :                     (errmsg("database system was interrupted while in recovery at log time %s",
    5577              :                             str_time(ControlFile->checkPointCopy.time,
    5578              :                                      timebuf, sizeof(timebuf))),
    5579              :                      errhint("If this has occurred more than once some data might be corrupted"
    5580              :                              " and you might need to choose an earlier recovery target.")));
    5581            7 :             break;
    5582              : 
    5583          179 :         case DB_IN_PRODUCTION:
    5584          179 :             ereport(LOG,
    5585              :                     (errmsg("database system was interrupted; last known up at %s",
    5586              :                             str_time(ControlFile->time,
    5587              :                                      timebuf, sizeof(timebuf)))));
    5588          179 :             break;
    5589              : 
    5590            0 :         default:
    5591            0 :             ereport(FATAL,
    5592              :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_DATA_CORRUPTED),
    5593              :                      errmsg("control file contains invalid database cluster state")));
    5594              :     }
    5595              : 
    5596              :     /* This is just to allow attaching to startup process with a debugger */
    5597              : #ifdef XLOG_REPLAY_DELAY
    5598              :     if (ControlFile->state != DB_SHUTDOWNED)
    5599              :         pg_usleep(60000000L);
    5600              : #endif
    5601              : 
    5602              :     /*
    5603              :      * Verify that pg_wal, pg_wal/archive_status, and pg_wal/summaries exist.
    5604              :      * In cases where someone has performed a copy for PITR, these directories
    5605              :      * may have been excluded and need to be re-created.
    5606              :      */
    5607         1035 :     ValidateXLOGDirectoryStructure();
    5608              : 
    5609              :     /* Set up timeout handler needed to report startup progress. */
    5610         1035 :     if (!IsBootstrapProcessingMode())
    5611          984 :         RegisterTimeout(STARTUP_PROGRESS_TIMEOUT,
    5612              :                         startup_progress_timeout_handler);
    5613              : 
    5614              :     /*----------
    5615              :      * If we previously crashed, perform a couple of actions:
    5616              :      *
    5617              :      * - The pg_wal directory may still include some temporary WAL segments
    5618              :      *   used when creating a new segment, so perform some clean up to not
    5619              :      *   bloat this path.  This is done first as there is no point to sync
    5620              :      *   this temporary data.
    5621              :      *
    5622              :      * - There might be data which we had written, intending to fsync it, but
    5623              :      *   which we had not actually fsync'd yet.  Therefore, a power failure in
    5624              :      *   the near future might cause earlier unflushed writes to be lost, even
    5625              :      *   though more recent data written to disk from here on would be
    5626              :      *   persisted.  To avoid that, fsync the entire data directory.
    5627              :      */
    5628         1035 :     if (ControlFile->state != DB_SHUTDOWNED &&
    5629          219 :         ControlFile->state != DB_SHUTDOWNED_IN_RECOVERY)
    5630              :     {
    5631          186 :         RemoveTempXlogFiles();
    5632          186 :         SyncDataDirectory();
    5633          186 :         didCrash = true;
    5634              :     }
    5635              :     else
    5636          849 :         didCrash = false;
    5637              : 
    5638              :     /*
    5639              :      * Prepare for WAL recovery if needed.
    5640              :      *
    5641              :      * InitWalRecovery analyzes the control file and the backup label file, if
    5642              :      * any.  It updates the in-memory ControlFile buffer according to the
    5643              :      * starting checkpoint, and sets InRecovery and ArchiveRecoveryRequested.
    5644              :      * It also applies the tablespace map file, if any.
    5645              :      */
    5646         1035 :     InitWalRecovery(ControlFile, &wasShutdown,
    5647              :                     &haveBackupLabel, &haveTblspcMap);
    5648         1033 :     checkPoint = ControlFile->checkPointCopy;
    5649              : 
    5650              :     /* initialize shared memory variables from the checkpoint record */
    5651         1033 :     TransamVariables->nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
    5652         1033 :     TransamVariables->nextOid = checkPoint.nextOid;
    5653         1033 :     TransamVariables->oidCount = 0;
    5654         1033 :     MultiXactSetNextMXact(checkPoint.nextMulti, checkPoint.nextMultiOffset);
    5655         1033 :     AdvanceOldestClogXid(checkPoint.oldestXid);
    5656         1033 :     SetTransactionIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestXid, checkPoint.oldestXidDB);
    5657         1033 :     SetMultiXactIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestMulti, checkPoint.oldestMultiDB);
    5658         1033 :     SetCommitTsLimit(checkPoint.oldestCommitTsXid,
    5659              :                      checkPoint.newestCommitTsXid);
    5660              : 
    5661              :     /*
    5662              :      * Clear out any old relcache cache files.  This is *necessary* if we do
    5663              :      * any WAL replay, since that would probably result in the cache files
    5664              :      * being out of sync with database reality.  In theory we could leave them
    5665              :      * in place if the database had been cleanly shut down, but it seems
    5666              :      * safest to just remove them always and let them be rebuilt during the
    5667              :      * first backend startup.  These files needs to be removed from all
    5668              :      * directories including pg_tblspc, however the symlinks are created only
    5669              :      * after reading tablespace_map file in case of archive recovery from
    5670              :      * backup, so needs to clear old relcache files here after creating
    5671              :      * symlinks.
    5672              :      */
    5673         1033 :     RelationCacheInitFileRemove();
    5674              : 
    5675              :     /*
    5676              :      * Initialize replication slots, before there's a chance to remove
    5677              :      * required resources.
    5678              :      */
    5679         1033 :     StartupReplicationSlots();
    5680              : 
    5681              :     /*
    5682              :      * Startup the logical decoding status with the last status stored in the
    5683              :      * checkpoint record.
    5684              :      */
    5685         1031 :     StartupLogicalDecodingStatus(checkPoint.logicalDecodingEnabled);
    5686              : 
    5687              :     /*
    5688              :      * Startup logical state, needs to be setup now so we have proper data
    5689              :      * during crash recovery.
    5690              :      */
    5691         1031 :     StartupReorderBuffer();
    5692              : 
    5693              :     /*
    5694              :      * Startup CLOG. This must be done after TransamVariables->nextXid has
    5695              :      * been initialized and before we accept connections or begin WAL replay.
    5696              :      */
    5697         1031 :     StartupCLOG();
    5698              : 
    5699              :     /*
    5700              :      * Startup MultiXact. We need to do this early to be able to replay
    5701              :      * truncations.
    5702              :      */
    5703         1031 :     StartupMultiXact();
    5704              : 
    5705              :     /*
    5706              :      * Ditto for commit timestamps.  Activate the facility if the setting is
    5707              :      * enabled in the control file, as there should be no tracking of commit
    5708              :      * timestamps done when the setting was disabled.  This facility can be
    5709              :      * started or stopped when replaying a XLOG_PARAMETER_CHANGE record.
    5710              :      */
    5711         1031 :     if (ControlFile->track_commit_timestamp)
    5712           14 :         StartupCommitTs();
    5713              : 
    5714              :     /*
    5715              :      * Recover knowledge about replay progress of known replication partners.
    5716              :      */
    5717         1031 :     StartupReplicationOrigin();
    5718              : 
    5719              :     /*
    5720              :      * Initialize unlogged LSN. On a clean shutdown, it's restored from the
    5721              :      * control file. On recovery, all unlogged relations are blown away, so
    5722              :      * the unlogged LSN counter can be reset too.
    5723              :      */
    5724         1031 :     if (ControlFile->state == DB_SHUTDOWNED)
    5725          807 :         pg_atomic_write_membarrier_u64(&XLogCtl->unloggedLSN,
    5726          807 :                                        ControlFile->unloggedLSN);
    5727              :     else
    5728          224 :         pg_atomic_write_membarrier_u64(&XLogCtl->unloggedLSN,
    5729              :                                        FirstNormalUnloggedLSN);
    5730              : 
    5731              :     /*
    5732              :      * Copy any missing timeline history files between 'now' and the recovery
    5733              :      * target timeline from archive to pg_wal. While we don't need those files
    5734              :      * ourselves - the history file of the recovery target timeline covers all
    5735              :      * the previous timelines in the history too - a cascading standby server
    5736              :      * might be interested in them. Or, if you archive the WAL from this
    5737              :      * server to a different archive than the primary, it'd be good for all
    5738              :      * the history files to get archived there after failover, so that you can
    5739              :      * use one of the old timelines as a PITR target. Timeline history files
    5740              :      * are small, so it's better to copy them unnecessarily than not copy them
    5741              :      * and regret later.
    5742              :      */
    5743         1031 :     restoreTimeLineHistoryFiles(checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID, recoveryTargetTLI);
    5744              : 
    5745              :     /*
    5746              :      * Before running in recovery, scan pg_twophase and fill in its status to
    5747              :      * be able to work on entries generated by redo.  Doing a scan before
    5748              :      * taking any recovery action has the merit to discard any 2PC files that
    5749              :      * are newer than the first record to replay, saving from any conflicts at
    5750              :      * replay.  This avoids as well any subsequent scans when doing recovery
    5751              :      * of the on-disk two-phase data.
    5752              :      */
    5753         1031 :     restoreTwoPhaseData();
    5754              : 
    5755              :     /*
    5756              :      * When starting with crash recovery, reset pgstat data - it might not be
    5757              :      * valid. Otherwise restore pgstat data. It's safe to do this here,
    5758              :      * because postmaster will not yet have started any other processes.
    5759              :      *
    5760              :      * NB: Restoring replication slot stats relies on slot state to have
    5761              :      * already been restored from disk.
    5762              :      *
    5763              :      * TODO: With a bit of extra work we could just start with a pgstat file
    5764              :      * associated with the checkpoint redo location we're starting from.
    5765              :      */
    5766         1031 :     if (didCrash)
    5767          184 :         pgstat_discard_stats();
    5768              :     else
    5769          847 :         pgstat_restore_stats();
    5770              : 
    5771         1031 :     lastFullPageWrites = checkPoint.fullPageWrites;
    5772              : 
    5773         1031 :     RedoRecPtr = XLogCtl->RedoRecPtr = XLogCtl->Insert.RedoRecPtr = checkPoint.redo;
    5774         1031 :     doPageWrites = lastFullPageWrites;
    5775              : 
    5776              :     /* REDO */
    5777         1031 :     if (InRecovery)
    5778              :     {
    5779              :         /* Initialize state for RecoveryInProgress() */
    5780          224 :         SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    5781          224 :         if (InArchiveRecovery)
    5782          122 :             XLogCtl->SharedRecoveryState = RECOVERY_STATE_ARCHIVE;
    5783              :         else
    5784          102 :             XLogCtl->SharedRecoveryState = RECOVERY_STATE_CRASH;
    5785          224 :         SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    5786              : 
    5787              :         /*
    5788              :          * Update pg_control to show that we are recovering and to show the
    5789              :          * selected checkpoint as the place we are starting from. We also mark
    5790              :          * pg_control with any minimum recovery stop point obtained from a
    5791              :          * backup history file.
    5792              :          *
    5793              :          * No need to hold ControlFileLock yet, we aren't up far enough.
    5794              :          */
    5795          224 :         UpdateControlFile();
    5796              : 
    5797              :         /*
    5798              :          * If there was a backup label file, it's done its job and the info
    5799              :          * has now been propagated into pg_control.  We must get rid of the
    5800              :          * label file so that if we crash during recovery, we'll pick up at
    5801              :          * the latest recovery restartpoint instead of going all the way back
    5802              :          * to the backup start point.  It seems prudent though to just rename
    5803              :          * the file out of the way rather than delete it completely.
    5804              :          */
    5805          224 :         if (haveBackupLabel)
    5806              :         {
    5807           80 :             unlink(BACKUP_LABEL_OLD);
    5808           80 :             durable_rename(BACKUP_LABEL_FILE, BACKUP_LABEL_OLD, FATAL);
    5809              :         }
    5810              : 
    5811              :         /*
    5812              :          * If there was a tablespace_map file, it's done its job and the
    5813              :          * symlinks have been created.  We must get rid of the map file so
    5814              :          * that if we crash during recovery, we don't create symlinks again.
    5815              :          * It seems prudent though to just rename the file out of the way
    5816              :          * rather than delete it completely.
    5817              :          */
    5818          224 :         if (haveTblspcMap)
    5819              :         {
    5820            2 :             unlink(TABLESPACE_MAP_OLD);
    5821            2 :             durable_rename(TABLESPACE_MAP, TABLESPACE_MAP_OLD, FATAL);
    5822              :         }
    5823              : 
    5824              :         /*
    5825              :          * Initialize our local copy of minRecoveryPoint.  When doing crash
    5826              :          * recovery we want to replay up to the end of WAL.  Particularly, in
    5827              :          * the case of a promoted standby minRecoveryPoint value in the
    5828              :          * control file is only updated after the first checkpoint.  However,
    5829              :          * if the instance crashes before the first post-recovery checkpoint
    5830              :          * is completed then recovery will use a stale location causing the
    5831              :          * startup process to think that there are still invalid page
    5832              :          * references when checking for data consistency.
    5833              :          */
    5834          224 :         if (InArchiveRecovery)
    5835              :         {
    5836          122 :             LocalMinRecoveryPoint = ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint;
    5837          122 :             LocalMinRecoveryPointTLI = ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI;
    5838              :         }
    5839              :         else
    5840              :         {
    5841          102 :             LocalMinRecoveryPoint = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
    5842          102 :             LocalMinRecoveryPointTLI = 0;
    5843              :         }
    5844              : 
    5845              :         /* Check that the GUCs used to generate the WAL allow recovery */
    5846          224 :         CheckRequiredParameterValues();
    5847              : 
    5848              :         /*
    5849              :          * We're in recovery, so unlogged relations may be trashed and must be
    5850              :          * reset.  This should be done BEFORE allowing Hot Standby
    5851              :          * connections, so that read-only backends don't try to read whatever
    5852              :          * garbage is left over from before.
    5853              :          */
    5854          224 :         ResetUnloggedRelations(UNLOGGED_RELATION_CLEANUP);
    5855              : 
    5856              :         /*
    5857              :          * Likewise, delete any saved transaction snapshot files that got left
    5858              :          * behind by crashed backends.
    5859              :          */
    5860          224 :         DeleteAllExportedSnapshotFiles();
    5861              : 
    5862              :         /*
    5863              :          * Initialize for Hot Standby, if enabled. We won't let backends in
    5864              :          * yet, not until we've reached the min recovery point specified in
    5865              :          * control file and we've established a recovery snapshot from a
    5866              :          * running-xacts WAL record.
    5867              :          */
    5868          224 :         if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested && EnableHotStandby)
    5869              :         {
    5870              :             TransactionId *xids;
    5871              :             int         nxids;
    5872              : 
    5873          114 :             ereport(DEBUG1,
    5874              :                     (errmsg_internal("initializing for hot standby")));
    5875              : 
    5876          114 :             InitRecoveryTransactionEnvironment();
    5877              : 
    5878          114 :             if (wasShutdown)
    5879           26 :                 oldestActiveXID = PrescanPreparedTransactions(&xids, &nxids);
    5880              :             else
    5881           88 :                 oldestActiveXID = checkPoint.oldestActiveXid;
    5882              :             Assert(TransactionIdIsValid(oldestActiveXID));
    5883              : 
    5884              :             /* Tell procarray about the range of xids it has to deal with */
    5885          114 :             ProcArrayInitRecovery(XidFromFullTransactionId(TransamVariables->nextXid));
    5886              : 
    5887              :             /*
    5888              :              * Startup subtrans only.  CLOG, MultiXact and commit timestamp
    5889              :              * have already been started up and other SLRUs are not maintained
    5890              :              * during recovery and need not be started yet.
    5891              :              */
    5892          114 :             StartupSUBTRANS(oldestActiveXID);
    5893              : 
    5894              :             /*
    5895              :              * If we're beginning at a shutdown checkpoint, we know that
    5896              :              * nothing was running on the primary at this point. So fake-up an
    5897              :              * empty running-xacts record and use that here and now. Recover
    5898              :              * additional standby state for prepared transactions.
    5899              :              */
    5900          114 :             if (wasShutdown)
    5901              :             {
    5902              :                 RunningTransactionsData running;
    5903              :                 TransactionId latestCompletedXid;
    5904              : 
    5905              :                 /* Update pg_subtrans entries for any prepared transactions */
    5906           26 :                 StandbyRecoverPreparedTransactions();
    5907              : 
    5908              :                 /*
    5909              :                  * Construct a RunningTransactions snapshot representing a
    5910              :                  * shut down server, with only prepared transactions still
    5911              :                  * alive. We're never overflowed at this point because all
    5912              :                  * subxids are listed with their parent prepared transactions.
    5913              :                  */
    5914           26 :                 running.xcnt = nxids;
    5915           26 :                 running.subxcnt = 0;
    5916           26 :                 running.subxid_status = SUBXIDS_IN_SUBTRANS;
    5917           26 :                 running.nextXid = XidFromFullTransactionId(checkPoint.nextXid);
    5918           26 :                 running.oldestRunningXid = oldestActiveXID;
    5919           26 :                 latestCompletedXid = XidFromFullTransactionId(checkPoint.nextXid);
    5920           26 :                 TransactionIdRetreat(latestCompletedXid);
    5921              :                 Assert(TransactionIdIsNormal(latestCompletedXid));
    5922           26 :                 running.latestCompletedXid = latestCompletedXid;
    5923           26 :                 running.xids = xids;
    5924              : 
    5925           26 :                 ProcArrayApplyRecoveryInfo(&running);
    5926              :             }
    5927              :         }
    5928              : 
    5929              :         /*
    5930              :          * We're all set for replaying the WAL now. Do it.
    5931              :          */
    5932          224 :         PerformWalRecovery();
    5933          163 :         performedWalRecovery = true;
    5934              :     }
    5935              :     else
    5936          807 :         performedWalRecovery = false;
    5937              : 
    5938              :     /*
    5939              :      * Finish WAL recovery.
    5940              :      */
    5941          970 :     endOfRecoveryInfo = FinishWalRecovery();
    5942          970 :     EndOfLog = endOfRecoveryInfo->endOfLog;
    5943          970 :     EndOfLogTLI = endOfRecoveryInfo->endOfLogTLI;
    5944          970 :     abortedRecPtr = endOfRecoveryInfo->abortedRecPtr;
    5945          970 :     missingContrecPtr = endOfRecoveryInfo->missingContrecPtr;
    5946              : 
    5947              :     /*
    5948              :      * Reset ps status display, so as no information related to recovery shows
    5949              :      * up.
    5950              :      */
    5951          970 :     set_ps_display("");
    5952              : 
    5953              :     /*
    5954              :      * When recovering from a backup (we are in recovery, and archive recovery
    5955              :      * was requested), complain if we did not roll forward far enough to reach
    5956              :      * the point where the database is consistent.  For regular online
    5957              :      * backup-from-primary, that means reaching the end-of-backup WAL record
    5958              :      * (at which point we reset backupStartPoint to be Invalid), for
    5959              :      * backup-from-replica (which can't inject records into the WAL stream),
    5960              :      * that point is when we reach the minRecoveryPoint in pg_control (which
    5961              :      * we purposefully copy last when backing up from a replica).  For
    5962              :      * pg_rewind (which creates a backup_label with a method of "pg_rewind")
    5963              :      * or snapshot-style backups (which don't), backupEndRequired will be set
    5964              :      * to false.
    5965              :      *
    5966              :      * Note: it is indeed okay to look at the local variable
    5967              :      * LocalMinRecoveryPoint here, even though ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint
    5968              :      * might be further ahead --- ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint cannot have
    5969              :      * been advanced beyond the WAL we processed.
    5970              :      */
    5971          970 :     if (InRecovery &&
    5972          163 :         (EndOfLog < LocalMinRecoveryPoint ||
    5973          163 :          XLogRecPtrIsValid(ControlFile->backupStartPoint)))
    5974              :     {
    5975              :         /*
    5976              :          * Ran off end of WAL before reaching end-of-backup WAL record, or
    5977              :          * minRecoveryPoint. That's a bad sign, indicating that you tried to
    5978              :          * recover from an online backup but never called pg_backup_stop(), or
    5979              :          * you didn't archive all the WAL needed.
    5980              :          */
    5981            0 :         if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested || ControlFile->backupEndRequired)
    5982              :         {
    5983            0 :             if (XLogRecPtrIsValid(ControlFile->backupStartPoint) || ControlFile->backupEndRequired)
    5984            0 :                 ereport(FATAL,
    5985              :                         (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    5986              :                          errmsg("WAL ends before end of online backup"),
    5987              :                          errhint("All WAL generated while online backup was taken must be available at recovery.")));
    5988              :             else
    5989            0 :                 ereport(FATAL,
    5990              :                         (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    5991              :                          errmsg("WAL ends before consistent recovery point")));
    5992              :         }
    5993              :     }
    5994              : 
    5995              :     /*
    5996              :      * Reset unlogged relations to the contents of their INIT fork. This is
    5997              :      * done AFTER recovery is complete so as to include any unlogged relations
    5998              :      * created during recovery, but BEFORE recovery is marked as having
    5999              :      * completed successfully. Otherwise we'd not retry if any of the post
    6000              :      * end-of-recovery steps fail.
    6001              :      */
    6002          970 :     if (InRecovery)
    6003          163 :         ResetUnloggedRelations(UNLOGGED_RELATION_INIT);
    6004              : 
    6005              :     /*
    6006              :      * Pre-scan prepared transactions to find out the range of XIDs present.
    6007              :      * This information is not quite needed yet, but it is positioned here so
    6008              :      * as potential problems are detected before any on-disk change is done.
    6009              :      */
    6010          970 :     oldestActiveXID = PrescanPreparedTransactions(NULL, NULL);
    6011              : 
    6012              :     /*
    6013              :      * Allow ordinary WAL segment creation before possibly switching to a new
    6014              :      * timeline, which creates a new segment, and after the last ReadRecord().
    6015              :      */
    6016          970 :     SetInstallXLogFileSegmentActive();
    6017              : 
    6018              :     /*
    6019              :      * Consider whether we need to assign a new timeline ID.
    6020              :      *
    6021              :      * If we did archive recovery, we always assign a new ID.  This handles a
    6022              :      * couple of issues.  If we stopped short of the end of WAL during
    6023              :      * recovery, then we are clearly generating a new timeline and must assign
    6024              :      * it a unique new ID.  Even if we ran to the end, modifying the current
    6025              :      * last segment is problematic because it may result in trying to
    6026              :      * overwrite an already-archived copy of that segment, and we encourage
    6027              :      * DBAs to make their archive_commands reject that.  We can dodge the
    6028              :      * problem by making the new active segment have a new timeline ID.
    6029              :      *
    6030              :      * In a normal crash recovery, we can just extend the timeline we were in.
    6031              :      */
    6032          970 :     newTLI = endOfRecoveryInfo->lastRecTLI;
    6033          970 :     if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested)
    6034              :     {
    6035           55 :         newTLI = findNewestTimeLine(recoveryTargetTLI) + 1;
    6036           55 :         ereport(LOG,
    6037              :                 (errmsg("selected new timeline ID: %u", newTLI)));
    6038              : 
    6039              :         /*
    6040              :          * Make a writable copy of the last WAL segment.  (Note that we also
    6041              :          * have a copy of the last block of the old WAL in
    6042              :          * endOfRecovery->lastPage; we will use that below.)
    6043              :          */
    6044           55 :         XLogInitNewTimeline(EndOfLogTLI, EndOfLog, newTLI);
    6045              : 
    6046              :         /*
    6047              :          * Remove the signal files out of the way, so that we don't
    6048              :          * accidentally re-enter archive recovery mode in a subsequent crash.
    6049              :          */
    6050           55 :         if (endOfRecoveryInfo->standby_signal_file_found)
    6051           52 :             durable_unlink(STANDBY_SIGNAL_FILE, FATAL);
    6052              : 
    6053           55 :         if (endOfRecoveryInfo->recovery_signal_file_found)
    6054            4 :             durable_unlink(RECOVERY_SIGNAL_FILE, FATAL);
    6055              : 
    6056              :         /*
    6057              :          * Write the timeline history file, and have it archived. After this
    6058              :          * point (or rather, as soon as the file is archived), the timeline
    6059              :          * will appear as "taken" in the WAL archive and to any standby
    6060              :          * servers.  If we crash before actually switching to the new
    6061              :          * timeline, standby servers will nevertheless think that we switched
    6062              :          * to the new timeline, and will try to connect to the new timeline.
    6063              :          * To minimize the window for that, try to do as little as possible
    6064              :          * between here and writing the end-of-recovery record.
    6065              :          */
    6066           55 :         writeTimeLineHistory(newTLI, recoveryTargetTLI,
    6067              :                              EndOfLog, endOfRecoveryInfo->recoveryStopReason);
    6068              : 
    6069           55 :         ereport(LOG,
    6070              :                 (errmsg("archive recovery complete")));
    6071              :     }
    6072              : 
    6073              :     /* Save the selected TimeLineID in shared memory, too */
    6074          970 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    6075          970 :     XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID = newTLI;
    6076          970 :     XLogCtl->PrevTimeLineID = endOfRecoveryInfo->lastRecTLI;
    6077          970 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    6078              : 
    6079              :     /*
    6080              :      * Actually, if WAL ended in an incomplete record, skip the parts that
    6081              :      * made it through and start writing after the portion that persisted.
    6082              :      * (It's critical to first write an OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD message, which
    6083              :      * we'll do as soon as we're open for writing new WAL.)
    6084              :      */
    6085          970 :     if (XLogRecPtrIsValid(missingContrecPtr))
    6086              :     {
    6087              :         /*
    6088              :          * We should only have a missingContrecPtr if we're not switching to a
    6089              :          * new timeline. When a timeline switch occurs, WAL is copied from the
    6090              :          * old timeline to the new only up to the end of the last complete
    6091              :          * record, so there can't be an incomplete WAL record that we need to
    6092              :          * disregard.
    6093              :          */
    6094              :         Assert(newTLI == endOfRecoveryInfo->lastRecTLI);
    6095              :         Assert(XLogRecPtrIsValid(abortedRecPtr));
    6096           10 :         EndOfLog = missingContrecPtr;
    6097              :     }
    6098              : 
    6099              :     /*
    6100              :      * Prepare to write WAL starting at EndOfLog location, and init xlog
    6101              :      * buffer cache using the block containing the last record from the
    6102              :      * previous incarnation.
    6103              :      */
    6104          970 :     Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert;
    6105          970 :     Insert->PrevBytePos = XLogRecPtrToBytePos(endOfRecoveryInfo->lastRec);
    6106          970 :     Insert->CurrBytePos = XLogRecPtrToBytePos(EndOfLog);
    6107              : 
    6108              :     /*
    6109              :      * Tricky point here: lastPage contains the *last* block that the LastRec
    6110              :      * record spans, not the one it starts in.  The last block is indeed the
    6111              :      * one we want to use.
    6112              :      */
    6113          970 :     if (EndOfLog % XLOG_BLCKSZ != 0)
    6114              :     {
    6115              :         char       *page;
    6116              :         int         len;
    6117              :         int         firstIdx;
    6118              : 
    6119          938 :         firstIdx = XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(EndOfLog);
    6120          938 :         len = EndOfLog - endOfRecoveryInfo->lastPageBeginPtr;
    6121              :         Assert(len < XLOG_BLCKSZ);
    6122              : 
    6123              :         /* Copy the valid part of the last block, and zero the rest */
    6124          938 :         page = &XLogCtl->pages[firstIdx * XLOG_BLCKSZ];
    6125          938 :         memcpy(page, endOfRecoveryInfo->lastPage, len);
    6126          938 :         memset(page + len, 0, XLOG_BLCKSZ - len);
    6127              : 
    6128          938 :         pg_atomic_write_u64(&XLogCtl->xlblocks[firstIdx], endOfRecoveryInfo->lastPageBeginPtr + XLOG_BLCKSZ);
    6129          938 :         XLogCtl->InitializedUpTo = endOfRecoveryInfo->lastPageBeginPtr + XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    6130              :     }
    6131              :     else
    6132              :     {
    6133              :         /*
    6134              :          * There is no partial block to copy. Just set InitializedUpTo, and
    6135              :          * let the first attempt to insert a log record to initialize the next
    6136              :          * buffer.
    6137              :          */
    6138           32 :         XLogCtl->InitializedUpTo = EndOfLog;
    6139              :     }
    6140              : 
    6141              :     /*
    6142              :      * Update local and shared status.  This is OK to do without any locks
    6143              :      * because no other process can be reading or writing WAL yet.
    6144              :      */
    6145          970 :     LogwrtResult.Write = LogwrtResult.Flush = EndOfLog;
    6146          970 :     pg_atomic_write_u64(&XLogCtl->logInsertResult, EndOfLog);
    6147          970 :     pg_atomic_write_u64(&XLogCtl->logWriteResult, EndOfLog);
    6148          970 :     pg_atomic_write_u64(&XLogCtl->logFlushResult, EndOfLog);
    6149          970 :     XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write = EndOfLog;
    6150          970 :     XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Flush = EndOfLog;
    6151              : 
    6152              :     /*
    6153              :      * Preallocate additional log files, if wanted.
    6154              :      */
    6155          970 :     PreallocXlogFiles(EndOfLog, newTLI);
    6156              : 
    6157              :     /*
    6158              :      * Okay, we're officially UP.
    6159              :      */
    6160          970 :     InRecovery = false;
    6161              : 
    6162              :     /* start the archive_timeout timer and LSN running */
    6163          970 :     XLogCtl->lastSegSwitchTime = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
    6164          970 :     XLogCtl->lastSegSwitchLSN = EndOfLog;
    6165              : 
    6166              :     /* also initialize latestCompletedXid, to nextXid - 1 */
    6167          970 :     LWLockAcquire(ProcArrayLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    6168          970 :     TransamVariables->latestCompletedXid = TransamVariables->nextXid;
    6169          970 :     FullTransactionIdRetreat(&TransamVariables->latestCompletedXid);
    6170          970 :     LWLockRelease(ProcArrayLock);
    6171              : 
    6172              :     /*
    6173              :      * Start up subtrans, if not already done for hot standby.  (commit
    6174              :      * timestamps are started below, if necessary.)
    6175              :      */
    6176          970 :     if (standbyState == STANDBY_DISABLED)
    6177          915 :         StartupSUBTRANS(oldestActiveXID);
    6178              : 
    6179              :     /*
    6180              :      * Perform end of recovery actions for any SLRUs that need it.
    6181              :      */
    6182          970 :     TrimCLOG();
    6183          970 :     TrimMultiXact();
    6184              : 
    6185              :     /*
    6186              :      * Reload shared-memory state for prepared transactions.  This needs to
    6187              :      * happen before renaming the last partial segment of the old timeline as
    6188              :      * it may be possible that we have to recover some transactions from it.
    6189              :      */
    6190          970 :     RecoverPreparedTransactions();
    6191              : 
    6192              :     /* Shut down xlogreader */
    6193          970 :     ShutdownWalRecovery();
    6194              : 
    6195              :     /* Enable WAL writes for this backend only. */
    6196          970 :     LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed();
    6197              : 
    6198              :     /* If necessary, write overwrite-contrecord before doing anything else */
    6199          970 :     if (XLogRecPtrIsValid(abortedRecPtr))
    6200              :     {
    6201              :         Assert(XLogRecPtrIsValid(missingContrecPtr));
    6202           10 :         CreateOverwriteContrecordRecord(abortedRecPtr, missingContrecPtr, newTLI);
    6203              :     }
    6204              : 
    6205              :     /*
    6206              :      * Update full_page_writes in shared memory and write an XLOG_FPW_CHANGE
    6207              :      * record before resource manager writes cleanup WAL records or checkpoint
    6208              :      * record is written.
    6209              :      */
    6210          970 :     Insert->fullPageWrites = lastFullPageWrites;
    6211          970 :     UpdateFullPageWrites();
    6212              : 
    6213              :     /*
    6214              :      * Emit checkpoint or end-of-recovery record in XLOG, if required.
    6215              :      */
    6216          970 :     if (performedWalRecovery)
    6217          163 :         promoted = PerformRecoveryXLogAction();
    6218              : 
    6219              :     /*
    6220              :      * If any of the critical GUCs have changed, log them before we allow
    6221              :      * backends to write WAL.
    6222              :      */
    6223          970 :     XLogReportParameters();
    6224              : 
    6225              :     /* If this is archive recovery, perform post-recovery cleanup actions. */
    6226          970 :     if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested)
    6227           55 :         CleanupAfterArchiveRecovery(EndOfLogTLI, EndOfLog, newTLI);
    6228              : 
    6229              :     /*
    6230              :      * Local WAL inserts enabled, so it's time to finish initialization of
    6231              :      * commit timestamp.
    6232              :      */
    6233          970 :     CompleteCommitTsInitialization();
    6234              : 
    6235              :     /*
    6236              :      * Update logical decoding status in shared memory and write an
    6237              :      * XLOG_LOGICAL_DECODING_STATUS_CHANGE, if necessary.
    6238              :      */
    6239          970 :     UpdateLogicalDecodingStatusEndOfRecovery();
    6240              : 
    6241              :     /* Clean up EndOfWalRecoveryInfo data to appease Valgrind leak checking */
    6242          970 :     if (endOfRecoveryInfo->lastPage)
    6243          948 :         pfree(endOfRecoveryInfo->lastPage);
    6244          970 :     pfree(endOfRecoveryInfo->recoveryStopReason);
    6245          970 :     pfree(endOfRecoveryInfo);
    6246              : 
    6247              :     /*
    6248              :      * All done with end-of-recovery actions.
    6249              :      *
    6250              :      * Now allow backends to write WAL and update the control file status in
    6251              :      * consequence.  SharedRecoveryState, that controls if backends can write
    6252              :      * WAL, is updated while holding ControlFileLock to prevent other backends
    6253              :      * to look at an inconsistent state of the control file in shared memory.
    6254              :      * There is still a small window during which backends can write WAL and
    6255              :      * the control file is still referring to a system not in DB_IN_PRODUCTION
    6256              :      * state while looking at the on-disk control file.
    6257              :      *
    6258              :      * Also, we use info_lck to update SharedRecoveryState to ensure that
    6259              :      * there are no race conditions concerning visibility of other recent
    6260              :      * updates to shared memory.
    6261              :      */
    6262          970 :     LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    6263          970 :     ControlFile->state = DB_IN_PRODUCTION;
    6264              : 
    6265          970 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    6266          970 :     XLogCtl->SharedRecoveryState = RECOVERY_STATE_DONE;
    6267          970 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    6268              : 
    6269          970 :     UpdateControlFile();
    6270          970 :     LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    6271              : 
    6272              :     /*
    6273              :      * Wake up the checkpointer process as there might be a request to disable
    6274              :      * logical decoding by concurrent slot drop.
    6275              :      */
    6276          970 :     WakeupCheckpointer();
    6277              : 
    6278              :     /*
    6279              :      * Wake up all waiters.  They need to report an error that recovery was
    6280              :      * ended before reaching the target LSN.
    6281              :      */
    6282          970 :     WaitLSNWakeup(WAIT_LSN_TYPE_STANDBY_REPLAY, InvalidXLogRecPtr);
    6283          970 :     WaitLSNWakeup(WAIT_LSN_TYPE_STANDBY_WRITE, InvalidXLogRecPtr);
    6284          970 :     WaitLSNWakeup(WAIT_LSN_TYPE_STANDBY_FLUSH, InvalidXLogRecPtr);
    6285              : 
    6286              :     /*
    6287              :      * Shutdown the recovery environment.  This must occur after
    6288              :      * RecoverPreparedTransactions() (see notes in lock_twophase_recover())
    6289              :      * and after switching SharedRecoveryState to RECOVERY_STATE_DONE so as
    6290              :      * any session building a snapshot will not rely on KnownAssignedXids as
    6291              :      * RecoveryInProgress() would return false at this stage.  This is
    6292              :      * particularly critical for prepared 2PC transactions, that would still
    6293              :      * need to be included in snapshots once recovery has ended.
    6294              :      */
    6295          970 :     if (standbyState != STANDBY_DISABLED)
    6296           55 :         ShutdownRecoveryTransactionEnvironment();
    6297              : 
    6298              :     /*
    6299              :      * If there were cascading standby servers connected to us, nudge any wal
    6300              :      * sender processes to notice that we've been promoted.
    6301              :      */
    6302          970 :     WalSndWakeup(true, true);
    6303              : 
    6304              :     /*
    6305              :      * If this was a promotion, request an (online) checkpoint now. This isn't
    6306              :      * required for consistency, but the last restartpoint might be far back,
    6307              :      * and in case of a crash, recovering from it might take a longer than is
    6308              :      * appropriate now that we're not in standby mode anymore.
    6309              :      */
    6310          970 :     if (promoted)
    6311           48 :         RequestCheckpoint(CHECKPOINT_FORCE);
    6312          970 : }
    6313              : 
    6314              : /*
    6315              :  * Callback from PerformWalRecovery(), called when we switch from crash
    6316              :  * recovery to archive recovery mode.  Updates the control file accordingly.
    6317              :  */
    6318              : void
    6319            1 : SwitchIntoArchiveRecovery(XLogRecPtr EndRecPtr, TimeLineID replayTLI)
    6320              : {
    6321              :     /* initialize minRecoveryPoint to this record */
    6322            1 :     LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    6323            1 :     ControlFile->state = DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY;
    6324            1 :     if (ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint < EndRecPtr)
    6325              :     {
    6326            1 :         ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = EndRecPtr;
    6327            1 :         ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = replayTLI;
    6328              :     }
    6329              :     /* update local copy */
    6330            1 :     LocalMinRecoveryPoint = ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint;
    6331            1 :     LocalMinRecoveryPointTLI = ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI;
    6332              : 
    6333              :     /*
    6334              :      * The startup process can update its local copy of minRecoveryPoint from
    6335              :      * this point.
    6336              :      */
    6337            1 :     updateMinRecoveryPoint = true;
    6338              : 
    6339            1 :     UpdateControlFile();
    6340              : 
    6341              :     /*
    6342              :      * We update SharedRecoveryState while holding the lock on ControlFileLock
    6343              :      * so both states are consistent in shared memory.
    6344              :      */
    6345            1 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    6346            1 :     XLogCtl->SharedRecoveryState = RECOVERY_STATE_ARCHIVE;
    6347            1 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    6348              : 
    6349            1 :     LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    6350            1 : }
    6351              : 
    6352              : /*
    6353              :  * Callback from PerformWalRecovery(), called when we reach the end of backup.
    6354              :  * Updates the control file accordingly.
    6355              :  */
    6356              : void
    6357           80 : ReachedEndOfBackup(XLogRecPtr EndRecPtr, TimeLineID tli)
    6358              : {
    6359              :     /*
    6360              :      * We have reached the end of base backup, as indicated by pg_control. The
    6361              :      * data on disk is now consistent (unless minRecoveryPoint is further
    6362              :      * ahead, which can happen if we crashed during previous recovery).  Reset
    6363              :      * backupStartPoint and backupEndPoint, and update minRecoveryPoint to
    6364              :      * make sure we don't allow starting up at an earlier point even if
    6365              :      * recovery is stopped and restarted soon after this.
    6366              :      */
    6367           80 :     LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    6368              : 
    6369           80 :     if (ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint < EndRecPtr)
    6370              :     {
    6371           75 :         ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = EndRecPtr;
    6372           75 :         ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = tli;
    6373              :     }
    6374              : 
    6375           80 :     ControlFile->backupStartPoint = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
    6376           80 :     ControlFile->backupEndPoint = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
    6377           80 :     ControlFile->backupEndRequired = false;
    6378           80 :     UpdateControlFile();
    6379              : 
    6380           80 :     LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    6381           80 : }
    6382              : 
    6383              : /*
    6384              :  * Perform whatever XLOG actions are necessary at end of REDO.
    6385              :  *
    6386              :  * The goal here is to make sure that we'll be able to recover properly if
    6387              :  * we crash again. If we choose to write a checkpoint, we'll write a shutdown
    6388              :  * checkpoint rather than an on-line one. This is not particularly critical,
    6389              :  * but since we may be assigning a new TLI, using a shutdown checkpoint allows
    6390              :  * us to have the rule that TLI only changes in shutdown checkpoints, which
    6391              :  * allows some extra error checking in xlog_redo.
    6392              :  */
    6393              : static bool
    6394          163 : PerformRecoveryXLogAction(void)
    6395              : {
    6396          163 :     bool        promoted = false;
    6397              : 
    6398              :     /*
    6399              :      * Perform a checkpoint to update all our recovery activity to disk.
    6400              :      *
    6401              :      * Note that we write a shutdown checkpoint rather than an on-line one.
    6402              :      * This is not particularly critical, but since we may be assigning a new
    6403              :      * TLI, using a shutdown checkpoint allows us to have the rule that TLI
    6404              :      * only changes in shutdown checkpoints, which allows some extra error
    6405              :      * checking in xlog_redo.
    6406              :      *
    6407              :      * In promotion, only create a lightweight end-of-recovery record instead
    6408              :      * of a full checkpoint. A checkpoint is requested later, after we're
    6409              :      * fully out of recovery mode and already accepting queries.
    6410              :      */
    6411          218 :     if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested && IsUnderPostmaster &&
    6412           55 :         PromoteIsTriggered())
    6413              :     {
    6414           48 :         promoted = true;
    6415              : 
    6416              :         /*
    6417              :          * Insert a special WAL record to mark the end of recovery, since we
    6418              :          * aren't doing a checkpoint. That means that the checkpointer process
    6419              :          * may likely be in the middle of a time-smoothed restartpoint and
    6420              :          * could continue to be for minutes after this.  That sounds strange,
    6421              :          * but the effect is roughly the same and it would be stranger to try
    6422              :          * to come out of the restartpoint and then checkpoint. We request a
    6423              :          * checkpoint later anyway, just for safety.
    6424              :          */
    6425           48 :         CreateEndOfRecoveryRecord();
    6426              :     }
    6427              :     else
    6428              :     {
    6429          115 :         RequestCheckpoint(CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY |
    6430              :                           CHECKPOINT_FAST |
    6431              :                           CHECKPOINT_WAIT);
    6432              :     }
    6433              : 
    6434          163 :     return promoted;
    6435              : }
    6436              : 
    6437              : /*
    6438              :  * Is the system still in recovery?
    6439              :  *
    6440              :  * Unlike testing InRecovery, this works in any process that's connected to
    6441              :  * shared memory.
    6442              :  */
    6443              : bool
    6444     96475915 : RecoveryInProgress(void)
    6445              : {
    6446              :     /*
    6447              :      * We check shared state each time only until we leave recovery mode. We
    6448              :      * can't re-enter recovery, so there's no need to keep checking after the
    6449              :      * shared variable has once been seen false.
    6450              :      */
    6451     96475915 :     if (!LocalRecoveryInProgress)
    6452     94548825 :         return false;
    6453              :     else
    6454              :     {
    6455              :         /*
    6456              :          * use volatile pointer to make sure we make a fresh read of the
    6457              :          * shared variable.
    6458              :          */
    6459      1927090 :         volatile XLogCtlData *xlogctl = XLogCtl;
    6460              : 
    6461      1927090 :         LocalRecoveryInProgress = (xlogctl->SharedRecoveryState != RECOVERY_STATE_DONE);
    6462              : 
    6463              :         /*
    6464              :          * Note: We don't need a memory barrier when we're still in recovery.
    6465              :          * We might exit recovery immediately after return, so the caller
    6466              :          * can't rely on 'true' meaning that we're still in recovery anyway.
    6467              :          */
    6468              : 
    6469      1927090 :         return LocalRecoveryInProgress;
    6470              :     }
    6471              : }
    6472              : 
    6473              : /*
    6474              :  * Returns current recovery state from shared memory.
    6475              :  *
    6476              :  * This returned state is kept consistent with the contents of the control
    6477              :  * file.  See details about the possible values of RecoveryState in xlog.h.
    6478              :  */
    6479              : RecoveryState
    6480         2530 : GetRecoveryState(void)
    6481              : {
    6482              :     RecoveryState retval;
    6483              : 
    6484         2530 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    6485         2530 :     retval = XLogCtl->SharedRecoveryState;
    6486         2530 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    6487              : 
    6488         2530 :     return retval;
    6489              : }
    6490              : 
    6491              : /*
    6492              :  * Is this process allowed to insert new WAL records?
    6493              :  *
    6494              :  * Ordinarily this is essentially equivalent to !RecoveryInProgress().
    6495              :  * But we also have provisions for forcing the result "true" or "false"
    6496              :  * within specific processes regardless of the global state.
    6497              :  */
    6498              : bool
    6499     48562100 : XLogInsertAllowed(void)
    6500              : {
    6501              :     /*
    6502              :      * If value is "unconditionally true" or "unconditionally false", just
    6503              :      * return it.  This provides the normal fast path once recovery is known
    6504              :      * done.
    6505              :      */
    6506     48562100 :     if (LocalXLogInsertAllowed >= 0)
    6507     47942671 :         return (bool) LocalXLogInsertAllowed;
    6508              : 
    6509              :     /*
    6510              :      * Else, must check to see if we're still in recovery.
    6511              :      */
    6512       619429 :     if (RecoveryInProgress())
    6513       609099 :         return false;
    6514              : 
    6515              :     /*
    6516              :      * On exit from recovery, reset to "unconditionally true", since there is
    6517              :      * no need to keep checking.
    6518              :      */
    6519        10330 :     LocalXLogInsertAllowed = 1;
    6520        10330 :     return true;
    6521              : }
    6522              : 
    6523              : /*
    6524              :  * Make XLogInsertAllowed() return true in the current process only.
    6525              :  *
    6526              :  * Note: it is allowed to switch LocalXLogInsertAllowed back to -1 later,
    6527              :  * and even call LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed() again after that.
    6528              :  *
    6529              :  * Returns the previous value of LocalXLogInsertAllowed.
    6530              :  */
    6531              : static int
    6532         1000 : LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed(void)
    6533              : {
    6534         1000 :     int         oldXLogAllowed = LocalXLogInsertAllowed;
    6535              : 
    6536         1000 :     LocalXLogInsertAllowed = 1;
    6537              : 
    6538         1000 :     return oldXLogAllowed;
    6539              : }
    6540              : 
    6541              : /*
    6542              :  * Return the current Redo pointer from shared memory.
    6543              :  *
    6544              :  * As a side-effect, the local RedoRecPtr copy is updated.
    6545              :  */
    6546              : XLogRecPtr
    6547       360808 : GetRedoRecPtr(void)
    6548              : {
    6549              :     XLogRecPtr  ptr;
    6550              : 
    6551              :     /*
    6552              :      * The possibly not up-to-date copy in XlogCtl is enough. Even if we
    6553              :      * grabbed a WAL insertion lock to read the authoritative value in
    6554              :      * Insert->RedoRecPtr, someone might update it just after we've released
    6555              :      * the lock.
    6556              :      */
    6557       360808 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    6558       360808 :     ptr = XLogCtl->RedoRecPtr;
    6559       360808 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    6560              : 
    6561       360808 :     if (RedoRecPtr < ptr)
    6562         1721 :         RedoRecPtr = ptr;
    6563              : 
    6564       360808 :     return RedoRecPtr;
    6565              : }
    6566              : 
    6567              : /*
    6568              :  * Return information needed to decide whether a modified block needs a
    6569              :  * full-page image to be included in the WAL record.
    6570              :  *
    6571              :  * The returned values are cached copies from backend-private memory, and
    6572              :  * possibly out-of-date or, indeed, uninitialized, in which case they will
    6573              :  * be InvalidXLogRecPtr and false, respectively.  XLogInsertRecord will
    6574              :  * re-check them against up-to-date values, while holding the WAL insert lock.
    6575              :  */
    6576              : void
    6577     18432917 : GetFullPageWriteInfo(XLogRecPtr *RedoRecPtr_p, bool *doPageWrites_p)
    6578              : {
    6579     18432917 :     *RedoRecPtr_p = RedoRecPtr;
    6580     18432917 :     *doPageWrites_p = doPageWrites;
    6581     18432917 : }
    6582              : 
    6583              : /*
    6584              :  * GetInsertRecPtr -- Returns the current insert position.
    6585              :  *
    6586              :  * NOTE: The value *actually* returned is the position of the last full
    6587              :  * xlog page. It lags behind the real insert position by at most 1 page.
    6588              :  * For that, we don't need to scan through WAL insertion locks, and an
    6589              :  * approximation is enough for the current usage of this function.
    6590              :  */
    6591              : XLogRecPtr
    6592         6893 : GetInsertRecPtr(void)
    6593              : {
    6594              :     XLogRecPtr  recptr;
    6595              : 
    6596         6893 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    6597         6893 :     recptr = XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write;
    6598         6893 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    6599              : 
    6600         6893 :     return recptr;
    6601              : }
    6602              : 
    6603              : /*
    6604              :  * GetFlushRecPtr -- Returns the current flush position, ie, the last WAL
    6605              :  * position known to be fsync'd to disk. This should only be used on a
    6606              :  * system that is known not to be in recovery.
    6607              :  */
    6608              : XLogRecPtr
    6609       214873 : GetFlushRecPtr(TimeLineID *insertTLI)
    6610              : {
    6611              :     Assert(XLogCtl->SharedRecoveryState == RECOVERY_STATE_DONE);
    6612              : 
    6613       214873 :     RefreshXLogWriteResult(LogwrtResult);
    6614              : 
    6615              :     /*
    6616              :      * If we're writing and flushing WAL, the time line can't be changing, so
    6617              :      * no lock is required.
    6618              :      */
    6619       214873 :     if (insertTLI)
    6620        24283 :         *insertTLI = XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
    6621              : 
    6622       214873 :     return LogwrtResult.Flush;
    6623              : }
    6624              : 
    6625              : /*
    6626              :  * GetWALInsertionTimeLine -- Returns the current timeline of a system that
    6627              :  * is not in recovery.
    6628              :  */
    6629              : TimeLineID
    6630       116710 : GetWALInsertionTimeLine(void)
    6631              : {
    6632              :     Assert(XLogCtl->SharedRecoveryState == RECOVERY_STATE_DONE);
    6633              : 
    6634              :     /* Since the value can't be changing, no lock is required. */
    6635       116710 :     return XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
    6636              : }
    6637              : 
    6638              : /*
    6639              :  * GetWALInsertionTimeLineIfSet -- If the system is not in recovery, returns
    6640              :  * the WAL insertion timeline; else, returns 0. Wherever possible, use
    6641              :  * GetWALInsertionTimeLine() instead, since it's cheaper. Note that this
    6642              :  * function decides recovery has ended as soon as the insert TLI is set, which
    6643              :  * happens before we set XLogCtl->SharedRecoveryState to RECOVERY_STATE_DONE.
    6644              :  */
    6645              : TimeLineID
    6646            1 : GetWALInsertionTimeLineIfSet(void)
    6647              : {
    6648              :     TimeLineID  insertTLI;
    6649              : 
    6650            1 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    6651            1 :     insertTLI = XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
    6652            1 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    6653              : 
    6654            1 :     return insertTLI;
    6655              : }
    6656              : 
    6657              : /*
    6658              :  * GetLastImportantRecPtr -- Returns the LSN of the last important record
    6659              :  * inserted. All records not explicitly marked as unimportant are considered
    6660              :  * important.
    6661              :  *
    6662              :  * The LSN is determined by computing the maximum of
    6663              :  * WALInsertLocks[i].lastImportantAt.
    6664              :  */
    6665              : XLogRecPtr
    6666         1684 : GetLastImportantRecPtr(void)
    6667              : {
    6668         1684 :     XLogRecPtr  res = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
    6669              :     int         i;
    6670              : 
    6671        15156 :     for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS; i++)
    6672              :     {
    6673              :         XLogRecPtr  last_important;
    6674              : 
    6675              :         /*
    6676              :          * Need to take a lock to prevent torn reads of the LSN, which are
    6677              :          * possible on some of the supported platforms. WAL insert locks only
    6678              :          * support exclusive mode, so we have to use that.
    6679              :          */
    6680        13472 :         LWLockAcquire(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    6681        13472 :         last_important = WALInsertLocks[i].l.lastImportantAt;
    6682        13472 :         LWLockRelease(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock);
    6683              : 
    6684        13472 :         if (res < last_important)
    6685         2910 :             res = last_important;
    6686              :     }
    6687              : 
    6688         1684 :     return res;
    6689              : }
    6690              : 
    6691              : /*
    6692              :  * Get the time and LSN of the last xlog segment switch
    6693              :  */
    6694              : pg_time_t
    6695            0 : GetLastSegSwitchData(XLogRecPtr *lastSwitchLSN)
    6696              : {
    6697              :     pg_time_t   result;
    6698              : 
    6699              :     /* Need WALWriteLock, but shared lock is sufficient */
    6700            0 :     LWLockAcquire(WALWriteLock, LW_SHARED);
    6701            0 :     result = XLogCtl->lastSegSwitchTime;
    6702            0 :     *lastSwitchLSN = XLogCtl->lastSegSwitchLSN;
    6703            0 :     LWLockRelease(WALWriteLock);
    6704              : 
    6705            0 :     return result;
    6706              : }
    6707              : 
    6708              : /*
    6709              :  * This must be called ONCE during postmaster or standalone-backend shutdown
    6710              :  */
    6711              : void
    6712          721 : ShutdownXLOG(int code, Datum arg)
    6713              : {
    6714              :     /*
    6715              :      * We should have an aux process resource owner to use, and we should not
    6716              :      * be in a transaction that's installed some other resowner.
    6717              :      */
    6718              :     Assert(AuxProcessResourceOwner != NULL);
    6719              :     Assert(CurrentResourceOwner == NULL ||
    6720              :            CurrentResourceOwner == AuxProcessResourceOwner);
    6721          721 :     CurrentResourceOwner = AuxProcessResourceOwner;
    6722              : 
    6723              :     /* Don't be chatty in standalone mode */
    6724          721 :     ereport(IsPostmasterEnvironment ? LOG : NOTICE,
    6725              :             (errmsg("shutting down")));
    6726              : 
    6727              :     /*
    6728              :      * Signal walsenders to move to stopping state.
    6729              :      */
    6730          721 :     WalSndInitStopping();
    6731              : 
    6732              :     /*
    6733              :      * Wait for WAL senders to be in stopping state.  This prevents commands
    6734              :      * from writing new WAL.
    6735              :      */
    6736          721 :     WalSndWaitStopping();
    6737              : 
    6738          721 :     if (RecoveryInProgress())
    6739           58 :         CreateRestartPoint(CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN | CHECKPOINT_FAST);
    6740              :     else
    6741              :     {
    6742              :         /*
    6743              :          * If archiving is enabled, rotate the last XLOG file so that all the
    6744              :          * remaining records are archived (postmaster wakes up the archiver
    6745              :          * process one more time at the end of shutdown). The checkpoint
    6746              :          * record will go to the next XLOG file and won't be archived (yet).
    6747              :          */
    6748          663 :         if (XLogArchivingActive())
    6749           16 :             RequestXLogSwitch(false);
    6750              : 
    6751          663 :         CreateCheckPoint(CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN | CHECKPOINT_FAST);
    6752              :     }
    6753          721 : }
    6754              : 
    6755              : /*
    6756              :  * Format checkpoint request flags as a space-separated string for
    6757              :  * log messages.
    6758              :  */
    6759              : static const char *
    6760         3074 : CheckpointFlagsString(int flags)
    6761              : {
    6762              :     static char buf[128];
    6763              : 
    6764        24592 :     snprintf(buf, sizeof(buf), "%s%s%s%s%s%s%s%s",
    6765         3074 :              (flags & CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN) ? " shutdown" : "",
    6766         3074 :              (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY) ? " end-of-recovery" : "",
    6767         3074 :              (flags & CHECKPOINT_FAST) ? " fast" : "",
    6768         3074 :              (flags & CHECKPOINT_FORCE) ? " force" : "",
    6769         3074 :              (flags & CHECKPOINT_WAIT) ? " wait" : "",
    6770         3074 :              (flags & CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_XLOG) ? " wal" : "",
    6771         3074 :              (flags & CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_TIME) ? " time" : "",
    6772         3074 :              (flags & CHECKPOINT_FLUSH_UNLOGGED) ? " flush-unlogged" : "");
    6773              : 
    6774         3074 :     return buf;
    6775              : }
    6776              : 
    6777              : /*
    6778              :  * Log start of a checkpoint.
    6779              :  */
    6780              : static void
    6781         1537 : LogCheckpointStart(int flags, bool restartpoint)
    6782              : {
    6783         1537 :     if (restartpoint)
    6784          205 :         ereport(LOG,
    6785              :         /* translator: the placeholder shows checkpoint options */
    6786              :                 (errmsg("restartpoint starting:%s",
    6787              :                         CheckpointFlagsString(flags))));
    6788              :     else
    6789         1332 :         ereport(LOG,
    6790              :         /* translator: the placeholder shows checkpoint options */
    6791              :                 (errmsg("checkpoint starting:%s",
    6792              :                         CheckpointFlagsString(flags))));
    6793         1537 : }
    6794              : 
    6795              : /*
    6796              :  * Log end of a checkpoint.
    6797              :  */
    6798              : static void
    6799         1835 : LogCheckpointEnd(bool restartpoint, int flags)
    6800              : {
    6801              :     long        write_msecs,
    6802              :                 sync_msecs,
    6803              :                 total_msecs,
    6804              :                 longest_msecs,
    6805              :                 average_msecs;
    6806              :     uint64      average_sync_time;
    6807              : 
    6808         1835 :     CheckpointStats.ckpt_end_t = GetCurrentTimestamp();
    6809              : 
    6810         1835 :     write_msecs = TimestampDifferenceMilliseconds(CheckpointStats.ckpt_write_t,
    6811              :                                                   CheckpointStats.ckpt_sync_t);
    6812              : 
    6813         1835 :     sync_msecs = TimestampDifferenceMilliseconds(CheckpointStats.ckpt_sync_t,
    6814              :                                                  CheckpointStats.ckpt_sync_end_t);
    6815              : 
    6816              :     /* Accumulate checkpoint timing summary data, in milliseconds. */
    6817         1835 :     PendingCheckpointerStats.write_time += write_msecs;
    6818         1835 :     PendingCheckpointerStats.sync_time += sync_msecs;
    6819              : 
    6820              :     /*
    6821              :      * All of the published timing statistics are accounted for.  Only
    6822              :      * continue if a log message is to be written.
    6823              :      */
    6824         1835 :     if (!log_checkpoints)
    6825          298 :         return;
    6826              : 
    6827         1537 :     total_msecs = TimestampDifferenceMilliseconds(CheckpointStats.ckpt_start_t,
    6828              :                                                   CheckpointStats.ckpt_end_t);
    6829              : 
    6830              :     /*
    6831              :      * Timing values returned from CheckpointStats are in microseconds.
    6832              :      * Convert to milliseconds for consistent printing.
    6833              :      */
    6834         1537 :     longest_msecs = (long) ((CheckpointStats.ckpt_longest_sync + 999) / 1000);
    6835              : 
    6836         1537 :     average_sync_time = 0;
    6837         1537 :     if (CheckpointStats.ckpt_sync_rels > 0)
    6838            0 :         average_sync_time = CheckpointStats.ckpt_agg_sync_time /
    6839            0 :             CheckpointStats.ckpt_sync_rels;
    6840         1537 :     average_msecs = (long) ((average_sync_time + 999) / 1000);
    6841              : 
    6842              :     /*
    6843              :      * ControlFileLock is not required to see ControlFile->checkPoint and
    6844              :      * ->checkPointCopy here as we are the only updator of those variables at
    6845              :      * this moment.
    6846              :      */
    6847         1537 :     if (restartpoint)
    6848          205 :         ereport(LOG,
    6849              :                 (errmsg("restartpoint complete:%s: wrote %d buffers (%.1f%%), "
    6850              :                         "wrote %d SLRU buffers; %d WAL file(s) added, "
    6851              :                         "%d removed, %d recycled; write=%ld.%03d s, "
    6852              :                         "sync=%ld.%03d s, total=%ld.%03d s; sync files=%d, "
    6853              :                         "longest=%ld.%03d s, average=%ld.%03d s; distance=%d kB, "
    6854              :                         "estimate=%d kB; lsn=%X/%08X, redo lsn=%X/%08X",
    6855              :                         CheckpointFlagsString(flags),
    6856              :                         CheckpointStats.ckpt_bufs_written,
    6857              :                         (double) CheckpointStats.ckpt_bufs_written * 100 / NBuffers,
    6858              :                         CheckpointStats.ckpt_slru_written,
    6859              :                         CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_added,
    6860              :                         CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_removed,
    6861              :                         CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_recycled,
    6862              :                         write_msecs / 1000, (int) (write_msecs % 1000),
    6863              :                         sync_msecs / 1000, (int) (sync_msecs % 1000),
    6864              :                         total_msecs / 1000, (int) (total_msecs % 1000),
    6865              :                         CheckpointStats.ckpt_sync_rels,
    6866              :                         longest_msecs / 1000, (int) (longest_msecs % 1000),
    6867              :                         average_msecs / 1000, (int) (average_msecs % 1000),
    6868              :                         (int) (PrevCheckPointDistance / 1024.0),
    6869              :                         (int) (CheckPointDistanceEstimate / 1024.0),
    6870              :                         LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(ControlFile->checkPoint),
    6871              :                         LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo))));
    6872              :     else
    6873         1332 :         ereport(LOG,
    6874              :                 (errmsg("checkpoint complete:%s: wrote %d buffers (%.1f%%), "
    6875              :                         "wrote %d SLRU buffers; %d WAL file(s) added, "
    6876              :                         "%d removed, %d recycled; write=%ld.%03d s, "
    6877              :                         "sync=%ld.%03d s, total=%ld.%03d s; sync files=%d, "
    6878              :                         "longest=%ld.%03d s, average=%ld.%03d s; distance=%d kB, "
    6879              :                         "estimate=%d kB; lsn=%X/%08X, redo lsn=%X/%08X",
    6880              :                         CheckpointFlagsString(flags),
    6881              :                         CheckpointStats.ckpt_bufs_written,
    6882              :                         (double) CheckpointStats.ckpt_bufs_written * 100 / NBuffers,
    6883              :                         CheckpointStats.ckpt_slru_written,
    6884              :                         CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_added,
    6885              :                         CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_removed,
    6886              :                         CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_recycled,
    6887              :                         write_msecs / 1000, (int) (write_msecs % 1000),
    6888              :                         sync_msecs / 1000, (int) (sync_msecs % 1000),
    6889              :                         total_msecs / 1000, (int) (total_msecs % 1000),
    6890              :                         CheckpointStats.ckpt_sync_rels,
    6891              :                         longest_msecs / 1000, (int) (longest_msecs % 1000),
    6892              :                         average_msecs / 1000, (int) (average_msecs % 1000),
    6893              :                         (int) (PrevCheckPointDistance / 1024.0),
    6894              :                         (int) (CheckPointDistanceEstimate / 1024.0),
    6895              :                         LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(ControlFile->checkPoint),
    6896              :                         LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo))));
    6897              : }
    6898              : 
    6899              : /*
    6900              :  * Update the estimate of distance between checkpoints.
    6901              :  *
    6902              :  * The estimate is used to calculate the number of WAL segments to keep
    6903              :  * preallocated, see XLOGfileslop().
    6904              :  */
    6905              : static void
    6906         1835 : UpdateCheckPointDistanceEstimate(uint64 nbytes)
    6907              : {
    6908              :     /*
    6909              :      * To estimate the number of segments consumed between checkpoints, keep a
    6910              :      * moving average of the amount of WAL generated in previous checkpoint
    6911              :      * cycles. However, if the load is bursty, with quiet periods and busy
    6912              :      * periods, we want to cater for the peak load. So instead of a plain
    6913              :      * moving average, let the average decline slowly if the previous cycle
    6914              :      * used less WAL than estimated, but bump it up immediately if it used
    6915              :      * more.
    6916              :      *
    6917              :      * When checkpoints are triggered by max_wal_size, this should converge to
    6918              :      * CheckpointSegments * wal_segment_size,
    6919              :      *
    6920              :      * Note: This doesn't pay any attention to what caused the checkpoint.
    6921              :      * Checkpoints triggered manually with CHECKPOINT command, or by e.g.
    6922              :      * starting a base backup, are counted the same as those created
    6923              :      * automatically. The slow-decline will largely mask them out, if they are
    6924              :      * not frequent. If they are frequent, it seems reasonable to count them
    6925              :      * in as any others; if you issue a manual checkpoint every 5 minutes and
    6926              :      * never let a timed checkpoint happen, it makes sense to base the
    6927              :      * preallocation on that 5 minute interval rather than whatever
    6928              :      * checkpoint_timeout is set to.
    6929              :      */
    6930         1835 :     PrevCheckPointDistance = nbytes;
    6931         1835 :     if (CheckPointDistanceEstimate < nbytes)
    6932          809 :         CheckPointDistanceEstimate = nbytes;
    6933              :     else
    6934         1026 :         CheckPointDistanceEstimate =
    6935         1026 :             (0.90 * CheckPointDistanceEstimate + 0.10 * (double) nbytes);
    6936         1835 : }
    6937              : 
    6938              : /*
    6939              :  * Update the ps display for a process running a checkpoint.  Note that
    6940              :  * this routine should not do any allocations so as it can be called
    6941              :  * from a critical section.
    6942              :  */
    6943              : static void
    6944         3670 : update_checkpoint_display(int flags, bool restartpoint, bool reset)
    6945              : {
    6946              :     /*
    6947              :      * The status is reported only for end-of-recovery and shutdown
    6948              :      * checkpoints or shutdown restartpoints.  Updating the ps display is
    6949              :      * useful in those situations as it may not be possible to rely on
    6950              :      * pg_stat_activity to see the status of the checkpointer or the startup
    6951              :      * process.
    6952              :      */
    6953         3670 :     if ((flags & (CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY | CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN)) == 0)
    6954         2240 :         return;
    6955              : 
    6956         1430 :     if (reset)
    6957          715 :         set_ps_display("");
    6958              :     else
    6959              :     {
    6960              :         char        activitymsg[128];
    6961              : 
    6962         2145 :         snprintf(activitymsg, sizeof(activitymsg), "performing %s%s%s",
    6963          715 :                  (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY) ? "end-of-recovery " : "",
    6964          715 :                  (flags & CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN) ? "shutdown " : "",
    6965              :                  restartpoint ? "restartpoint" : "checkpoint");
    6966          715 :         set_ps_display(activitymsg);
    6967              :     }
    6968              : }
    6969              : 
    6970              : 
    6971              : /*
    6972              :  * Perform a checkpoint --- either during shutdown, or on-the-fly
    6973              :  *
    6974              :  * flags is a bitwise OR of the following:
    6975              :  *  CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN: checkpoint is for database shutdown.
    6976              :  *  CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY: checkpoint is for end of WAL recovery.
    6977              :  *  CHECKPOINT_FAST: finish the checkpoint ASAP, ignoring
    6978              :  *      checkpoint_completion_target parameter.
    6979              :  *  CHECKPOINT_FORCE: force a checkpoint even if no XLOG activity has occurred
    6980              :  *      since the last one (implied by CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN or
    6981              :  *      CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY).
    6982              :  *  CHECKPOINT_FLUSH_UNLOGGED: also flush buffers of unlogged tables.
    6983              :  *
    6984              :  * Note: flags contains other bits, of interest here only for logging purposes.
    6985              :  * In particular note that this routine is synchronous and does not pay
    6986              :  * attention to CHECKPOINT_WAIT.
    6987              :  *
    6988              :  * If !shutdown then we are writing an online checkpoint. An XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO
    6989              :  * record is inserted into WAL at the logical location of the checkpoint, before
    6990              :  * flushing anything to disk, and when the checkpoint is eventually completed,
    6991              :  * and it is from this point that WAL replay will begin in the case of a recovery
    6992              :  * from this checkpoint. Once everything is written to disk, an
    6993              :  * XLOG_CHECKPOINT_ONLINE record is written to complete the checkpoint, and
    6994              :  * points back to the earlier XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO record. This mechanism allows
    6995              :  * other write-ahead log records to be written while the checkpoint is in
    6996              :  * progress, but we must be very careful about order of operations. This function
    6997              :  * may take many minutes to execute on a busy system.
    6998              :  *
    6999              :  * On the other hand, when shutdown is true, concurrent insertion into the
    7000              :  * write-ahead log is impossible, so there is no need for two separate records.
    7001              :  * In this case, we only insert an XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN record, and it's
    7002              :  * both the record marking the completion of the checkpoint and the location
    7003              :  * from which WAL replay would begin if needed.
    7004              :  *
    7005              :  * Returns true if a new checkpoint was performed, or false if it was skipped
    7006              :  * because the system was idle.
    7007              :  */
    7008              : bool
    7009         1631 : CreateCheckPoint(int flags)
    7010              : {
    7011              :     bool        shutdown;
    7012              :     CheckPoint  checkPoint;
    7013              :     XLogRecPtr  recptr;
    7014              :     XLogSegNo   _logSegNo;
    7015         1631 :     XLogCtlInsert *Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert;
    7016              :     uint32      freespace;
    7017              :     XLogRecPtr  PriorRedoPtr;
    7018              :     XLogRecPtr  last_important_lsn;
    7019              :     VirtualTransactionId *vxids;
    7020              :     int         nvxids;
    7021         1631 :     int         oldXLogAllowed = 0;
    7022              : 
    7023              :     /*
    7024              :      * An end-of-recovery checkpoint is really a shutdown checkpoint, just
    7025              :      * issued at a different time.
    7026              :      */
    7027         1631 :     if (flags & (CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN | CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY))
    7028          693 :         shutdown = true;
    7029              :     else
    7030          938 :         shutdown = false;
    7031              : 
    7032              :     /* sanity check */
    7033         1631 :     if (RecoveryInProgress() && (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY) == 0)
    7034            0 :         elog(ERROR, "can't create a checkpoint during recovery");
    7035              : 
    7036              :     /*
    7037              :      * Prepare to accumulate statistics.
    7038              :      *
    7039              :      * Note: because it is possible for log_checkpoints to change while a
    7040              :      * checkpoint proceeds, we always accumulate stats, even if
    7041              :      * log_checkpoints is currently off.
    7042              :      */
    7043        17941 :     MemSet(&CheckpointStats, 0, sizeof(CheckpointStats));
    7044         1631 :     CheckpointStats.ckpt_start_t = GetCurrentTimestamp();
    7045              : 
    7046              :     /*
    7047              :      * Let smgr prepare for checkpoint; this has to happen outside the
    7048              :      * critical section and before we determine the REDO pointer.  Note that
    7049              :      * smgr must not do anything that'd have to be undone if we decide no
    7050              :      * checkpoint is needed.
    7051              :      */
    7052         1631 :     SyncPreCheckpoint();
    7053              : 
    7054              :     /* Run these points outside the critical section. */
    7055         1631 :     INJECTION_POINT("create-checkpoint-initial", NULL);
    7056         1631 :     INJECTION_POINT_LOAD("create-checkpoint-run");
    7057              : 
    7058              :     /*
    7059              :      * Use a critical section to force system panic if we have trouble.
    7060              :      */
    7061         1631 :     START_CRIT_SECTION();
    7062              : 
    7063         1631 :     if (shutdown)
    7064              :     {
    7065          693 :         LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    7066          693 :         ControlFile->state = DB_SHUTDOWNING;
    7067          693 :         UpdateControlFile();
    7068          693 :         LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    7069              :     }
    7070              : 
    7071              :     /* Begin filling in the checkpoint WAL record */
    7072        21203 :     MemSet(&checkPoint, 0, sizeof(checkPoint));
    7073         1631 :     checkPoint.time = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
    7074              : 
    7075              :     /*
    7076              :      * For Hot Standby, derive the oldestActiveXid before we fix the redo
    7077              :      * pointer. This allows us to begin accumulating changes to assemble our
    7078              :      * starting snapshot of locks and transactions.
    7079              :      */
    7080         1631 :     if (!shutdown && XLogStandbyInfoActive())
    7081          907 :         checkPoint.oldestActiveXid = GetOldestActiveTransactionId(false, true);
    7082              :     else
    7083          724 :         checkPoint.oldestActiveXid = InvalidTransactionId;
    7084              : 
    7085              :     /*
    7086              :      * Get location of last important record before acquiring insert locks (as
    7087              :      * GetLastImportantRecPtr() also locks WAL locks).
    7088              :      */
    7089         1631 :     last_important_lsn = GetLastImportantRecPtr();
    7090              : 
    7091              :     /*
    7092              :      * If this isn't a shutdown or forced checkpoint, and if there has been no
    7093              :      * WAL activity requiring a checkpoint, skip it.  The idea here is to
    7094              :      * avoid inserting duplicate checkpoints when the system is idle.
    7095              :      */
    7096         1631 :     if ((flags & (CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN | CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY |
    7097              :                   CHECKPOINT_FORCE)) == 0)
    7098              :     {
    7099          197 :         if (last_important_lsn == ControlFile->checkPoint)
    7100              :         {
    7101            1 :             END_CRIT_SECTION();
    7102            1 :             ereport(DEBUG1,
    7103              :                     (errmsg_internal("checkpoint skipped because system is idle")));
    7104            1 :             return false;
    7105              :         }
    7106              :     }
    7107              : 
    7108              :     /*
    7109              :      * An end-of-recovery checkpoint is created before anyone is allowed to
    7110              :      * write WAL. To allow us to write the checkpoint record, temporarily
    7111              :      * enable XLogInsertAllowed.
    7112              :      */
    7113         1630 :     if (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY)
    7114           30 :         oldXLogAllowed = LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed();
    7115              : 
    7116         1630 :     checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID = XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
    7117         1630 :     if (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY)
    7118           30 :         checkPoint.PrevTimeLineID = XLogCtl->PrevTimeLineID;
    7119              :     else
    7120         1600 :         checkPoint.PrevTimeLineID = checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID;
    7121              : 
    7122              :     /*
    7123              :      * We must block concurrent insertions while examining insert state.
    7124              :      */
    7125         1630 :     WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive();
    7126              : 
    7127         1630 :     checkPoint.fullPageWrites = Insert->fullPageWrites;
    7128         1630 :     checkPoint.wal_level = wal_level;
    7129              : 
    7130         1630 :     if (shutdown)
    7131              :     {
    7132          693 :         XLogRecPtr  curInsert = XLogBytePosToRecPtr(Insert->CurrBytePos);
    7133              : 
    7134              :         /*
    7135              :          * Compute new REDO record ptr = location of next XLOG record.
    7136              :          *
    7137              :          * Since this is a shutdown checkpoint, there can't be any concurrent
    7138              :          * WAL insertion.
    7139              :          */
    7140          693 :         freespace = INSERT_FREESPACE(curInsert);
    7141          693 :         if (freespace == 0)
    7142              :         {
    7143            0 :             if (XLogSegmentOffset(curInsert, wal_segment_size) == 0)
    7144            0 :                 curInsert += SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
    7145              :             else
    7146            0 :                 curInsert += SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
    7147              :         }
    7148          693 :         checkPoint.redo = curInsert;
    7149              : 
    7150              :         /*
    7151              :          * Here we update the shared RedoRecPtr for future XLogInsert calls;
    7152              :          * this must be done while holding all the insertion locks.
    7153              :          *
    7154              :          * Note: if we fail to complete the checkpoint, RedoRecPtr will be
    7155              :          * left pointing past where it really needs to point.  This is okay;
    7156              :          * the only consequence is that XLogInsert might back up whole buffers
    7157              :          * that it didn't really need to.  We can't postpone advancing
    7158              :          * RedoRecPtr because XLogInserts that happen while we are dumping
    7159              :          * buffers must assume that their buffer changes are not included in
    7160              :          * the checkpoint.
    7161              :          */
    7162          693 :         RedoRecPtr = XLogCtl->Insert.RedoRecPtr = checkPoint.redo;
    7163              :     }
    7164              : 
    7165              :     /*
    7166              :      * Now we can release the WAL insertion locks, allowing other xacts to
    7167              :      * proceed while we are flushing disk buffers.
    7168              :      */
    7169         1630 :     WALInsertLockRelease();
    7170              : 
    7171              :     /*
    7172              :      * If this is an online checkpoint, we have not yet determined the redo
    7173              :      * point. We do so now by inserting the special XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO
    7174              :      * record; the LSN at which it starts becomes the new redo pointer. We
    7175              :      * don't do this for a shutdown checkpoint, because in that case no WAL
    7176              :      * can be written between the redo point and the insertion of the
    7177              :      * checkpoint record itself, so the checkpoint record itself serves to
    7178              :      * mark the redo point.
    7179              :      */
    7180         1630 :     if (!shutdown)
    7181              :     {
    7182              :         /* Include WAL level in record for WAL summarizer's benefit. */
    7183          937 :         XLogBeginInsert();
    7184          937 :         XLogRegisterData(&wal_level, sizeof(wal_level));
    7185          937 :         (void) XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO);
    7186              : 
    7187              :         /*
    7188              :          * XLogInsertRecord will have updated XLogCtl->Insert.RedoRecPtr in
    7189              :          * shared memory and RedoRecPtr in backend-local memory, but we need
    7190              :          * to copy that into the record that will be inserted when the
    7191              :          * checkpoint is complete.
    7192              :          */
    7193          937 :         checkPoint.redo = RedoRecPtr;
    7194              :     }
    7195              : 
    7196              :     /* Update the info_lck-protected copy of RedoRecPtr as well */
    7197         1630 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    7198         1630 :     XLogCtl->RedoRecPtr = checkPoint.redo;
    7199         1630 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    7200              : 
    7201              :     /*
    7202              :      * If enabled, log checkpoint start.  We postpone this until now so as not
    7203              :      * to log anything if we decided to skip the checkpoint.
    7204              :      */
    7205         1630 :     if (log_checkpoints)
    7206         1332 :         LogCheckpointStart(flags, false);
    7207              : 
    7208         1630 :     INJECTION_POINT_CACHED("create-checkpoint-run", NULL);
    7209              : 
    7210              :     /* Update the process title */
    7211         1630 :     update_checkpoint_display(flags, false, false);
    7212              : 
    7213              :     TRACE_POSTGRESQL_CHECKPOINT_START(flags);
    7214              : 
    7215              :     /*
    7216              :      * Get the other info we need for the checkpoint record.
    7217              :      *
    7218              :      * We don't need to save oldestClogXid in the checkpoint, it only matters
    7219              :      * for the short period in which clog is being truncated, and if we crash
    7220              :      * during that we'll redo the clog truncation and fix up oldestClogXid
    7221              :      * there.
    7222              :      */
    7223         1630 :     LWLockAcquire(XidGenLock, LW_SHARED);
    7224         1630 :     checkPoint.nextXid = TransamVariables->nextXid;
    7225         1630 :     checkPoint.oldestXid = TransamVariables->oldestXid;
    7226         1630 :     checkPoint.oldestXidDB = TransamVariables->oldestXidDB;
    7227         1630 :     LWLockRelease(XidGenLock);
    7228              : 
    7229         1630 :     LWLockAcquire(CommitTsLock, LW_SHARED);
    7230         1630 :     checkPoint.oldestCommitTsXid = TransamVariables->oldestCommitTsXid;
    7231         1630 :     checkPoint.newestCommitTsXid = TransamVariables->newestCommitTsXid;
    7232         1630 :     LWLockRelease(CommitTsLock);
    7233              : 
    7234         1630 :     LWLockAcquire(OidGenLock, LW_SHARED);
    7235         1630 :     checkPoint.nextOid = TransamVariables->nextOid;
    7236         1630 :     if (!shutdown)
    7237          937 :         checkPoint.nextOid += TransamVariables->oidCount;
    7238         1630 :     LWLockRelease(OidGenLock);
    7239              : 
    7240         1630 :     checkPoint.logicalDecodingEnabled = IsLogicalDecodingEnabled();
    7241              : 
    7242         1630 :     MultiXactGetCheckptMulti(shutdown,
    7243              :                              &checkPoint.nextMulti,
    7244              :                              &checkPoint.nextMultiOffset,
    7245              :                              &checkPoint.oldestMulti,
    7246              :                              &checkPoint.oldestMultiDB);
    7247              : 
    7248              :     /*
    7249              :      * Having constructed the checkpoint record, ensure all shmem disk buffers
    7250              :      * and commit-log buffers are flushed to disk.
    7251              :      *
    7252              :      * This I/O could fail for various reasons.  If so, we will fail to
    7253              :      * complete the checkpoint, but there is no reason to force a system
    7254              :      * panic. Accordingly, exit critical section while doing it.
    7255              :      */
    7256         1630 :     END_CRIT_SECTION();
    7257              : 
    7258              :     /*
    7259              :      * In some cases there are groups of actions that must all occur on one
    7260              :      * side or the other of a checkpoint record. Before flushing the
    7261              :      * checkpoint record we must explicitly wait for any backend currently
    7262              :      * performing those groups of actions.
    7263              :      *
    7264              :      * One example is end of transaction, so we must wait for any transactions
    7265              :      * that are currently in commit critical sections.  If an xact inserted
    7266              :      * its commit record into XLOG just before the REDO point, then a crash
    7267              :      * restart from the REDO point would not replay that record, which means
    7268              :      * that our flushing had better include the xact's update of pg_xact.  So
    7269              :      * we wait till he's out of his commit critical section before proceeding.
    7270              :      * See notes in RecordTransactionCommit().
    7271              :      *
    7272              :      * Because we've already released the insertion locks, this test is a bit
    7273              :      * fuzzy: it is possible that we will wait for xacts we didn't really need
    7274              :      * to wait for.  But the delay should be short and it seems better to make
    7275              :      * checkpoint take a bit longer than to hold off insertions longer than
    7276              :      * necessary. (In fact, the whole reason we have this issue is that xact.c
    7277              :      * does commit record XLOG insertion and clog update as two separate steps
    7278              :      * protected by different locks, but again that seems best on grounds of
    7279              :      * minimizing lock contention.)
    7280              :      *
    7281              :      * A transaction that has not yet set delayChkptFlags when we look cannot
    7282              :      * be at risk, since it has not inserted its commit record yet; and one
    7283              :      * that's already cleared it is not at risk either, since it's done fixing
    7284              :      * clog and we will correctly flush the update below.  So we cannot miss
    7285              :      * any xacts we need to wait for.
    7286              :      */
    7287         1630 :     vxids = GetVirtualXIDsDelayingChkpt(&nvxids, DELAY_CHKPT_START);
    7288         1630 :     if (nvxids > 0)
    7289              :     {
    7290              :         do
    7291              :         {
    7292              :             /*
    7293              :              * Keep absorbing fsync requests while we wait. There could even
    7294              :              * be a deadlock if we don't, if the process that prevents the
    7295              :              * checkpoint is trying to add a request to the queue.
    7296              :              */
    7297           29 :             AbsorbSyncRequests();
    7298              : 
    7299           29 :             pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_CHECKPOINT_DELAY_START);
    7300           29 :             pg_usleep(10000L);  /* wait for 10 msec */
    7301           29 :             pgstat_report_wait_end();
    7302           29 :         } while (HaveVirtualXIDsDelayingChkpt(vxids, nvxids,
    7303              :                                               DELAY_CHKPT_START));
    7304              :     }
    7305         1630 :     pfree(vxids);
    7306              : 
    7307         1630 :     CheckPointGuts(checkPoint.redo, flags);
    7308              : 
    7309         1630 :     vxids = GetVirtualXIDsDelayingChkpt(&nvxids, DELAY_CHKPT_COMPLETE);
    7310         1630 :     if (nvxids > 0)
    7311              :     {
    7312              :         do
    7313              :         {
    7314            0 :             AbsorbSyncRequests();
    7315              : 
    7316            0 :             pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_CHECKPOINT_DELAY_COMPLETE);
    7317            0 :             pg_usleep(10000L);  /* wait for 10 msec */
    7318            0 :             pgstat_report_wait_end();
    7319            0 :         } while (HaveVirtualXIDsDelayingChkpt(vxids, nvxids,
    7320              :                                               DELAY_CHKPT_COMPLETE));
    7321              :     }
    7322         1630 :     pfree(vxids);
    7323              : 
    7324              :     /*
    7325              :      * Take a snapshot of running transactions and write this to WAL. This
    7326              :      * allows us to reconstruct the state of running transactions during
    7327              :      * archive recovery, if required. Skip, if this info disabled.
    7328              :      *
    7329              :      * If we are shutting down, or Startup process is completing crash
    7330              :      * recovery we don't need to write running xact data.
    7331              :      */
    7332         1630 :     if (!shutdown && XLogStandbyInfoActive())
    7333          906 :         LogStandbySnapshot();
    7334              : 
    7335         1630 :     START_CRIT_SECTION();
    7336              : 
    7337              :     /*
    7338              :      * Now insert the checkpoint record into XLOG.
    7339              :      */
    7340         1630 :     XLogBeginInsert();
    7341         1630 :     XLogRegisterData(&checkPoint, sizeof(checkPoint));
    7342         1630 :     recptr = XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID,
    7343              :                         shutdown ? XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN :
    7344              :                         XLOG_CHECKPOINT_ONLINE);
    7345              : 
    7346         1630 :     XLogFlush(recptr);
    7347              : 
    7348              :     /*
    7349              :      * We mustn't write any new WAL after a shutdown checkpoint, or it will be
    7350              :      * overwritten at next startup.  No-one should even try, this just allows
    7351              :      * sanity-checking.  In the case of an end-of-recovery checkpoint, we want
    7352              :      * to just temporarily disable writing until the system has exited
    7353              :      * recovery.
    7354              :      */
    7355         1630 :     if (shutdown)
    7356              :     {
    7357          693 :         if (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY)
    7358           30 :             LocalXLogInsertAllowed = oldXLogAllowed;
    7359              :         else
    7360          663 :             LocalXLogInsertAllowed = 0; /* never again write WAL */
    7361              :     }
    7362              : 
    7363              :     /*
    7364              :      * We now have ProcLastRecPtr = start of actual checkpoint record, recptr
    7365              :      * = end of actual checkpoint record.
    7366              :      */
    7367         1630 :     if (shutdown && checkPoint.redo != ProcLastRecPtr)
    7368            0 :         ereport(PANIC,
    7369              :                 (errmsg("concurrent write-ahead log activity while database system is shutting down")));
    7370              : 
    7371              :     /*
    7372              :      * Remember the prior checkpoint's redo ptr for
    7373              :      * UpdateCheckPointDistanceEstimate()
    7374              :      */
    7375         1630 :     PriorRedoPtr = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo;
    7376              : 
    7377              :     /*
    7378              :      * Update the control file.
    7379              :      */
    7380         1630 :     LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    7381         1630 :     if (shutdown)
    7382          693 :         ControlFile->state = DB_SHUTDOWNED;
    7383         1630 :     ControlFile->checkPoint = ProcLastRecPtr;
    7384         1630 :     ControlFile->checkPointCopy = checkPoint;
    7385              :     /* crash recovery should always recover to the end of WAL */
    7386         1630 :     ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
    7387         1630 :     ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = 0;
    7388              : 
    7389              :     /*
    7390              :      * Persist unloggedLSN value. It's reset on crash recovery, so this goes
    7391              :      * unused on non-shutdown checkpoints, but seems useful to store it always
    7392              :      * for debugging purposes.
    7393              :      */
    7394         1630 :     ControlFile->unloggedLSN = pg_atomic_read_membarrier_u64(&XLogCtl->unloggedLSN);
    7395              : 
    7396         1630 :     UpdateControlFile();
    7397         1630 :     LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    7398              : 
    7399              :     /*
    7400              :      * We are now done with critical updates; no need for system panic if we
    7401              :      * have trouble while fooling with old log segments.
    7402              :      */
    7403         1630 :     END_CRIT_SECTION();
    7404              : 
    7405              :     /*
    7406              :      * WAL summaries end when the next XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO or
    7407              :      * XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN record is reached. This is the first point
    7408              :      * where (a) we're not inside of a critical section and (b) we can be
    7409              :      * certain that the relevant record has been flushed to disk, which must
    7410              :      * happen before it can be summarized.
    7411              :      *
    7412              :      * If this is a shutdown checkpoint, then this happens reasonably
    7413              :      * promptly: we've only just inserted and flushed the
    7414              :      * XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN record. If this is not a shutdown checkpoint,
    7415              :      * then this might not be very prompt at all: the XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO
    7416              :      * record was written before we began flushing data to disk, and that
    7417              :      * could be many minutes ago at this point. However, we don't XLogFlush()
    7418              :      * after inserting that record, so we're not guaranteed that it's on disk
    7419              :      * until after the above call that flushes the XLOG_CHECKPOINT_ONLINE
    7420              :      * record.
    7421              :      */
    7422         1630 :     WakeupWalSummarizer();
    7423              : 
    7424              :     /*
    7425              :      * Let smgr do post-checkpoint cleanup (eg, deleting old files).
    7426              :      */
    7427         1630 :     SyncPostCheckpoint();
    7428              : 
    7429              :     /*
    7430              :      * Update the average distance between checkpoints if the prior checkpoint
    7431              :      * exists.
    7432              :      */
    7433         1630 :     if (XLogRecPtrIsValid(PriorRedoPtr))
    7434         1630 :         UpdateCheckPointDistanceEstimate(RedoRecPtr - PriorRedoPtr);
    7435              : 
    7436         1630 :     INJECTION_POINT("checkpoint-before-old-wal-removal", NULL);
    7437              : 
    7438              :     /*
    7439              :      * Delete old log files, those no longer needed for last checkpoint to
    7440              :      * prevent the disk holding the xlog from growing full.
    7441              :      */
    7442         1630 :     XLByteToSeg(RedoRecPtr, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    7443         1630 :     KeepLogSeg(recptr, &_logSegNo);
    7444         1630 :     if (InvalidateObsoleteReplicationSlots(RS_INVAL_WAL_REMOVED | RS_INVAL_IDLE_TIMEOUT,
    7445              :                                            _logSegNo, InvalidOid,
    7446              :                                            InvalidTransactionId))
    7447              :     {
    7448              :         /*
    7449              :          * Some slots have been invalidated; recalculate the old-segment
    7450              :          * horizon, starting again from RedoRecPtr.
    7451              :          */
    7452            4 :         XLByteToSeg(RedoRecPtr, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    7453            4 :         KeepLogSeg(recptr, &_logSegNo);
    7454              :     }
    7455         1630 :     _logSegNo--;
    7456         1630 :     RemoveOldXlogFiles(_logSegNo, RedoRecPtr, recptr,
    7457              :                        checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID);
    7458              : 
    7459              :     /*
    7460              :      * Make more log segments if needed.  (Do this after recycling old log
    7461              :      * segments, since that may supply some of the needed files.)
    7462              :      */
    7463         1630 :     if (!shutdown)
    7464          937 :         PreallocXlogFiles(recptr, checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID);
    7465              : 
    7466              :     /*
    7467              :      * Truncate pg_subtrans if possible.  We can throw away all data before
    7468              :      * the oldest XMIN of any running transaction.  No future transaction will
    7469              :      * attempt to reference any pg_subtrans entry older than that (see Asserts
    7470              :      * in subtrans.c).  During recovery, though, we mustn't do this because
    7471              :      * StartupSUBTRANS hasn't been called yet.
    7472              :      */
    7473         1630 :     if (!RecoveryInProgress())
    7474         1600 :         TruncateSUBTRANS(GetOldestTransactionIdConsideredRunning());
    7475              : 
    7476              :     /* Real work is done; log and update stats. */
    7477         1630 :     LogCheckpointEnd(false, flags);
    7478              : 
    7479              :     /* Reset the process title */
    7480         1630 :     update_checkpoint_display(flags, false, true);
    7481              : 
    7482              :     TRACE_POSTGRESQL_CHECKPOINT_DONE(CheckpointStats.ckpt_bufs_written,
    7483              :                                      NBuffers,
    7484              :                                      CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_added,
    7485              :                                      CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_removed,
    7486              :                                      CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_recycled);
    7487              : 
    7488         1630 :     return true;
    7489              : }
    7490              : 
    7491              : /*
    7492              :  * Mark the end of recovery in WAL though without running a full checkpoint.
    7493              :  * We can expect that a restartpoint is likely to be in progress as we
    7494              :  * do this, though we are unwilling to wait for it to complete.
    7495              :  *
    7496              :  * CreateRestartPoint() allows for the case where recovery may end before
    7497              :  * the restartpoint completes so there is no concern of concurrent behaviour.
    7498              :  */
    7499              : static void
    7500           48 : CreateEndOfRecoveryRecord(void)
    7501              : {
    7502              :     xl_end_of_recovery xlrec;
    7503              :     XLogRecPtr  recptr;
    7504              : 
    7505              :     /* sanity check */
    7506           48 :     if (!RecoveryInProgress())
    7507            0 :         elog(ERROR, "can only be used to end recovery");
    7508              : 
    7509           48 :     xlrec.end_time = GetCurrentTimestamp();
    7510           48 :     xlrec.wal_level = wal_level;
    7511              : 
    7512           48 :     WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive();
    7513           48 :     xlrec.ThisTimeLineID = XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
    7514           48 :     xlrec.PrevTimeLineID = XLogCtl->PrevTimeLineID;
    7515           48 :     WALInsertLockRelease();
    7516              : 
    7517           48 :     START_CRIT_SECTION();
    7518              : 
    7519           48 :     XLogBeginInsert();
    7520           48 :     XLogRegisterData(&xlrec, sizeof(xl_end_of_recovery));
    7521           48 :     recptr = XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_END_OF_RECOVERY);
    7522              : 
    7523           48 :     XLogFlush(recptr);
    7524              : 
    7525              :     /*
    7526              :      * Update the control file so that crash recovery can follow the timeline
    7527              :      * changes to this point.
    7528              :      */
    7529           48 :     LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    7530           48 :     ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = recptr;
    7531           48 :     ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = xlrec.ThisTimeLineID;
    7532           48 :     UpdateControlFile();
    7533           48 :     LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    7534              : 
    7535           48 :     END_CRIT_SECTION();
    7536           48 : }
    7537              : 
    7538              : /*
    7539              :  * Write an OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD message.
    7540              :  *
    7541              :  * When on WAL replay we expect a continuation record at the start of a page
    7542              :  * that is not there, recovery ends and WAL writing resumes at that point.
    7543              :  * But it's wrong to resume writing new WAL back at the start of the record
    7544              :  * that was broken, because downstream consumers of that WAL (physical
    7545              :  * replicas) are not prepared to "rewind".  So the first action after
    7546              :  * finishing replay of all valid WAL must be to write a record of this type
    7547              :  * at the point where the contrecord was missing; to support xlogreader
    7548              :  * detecting the special case, XLP_FIRST_IS_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD is also added
    7549              :  * to the page header where the record occurs.  xlogreader has an ad-hoc
    7550              :  * mechanism to report metadata about the broken record, which is what we
    7551              :  * use here.
    7552              :  *
    7553              :  * At replay time, XLP_FIRST_IS_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD instructs xlogreader to
    7554              :  * skip the record it was reading, and pass back the LSN of the skipped
    7555              :  * record, so that its caller can verify (on "replay" of that record) that the
    7556              :  * XLOG_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD matches what was effectively overwritten.
    7557              :  *
    7558              :  * 'aborted_lsn' is the beginning position of the record that was incomplete.
    7559              :  * It is included in the WAL record.  'pagePtr' and 'newTLI' point to the
    7560              :  * beginning of the XLOG page where the record is to be inserted.  They must
    7561              :  * match the current WAL insert position, they're passed here just so that we
    7562              :  * can verify that.
    7563              :  */
    7564              : static XLogRecPtr
    7565           10 : CreateOverwriteContrecordRecord(XLogRecPtr aborted_lsn, XLogRecPtr pagePtr,
    7566              :                                 TimeLineID newTLI)
    7567              : {
    7568              :     xl_overwrite_contrecord xlrec;
    7569              :     XLogRecPtr  recptr;
    7570              :     XLogPageHeader pagehdr;
    7571              :     XLogRecPtr  startPos;
    7572              : 
    7573              :     /* sanity checks */
    7574           10 :     if (!RecoveryInProgress())
    7575            0 :         elog(ERROR, "can only be used at end of recovery");
    7576           10 :     if (pagePtr % XLOG_BLCKSZ != 0)
    7577            0 :         elog(ERROR, "invalid position for missing continuation record %X/%08X",
    7578              :              LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(pagePtr));
    7579              : 
    7580              :     /* The current WAL insert position should be right after the page header */
    7581           10 :     startPos = pagePtr;
    7582           10 :     if (XLogSegmentOffset(startPos, wal_segment_size) == 0)
    7583            1 :         startPos += SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
    7584              :     else
    7585            9 :         startPos += SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
    7586           10 :     recptr = GetXLogInsertRecPtr();
    7587           10 :     if (recptr != startPos)
    7588            0 :         elog(ERROR, "invalid WAL insert position %X/%08X for OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD",
    7589              :              LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(recptr));
    7590              : 
    7591           10 :     START_CRIT_SECTION();
    7592              : 
    7593              :     /*
    7594              :      * Initialize the XLOG page header (by GetXLogBuffer), and set the
    7595              :      * XLP_FIRST_IS_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD flag.
    7596              :      *
    7597              :      * No other backend is allowed to write WAL yet, so acquiring the WAL
    7598              :      * insertion lock is just pro forma.
    7599              :      */
    7600           10 :     WALInsertLockAcquire();
    7601           10 :     pagehdr = (XLogPageHeader) GetXLogBuffer(pagePtr, newTLI);
    7602           10 :     pagehdr->xlp_info |= XLP_FIRST_IS_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD;
    7603           10 :     WALInsertLockRelease();
    7604              : 
    7605              :     /*
    7606              :      * Insert the XLOG_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD record as the first record on the
    7607              :      * page.  We know it becomes the first record, because no other backend is
    7608              :      * allowed to write WAL yet.
    7609              :      */
    7610           10 :     XLogBeginInsert();
    7611           10 :     xlrec.overwritten_lsn = aborted_lsn;
    7612           10 :     xlrec.overwrite_time = GetCurrentTimestamp();
    7613           10 :     XLogRegisterData(&xlrec, sizeof(xl_overwrite_contrecord));
    7614           10 :     recptr = XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD);
    7615              : 
    7616              :     /* check that the record was inserted to the right place */
    7617           10 :     if (ProcLastRecPtr != startPos)
    7618            0 :         elog(ERROR, "OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD was inserted to unexpected position %X/%08X",
    7619              :              LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(ProcLastRecPtr));
    7620              : 
    7621           10 :     XLogFlush(recptr);
    7622              : 
    7623           10 :     END_CRIT_SECTION();
    7624              : 
    7625           10 :     return recptr;
    7626              : }
    7627              : 
    7628              : /*
    7629              :  * Flush all data in shared memory to disk, and fsync
    7630              :  *
    7631              :  * This is the common code shared between regular checkpoints and
    7632              :  * recovery restartpoints.
    7633              :  */
    7634              : static void
    7635         1835 : CheckPointGuts(XLogRecPtr checkPointRedo, int flags)
    7636              : {
    7637         1835 :     CheckPointRelationMap();
    7638         1835 :     CheckPointReplicationSlots(flags & CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN);
    7639         1835 :     CheckPointSnapBuild();
    7640         1835 :     CheckPointLogicalRewriteHeap();
    7641         1835 :     CheckPointReplicationOrigin();
    7642              : 
    7643              :     /* Write out all dirty data in SLRUs and the main buffer pool */
    7644              :     TRACE_POSTGRESQL_BUFFER_CHECKPOINT_START(flags);
    7645         1835 :     CheckpointStats.ckpt_write_t = GetCurrentTimestamp();
    7646         1835 :     CheckPointCLOG();
    7647         1835 :     CheckPointCommitTs();
    7648         1835 :     CheckPointSUBTRANS();
    7649         1835 :     CheckPointMultiXact();
    7650         1835 :     CheckPointPredicate();
    7651         1835 :     CheckPointBuffers(flags);
    7652              : 
    7653              :     /* Perform all queued up fsyncs */
    7654              :     TRACE_POSTGRESQL_BUFFER_CHECKPOINT_SYNC_START();
    7655         1835 :     CheckpointStats.ckpt_sync_t = GetCurrentTimestamp();
    7656         1835 :     ProcessSyncRequests();
    7657         1835 :     CheckpointStats.ckpt_sync_end_t = GetCurrentTimestamp();
    7658              :     TRACE_POSTGRESQL_BUFFER_CHECKPOINT_DONE();
    7659              : 
    7660              :     /* We deliberately delay 2PC checkpointing as long as possible */
    7661         1835 :     CheckPointTwoPhase(checkPointRedo);
    7662         1835 : }
    7663              : 
    7664              : /*
    7665              :  * Save a checkpoint for recovery restart if appropriate
    7666              :  *
    7667              :  * This function is called each time a checkpoint record is read from XLOG.
    7668              :  * It must determine whether the checkpoint represents a safe restartpoint or
    7669              :  * not.  If so, the checkpoint record is stashed in shared memory so that
    7670              :  * CreateRestartPoint can consult it.  (Note that the latter function is
    7671              :  * executed by the checkpointer, while this one will be executed by the
    7672              :  * startup process.)
    7673              :  */
    7674              : static void
    7675          735 : RecoveryRestartPoint(const CheckPoint *checkPoint, XLogReaderState *record)
    7676              : {
    7677              :     /*
    7678              :      * Also refrain from creating a restartpoint if we have seen any
    7679              :      * references to non-existent pages. Restarting recovery from the
    7680              :      * restartpoint would not see the references, so we would lose the
    7681              :      * cross-check that the pages belonged to a relation that was dropped
    7682              :      * later.
    7683              :      */
    7684          735 :     if (XLogHaveInvalidPages())
    7685              :     {
    7686            0 :         elog(DEBUG2,
    7687              :              "could not record restart point at %X/%08X because there are unresolved references to invalid pages",
    7688              :              LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(checkPoint->redo));
    7689            0 :         return;
    7690              :     }
    7691              : 
    7692              :     /*
    7693              :      * Copy the checkpoint record to shared memory, so that checkpointer can
    7694              :      * work out the next time it wants to perform a restartpoint.
    7695              :      */
    7696          735 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    7697          735 :     XLogCtl->lastCheckPointRecPtr = record->ReadRecPtr;
    7698          735 :     XLogCtl->lastCheckPointEndPtr = record->EndRecPtr;
    7699          735 :     XLogCtl->lastCheckPoint = *checkPoint;
    7700          735 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    7701              : }
    7702              : 
    7703              : /*
    7704              :  * Establish a restartpoint if possible.
    7705              :  *
    7706              :  * This is similar to CreateCheckPoint, but is used during WAL recovery
    7707              :  * to establish a point from which recovery can roll forward without
    7708              :  * replaying the entire recovery log.
    7709              :  *
    7710              :  * Returns true if a new restartpoint was established. We can only establish
    7711              :  * a restartpoint if we have replayed a safe checkpoint record since last
    7712              :  * restartpoint.
    7713              :  */
    7714              : bool
    7715          615 : CreateRestartPoint(int flags)
    7716              : {
    7717              :     XLogRecPtr  lastCheckPointRecPtr;
    7718              :     XLogRecPtr  lastCheckPointEndPtr;
    7719              :     CheckPoint  lastCheckPoint;
    7720              :     XLogRecPtr  PriorRedoPtr;
    7721              :     XLogRecPtr  receivePtr;
    7722              :     XLogRecPtr  replayPtr;
    7723              :     TimeLineID  replayTLI;
    7724              :     XLogRecPtr  endptr;
    7725              :     XLogSegNo   _logSegNo;
    7726              :     TimestampTz xtime;
    7727              : 
    7728              :     /* Concurrent checkpoint/restartpoint cannot happen */
    7729              :     Assert(!IsUnderPostmaster || MyBackendType == B_CHECKPOINTER);
    7730              : 
    7731              :     /* Get a local copy of the last safe checkpoint record. */
    7732          615 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    7733          615 :     lastCheckPointRecPtr = XLogCtl->lastCheckPointRecPtr;
    7734          615 :     lastCheckPointEndPtr = XLogCtl->lastCheckPointEndPtr;
    7735          615 :     lastCheckPoint = XLogCtl->lastCheckPoint;
    7736          615 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    7737              : 
    7738              :     /*
    7739              :      * Check that we're still in recovery mode. It's ok if we exit recovery
    7740              :      * mode after this check, the restart point is valid anyway.
    7741              :      */
    7742          615 :     if (!RecoveryInProgress())
    7743              :     {
    7744            0 :         ereport(DEBUG2,
    7745              :                 (errmsg_internal("skipping restartpoint, recovery has already ended")));
    7746            0 :         return false;
    7747              :     }
    7748              : 
    7749              :     /*
    7750              :      * If the last checkpoint record we've replayed is already our last
    7751              :      * restartpoint, we can't perform a new restart point. We still update
    7752              :      * minRecoveryPoint in that case, so that if this is a shutdown restart
    7753              :      * point, we won't start up earlier than before. That's not strictly
    7754              :      * necessary, but when hot standby is enabled, it would be rather weird if
    7755              :      * the database opened up for read-only connections at a point-in-time
    7756              :      * before the last shutdown. Such time travel is still possible in case of
    7757              :      * immediate shutdown, though.
    7758              :      *
    7759              :      * We don't explicitly advance minRecoveryPoint when we do create a
    7760              :      * restartpoint. It's assumed that flushing the buffers will do that as a
    7761              :      * side-effect.
    7762              :      */
    7763          615 :     if (!XLogRecPtrIsValid(lastCheckPointRecPtr) ||
    7764          284 :         lastCheckPoint.redo <= ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo)
    7765              :     {
    7766          410 :         ereport(DEBUG2,
    7767              :                 errmsg_internal("skipping restartpoint, already performed at %X/%08X",
    7768              :                                 LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(lastCheckPoint.redo)));
    7769              : 
    7770          410 :         UpdateMinRecoveryPoint(InvalidXLogRecPtr, true);
    7771          410 :         if (flags & CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN)
    7772              :         {
    7773           36 :             LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    7774           36 :             ControlFile->state = DB_SHUTDOWNED_IN_RECOVERY;
    7775           36 :             UpdateControlFile();
    7776           36 :             LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    7777              :         }
    7778          410 :         return false;
    7779              :     }
    7780              : 
    7781              :     /*
    7782              :      * Update the shared RedoRecPtr so that the startup process can calculate
    7783              :      * the number of segments replayed since last restartpoint, and request a
    7784              :      * restartpoint if it exceeds CheckPointSegments.
    7785              :      *
    7786              :      * Like in CreateCheckPoint(), hold off insertions to update it, although
    7787              :      * during recovery this is just pro forma, because no WAL insertions are
    7788              :      * happening.
    7789              :      */
    7790          205 :     WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive();
    7791          205 :     RedoRecPtr = XLogCtl->Insert.RedoRecPtr = lastCheckPoint.redo;
    7792          205 :     WALInsertLockRelease();
    7793              : 
    7794              :     /* Also update the info_lck-protected copy */
    7795          205 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    7796          205 :     XLogCtl->RedoRecPtr = lastCheckPoint.redo;
    7797          205 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    7798              : 
    7799              :     /*
    7800              :      * Prepare to accumulate statistics.
    7801              :      *
    7802              :      * Note: because it is possible for log_checkpoints to change while a
    7803              :      * checkpoint proceeds, we always accumulate stats, even if
    7804              :      * log_checkpoints is currently off.
    7805              :      */
    7806         2255 :     MemSet(&CheckpointStats, 0, sizeof(CheckpointStats));
    7807          205 :     CheckpointStats.ckpt_start_t = GetCurrentTimestamp();
    7808              : 
    7809          205 :     if (log_checkpoints)
    7810          205 :         LogCheckpointStart(flags, true);
    7811              : 
    7812              :     /* Update the process title */
    7813          205 :     update_checkpoint_display(flags, true, false);
    7814              : 
    7815          205 :     CheckPointGuts(lastCheckPoint.redo, flags);
    7816              : 
    7817              :     /*
    7818              :      * This location needs to be after CheckPointGuts() to ensure that some
    7819              :      * work has already happened during this checkpoint.
    7820              :      */
    7821          205 :     INJECTION_POINT("create-restart-point", NULL);
    7822              : 
    7823              :     /*
    7824              :      * Remember the prior checkpoint's redo ptr for
    7825              :      * UpdateCheckPointDistanceEstimate()
    7826              :      */
    7827          205 :     PriorRedoPtr = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo;
    7828              : 
    7829              :     /*
    7830              :      * Update pg_control, using current time.  Check that it still shows an
    7831              :      * older checkpoint, else do nothing; this is a quick hack to make sure
    7832              :      * nothing really bad happens if somehow we get here after the
    7833              :      * end-of-recovery checkpoint.
    7834              :      */
    7835          205 :     LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    7836          205 :     if (ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo < lastCheckPoint.redo)
    7837              :     {
    7838              :         /*
    7839              :          * Update the checkpoint information.  We do this even if the cluster
    7840              :          * does not show DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY to match with the set of WAL
    7841              :          * segments recycled below.
    7842              :          */
    7843          205 :         ControlFile->checkPoint = lastCheckPointRecPtr;
    7844          205 :         ControlFile->checkPointCopy = lastCheckPoint;
    7845              : 
    7846              :         /*
    7847              :          * Ensure minRecoveryPoint is past the checkpoint record and update it
    7848              :          * if the control file still shows DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY.  Normally,
    7849              :          * this will have happened already while writing out dirty buffers,
    7850              :          * but not necessarily - e.g. because no buffers were dirtied.  We do
    7851              :          * this because a backup performed in recovery uses minRecoveryPoint
    7852              :          * to determine which WAL files must be included in the backup, and
    7853              :          * the file (or files) containing the checkpoint record must be
    7854              :          * included, at a minimum.  Note that for an ordinary restart of
    7855              :          * recovery there's no value in having the minimum recovery point any
    7856              :          * earlier than this anyway, because redo will begin just after the
    7857              :          * checkpoint record.
    7858              :          */
    7859          205 :         if (ControlFile->state == DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY)
    7860              :         {
    7861          205 :             if (ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint < lastCheckPointEndPtr)
    7862              :             {
    7863           19 :                 ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = lastCheckPointEndPtr;
    7864           19 :                 ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = lastCheckPoint.ThisTimeLineID;
    7865              : 
    7866              :                 /* update local copy */
    7867           19 :                 LocalMinRecoveryPoint = ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint;
    7868           19 :                 LocalMinRecoveryPointTLI = ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI;
    7869              :             }
    7870          205 :             if (flags & CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN)
    7871           22 :                 ControlFile->state = DB_SHUTDOWNED_IN_RECOVERY;
    7872              :         }
    7873          205 :         UpdateControlFile();
    7874              :     }
    7875          205 :     LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    7876              : 
    7877              :     /*
    7878              :      * Update the average distance between checkpoints/restartpoints if the
    7879              :      * prior checkpoint exists.
    7880              :      */
    7881          205 :     if (XLogRecPtrIsValid(PriorRedoPtr))
    7882          205 :         UpdateCheckPointDistanceEstimate(RedoRecPtr - PriorRedoPtr);
    7883              : 
    7884              :     /*
    7885              :      * Delete old log files, those no longer needed for last restartpoint to
    7886              :      * prevent the disk holding the xlog from growing full.
    7887              :      */
    7888          205 :     XLByteToSeg(RedoRecPtr, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    7889              : 
    7890              :     /*
    7891              :      * Retreat _logSegNo using the current end of xlog replayed or received,
    7892              :      * whichever is later.
    7893              :      */
    7894          205 :     receivePtr = GetWalRcvFlushRecPtr(NULL, NULL);
    7895          205 :     replayPtr = GetXLogReplayRecPtr(&replayTLI);
    7896          205 :     endptr = (receivePtr < replayPtr) ? replayPtr : receivePtr;
    7897          205 :     KeepLogSeg(endptr, &_logSegNo);
    7898              : 
    7899          205 :     INJECTION_POINT("restartpoint-before-slot-invalidation", NULL);
    7900              : 
    7901          205 :     if (InvalidateObsoleteReplicationSlots(RS_INVAL_WAL_REMOVED | RS_INVAL_IDLE_TIMEOUT,
    7902              :                                            _logSegNo, InvalidOid,
    7903              :                                            InvalidTransactionId))
    7904              :     {
    7905              :         /*
    7906              :          * Some slots have been invalidated; recalculate the old-segment
    7907              :          * horizon, starting again from RedoRecPtr.
    7908              :          */
    7909            1 :         XLByteToSeg(RedoRecPtr, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    7910            1 :         KeepLogSeg(endptr, &_logSegNo);
    7911              :     }
    7912          205 :     _logSegNo--;
    7913              : 
    7914              :     /*
    7915              :      * Try to recycle segments on a useful timeline. If we've been promoted
    7916              :      * since the beginning of this restartpoint, use the new timeline chosen
    7917              :      * at end of recovery.  If we're still in recovery, use the timeline we're
    7918              :      * currently replaying.
    7919              :      *
    7920              :      * There is no guarantee that the WAL segments will be useful on the
    7921              :      * current timeline; if recovery proceeds to a new timeline right after
    7922              :      * this, the pre-allocated WAL segments on this timeline will not be used,
    7923              :      * and will go wasted until recycled on the next restartpoint. We'll live
    7924              :      * with that.
    7925              :      */
    7926          205 :     if (!RecoveryInProgress())
    7927            0 :         replayTLI = XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
    7928              : 
    7929          205 :     RemoveOldXlogFiles(_logSegNo, RedoRecPtr, endptr, replayTLI);
    7930              : 
    7931              :     /*
    7932              :      * Make more log segments if needed.  (Do this after recycling old log
    7933              :      * segments, since that may supply some of the needed files.)
    7934              :      */
    7935          205 :     PreallocXlogFiles(endptr, replayTLI);
    7936              : 
    7937              :     /*
    7938              :      * Truncate pg_subtrans if possible.  We can throw away all data before
    7939              :      * the oldest XMIN of any running transaction.  No future transaction will
    7940              :      * attempt to reference any pg_subtrans entry older than that (see Asserts
    7941              :      * in subtrans.c).  When hot standby is disabled, though, we mustn't do
    7942              :      * this because StartupSUBTRANS hasn't been called yet.
    7943              :      */
    7944          205 :     if (EnableHotStandby)
    7945          205 :         TruncateSUBTRANS(GetOldestTransactionIdConsideredRunning());
    7946              : 
    7947              :     /* Real work is done; log and update stats. */
    7948          205 :     LogCheckpointEnd(true, flags);
    7949              : 
    7950              :     /* Reset the process title */
    7951          205 :     update_checkpoint_display(flags, true, true);
    7952              : 
    7953          205 :     xtime = GetLatestXTime();
    7954          205 :     ereport((log_checkpoints ? LOG : DEBUG2),
    7955              :             errmsg("recovery restart point at %X/%08X",
    7956              :                    LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(lastCheckPoint.redo)),
    7957              :             xtime ? errdetail("Last completed transaction was at log time %s.",
    7958              :                               timestamptz_to_str(xtime)) : 0);
    7959              : 
    7960              :     /*
    7961              :      * Finally, execute archive_cleanup_command, if any.
    7962              :      */
    7963          205 :     if (archiveCleanupCommand && strcmp(archiveCleanupCommand, "") != 0)
    7964            0 :         ExecuteRecoveryCommand(archiveCleanupCommand,
    7965              :                                "archive_cleanup_command",
    7966              :                                false,
    7967              :                                WAIT_EVENT_ARCHIVE_CLEANUP_COMMAND);
    7968              : 
    7969          205 :     return true;
    7970              : }
    7971              : 
    7972              : /*
    7973              :  * Report availability of WAL for the given target LSN
    7974              :  *      (typically a slot's restart_lsn)
    7975              :  *
    7976              :  * Returns one of the following enum values:
    7977              :  *
    7978              :  * * WALAVAIL_RESERVED means targetLSN is available and it is in the range of
    7979              :  *   max_wal_size.
    7980              :  *
    7981              :  * * WALAVAIL_EXTENDED means it is still available by preserving extra
    7982              :  *   segments beyond max_wal_size. If max_slot_wal_keep_size is smaller
    7983              :  *   than max_wal_size, this state is not returned.
    7984              :  *
    7985              :  * * WALAVAIL_UNRESERVED means it is being lost and the next checkpoint will
    7986              :  *   remove reserved segments. The walsender using this slot may return to the
    7987              :  *   above.
    7988              :  *
    7989              :  * * WALAVAIL_REMOVED means it has been removed. A replication stream on
    7990              :  *   a slot with this LSN cannot continue.  (Any associated walsender
    7991              :  *   processes should have been terminated already.)
    7992              :  *
    7993              :  * * WALAVAIL_INVALID_LSN means the slot hasn't been set to reserve WAL.
    7994              :  */
    7995              : WALAvailability
    7996          640 : GetWALAvailability(XLogRecPtr targetLSN)
    7997              : {
    7998              :     XLogRecPtr  currpos;        /* current write LSN */
    7999              :     XLogSegNo   currSeg;        /* segid of currpos */
    8000              :     XLogSegNo   targetSeg;      /* segid of targetLSN */
    8001              :     XLogSegNo   oldestSeg;      /* actual oldest segid */
    8002              :     XLogSegNo   oldestSegMaxWalSize;    /* oldest segid kept by max_wal_size */
    8003              :     XLogSegNo   oldestSlotSeg;  /* oldest segid kept by slot */
    8004              :     uint64      keepSegs;
    8005              : 
    8006              :     /*
    8007              :      * slot does not reserve WAL. Either deactivated, or has never been active
    8008              :      */
    8009          640 :     if (!XLogRecPtrIsValid(targetLSN))
    8010           27 :         return WALAVAIL_INVALID_LSN;
    8011              : 
    8012              :     /*
    8013              :      * Calculate the oldest segment currently reserved by all slots,
    8014              :      * considering wal_keep_size and max_slot_wal_keep_size.  Initialize
    8015              :      * oldestSlotSeg to the current segment.
    8016              :      */
    8017          613 :     currpos = GetXLogWriteRecPtr();
    8018          613 :     XLByteToSeg(currpos, oldestSlotSeg, wal_segment_size);
    8019          613 :     KeepLogSeg(currpos, &oldestSlotSeg);
    8020              : 
    8021              :     /*
    8022              :      * Find the oldest extant segment file. We get 1 until checkpoint removes
    8023              :      * the first WAL segment file since startup, which causes the status being
    8024              :      * wrong under certain abnormal conditions but that doesn't actually harm.
    8025              :      */
    8026          613 :     oldestSeg = XLogGetLastRemovedSegno() + 1;
    8027              : 
    8028              :     /* calculate oldest segment by max_wal_size */
    8029          613 :     XLByteToSeg(currpos, currSeg, wal_segment_size);
    8030          613 :     keepSegs = ConvertToXSegs(max_wal_size_mb, wal_segment_size) + 1;
    8031              : 
    8032          613 :     if (currSeg > keepSegs)
    8033            8 :         oldestSegMaxWalSize = currSeg - keepSegs;
    8034              :     else
    8035          605 :         oldestSegMaxWalSize = 1;
    8036              : 
    8037              :     /* the segment we care about */
    8038          613 :     XLByteToSeg(targetLSN, targetSeg, wal_segment_size);
    8039              : 
    8040              :     /*
    8041              :      * No point in returning reserved or extended status values if the
    8042              :      * targetSeg is known to be lost.
    8043              :      */
    8044          613 :     if (targetSeg >= oldestSlotSeg)
    8045              :     {
    8046              :         /* show "reserved" when targetSeg is within max_wal_size */
    8047          612 :         if (targetSeg >= oldestSegMaxWalSize)
    8048          610 :             return WALAVAIL_RESERVED;
    8049              : 
    8050              :         /* being retained by slots exceeding max_wal_size */
    8051            2 :         return WALAVAIL_EXTENDED;
    8052              :     }
    8053              : 
    8054              :     /* WAL segments are no longer retained but haven't been removed yet */
    8055            1 :     if (targetSeg >= oldestSeg)
    8056            1 :         return WALAVAIL_UNRESERVED;
    8057              : 
    8058              :     /* Definitely lost */
    8059            0 :     return WALAVAIL_REMOVED;
    8060              : }
    8061              : 
    8062              : 
    8063              : /*
    8064              :  * Retreat *logSegNo to the last segment that we need to retain because of
    8065              :  * either wal_keep_size or replication slots.
    8066              :  *
    8067              :  * This is calculated by subtracting wal_keep_size from the given xlog
    8068              :  * location, recptr and by making sure that that result is below the
    8069              :  * requirement of replication slots.  For the latter criterion we do consider
    8070              :  * the effects of max_slot_wal_keep_size: reserve at most that much space back
    8071              :  * from recptr.
    8072              :  *
    8073              :  * Note about replication slots: if this function calculates a value
    8074              :  * that's further ahead than what slots need reserved, then affected
    8075              :  * slots need to be invalidated and this function invoked again.
    8076              :  * XXX it might be a good idea to rewrite this function so that
    8077              :  * invalidation is optionally done here, instead.
    8078              :  */
    8079              : static void
    8080         2453 : KeepLogSeg(XLogRecPtr recptr, XLogSegNo *logSegNo)
    8081              : {
    8082              :     XLogSegNo   currSegNo;
    8083              :     XLogSegNo   segno;
    8084              :     XLogRecPtr  keep;
    8085              : 
    8086         2453 :     XLByteToSeg(recptr, currSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    8087         2453 :     segno = currSegNo;
    8088              : 
    8089              :     /* Calculate how many segments are kept by slots. */
    8090         2453 :     keep = XLogGetReplicationSlotMinimumLSN();
    8091         2453 :     if (XLogRecPtrIsValid(keep) && keep < recptr)
    8092              :     {
    8093          772 :         XLByteToSeg(keep, segno, wal_segment_size);
    8094              : 
    8095              :         /*
    8096              :          * Account for max_slot_wal_keep_size to avoid keeping more than
    8097              :          * configured.  However, don't do that during a binary upgrade: if
    8098              :          * slots were to be invalidated because of this, it would not be
    8099              :          * possible to preserve logical ones during the upgrade.
    8100              :          */
    8101          772 :         if (max_slot_wal_keep_size_mb >= 0 && !IsBinaryUpgrade)
    8102              :         {
    8103              :             uint64      slot_keep_segs;
    8104              : 
    8105           23 :             slot_keep_segs =
    8106           23 :                 ConvertToXSegs(max_slot_wal_keep_size_mb, wal_segment_size);
    8107              : 
    8108           23 :             if (currSegNo - segno > slot_keep_segs)
    8109            6 :                 segno = currSegNo - slot_keep_segs;
    8110              :         }
    8111              :     }
    8112              : 
    8113              :     /*
    8114              :      * If WAL summarization is in use, don't remove WAL that has yet to be
    8115              :      * summarized.
    8116              :      */
    8117         2453 :     keep = GetOldestUnsummarizedLSN(NULL, NULL);
    8118         2453 :     if (XLogRecPtrIsValid(keep))
    8119              :     {
    8120              :         XLogSegNo   unsummarized_segno;
    8121              : 
    8122            7 :         XLByteToSeg(keep, unsummarized_segno, wal_segment_size);
    8123            7 :         if (unsummarized_segno < segno)
    8124            7 :             segno = unsummarized_segno;
    8125              :     }
    8126              : 
    8127              :     /* but, keep at least wal_keep_size if that's set */
    8128         2453 :     if (wal_keep_size_mb > 0)
    8129              :     {
    8130              :         uint64      keep_segs;
    8131              : 
    8132           74 :         keep_segs = ConvertToXSegs(wal_keep_size_mb, wal_segment_size);
    8133           74 :         if (currSegNo - segno < keep_segs)
    8134              :         {
    8135              :             /* avoid underflow, don't go below 1 */
    8136           74 :             if (currSegNo <= keep_segs)
    8137           70 :                 segno = 1;
    8138              :             else
    8139            4 :                 segno = currSegNo - keep_segs;
    8140              :         }
    8141              :     }
    8142              : 
    8143              :     /* don't delete WAL segments newer than the calculated segment */
    8144         2453 :     if (segno < *logSegNo)
    8145          364 :         *logSegNo = segno;
    8146         2453 : }
    8147              : 
    8148              : /*
    8149              :  * Write a NEXTOID log record
    8150              :  */
    8151              : void
    8152          654 : XLogPutNextOid(Oid nextOid)
    8153              : {
    8154          654 :     XLogBeginInsert();
    8155          654 :     XLogRegisterData(&nextOid, sizeof(Oid));
    8156          654 :     (void) XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_NEXTOID);
    8157              : 
    8158              :     /*
    8159              :      * We need not flush the NEXTOID record immediately, because any of the
    8160              :      * just-allocated OIDs could only reach disk as part of a tuple insert or
    8161              :      * update that would have its own XLOG record that must follow the NEXTOID
    8162              :      * record.  Therefore, the standard buffer LSN interlock applied to those
    8163              :      * records will ensure no such OID reaches disk before the NEXTOID record
    8164              :      * does.
    8165              :      *
    8166              :      * Note, however, that the above statement only covers state "within" the
    8167              :      * database.  When we use a generated OID as a file or directory name, we
    8168              :      * are in a sense violating the basic WAL rule, because that filesystem
    8169              :      * change may reach disk before the NEXTOID WAL record does.  The impact
    8170              :      * of this is that if a database crash occurs immediately afterward, we
    8171              :      * might after restart re-generate the same OID and find that it conflicts
    8172              :      * with the leftover file or directory.  But since for safety's sake we
    8173              :      * always loop until finding a nonconflicting filename, this poses no real
    8174              :      * problem in practice. See pgsql-hackers discussion 27-Sep-2006.
    8175              :      */
    8176          654 : }
    8177              : 
    8178              : /*
    8179              :  * Write an XLOG SWITCH record.
    8180              :  *
    8181              :  * Here we just blindly issue an XLogInsert request for the record.
    8182              :  * All the magic happens inside XLogInsert.
    8183              :  *
    8184              :  * The return value is either the end+1 address of the switch record,
    8185              :  * or the end+1 address of the prior segment if we did not need to
    8186              :  * write a switch record because we are already at segment start.
    8187              :  */
    8188              : XLogRecPtr
    8189          812 : RequestXLogSwitch(bool mark_unimportant)
    8190              : {
    8191              :     XLogRecPtr  RecPtr;
    8192              : 
    8193              :     /* XLOG SWITCH has no data */
    8194          812 :     XLogBeginInsert();
    8195              : 
    8196          812 :     if (mark_unimportant)
    8197            0 :         XLogSetRecordFlags(XLOG_MARK_UNIMPORTANT);
    8198          812 :     RecPtr = XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_SWITCH);
    8199              : 
    8200          812 :     return RecPtr;
    8201              : }
    8202              : 
    8203              : /*
    8204              :  * Write a RESTORE POINT record
    8205              :  */
    8206              : XLogRecPtr
    8207            3 : XLogRestorePoint(const char *rpName)
    8208              : {
    8209              :     XLogRecPtr  RecPtr;
    8210              :     xl_restore_point xlrec;
    8211              : 
    8212            3 :     xlrec.rp_time = GetCurrentTimestamp();
    8213            3 :     strlcpy(xlrec.rp_name, rpName, MAXFNAMELEN);
    8214              : 
    8215            3 :     XLogBeginInsert();
    8216            3 :     XLogRegisterData(&xlrec, sizeof(xl_restore_point));
    8217              : 
    8218            3 :     RecPtr = XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_RESTORE_POINT);
    8219              : 
    8220            3 :     ereport(LOG,
    8221              :             errmsg("restore point \"%s\" created at %X/%08X",
    8222              :                    rpName, LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(RecPtr)));
    8223              : 
    8224            3 :     return RecPtr;
    8225              : }
    8226              : 
    8227              : /*
    8228              :  * Write an empty XLOG record to assign a distinct LSN.
    8229              :  *
    8230              :  * This is used by some index AMs when building indexes on permanent relations
    8231              :  * with wal_level=minimal.  In that scenario, WAL-logging will start after
    8232              :  * commit, but the index AM needs distinct LSNs to detect concurrent page
    8233              :  * modifications.  When the current WAL insert position hasn't advanced since
    8234              :  * the last call, we emit a dummy record to ensure we get a new, distinct LSN.
    8235              :  */
    8236              : XLogRecPtr
    8237        94833 : XLogAssignLSN(void)
    8238              : {
    8239        94833 :     int         dummy = 0;
    8240              : 
    8241              :     /*
    8242              :      * Records other than XLOG_SWITCH must have content.  We use an integer 0
    8243              :      * to satisfy this restriction.
    8244              :      */
    8245        94833 :     XLogBeginInsert();
    8246        94833 :     XLogSetRecordFlags(XLOG_MARK_UNIMPORTANT);
    8247        94833 :     XLogRegisterData(&dummy, sizeof(dummy));
    8248        94833 :     return XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_ASSIGN_LSN);
    8249              : }
    8250              : 
    8251              : /*
    8252              :  * Check if any of the GUC parameters that are critical for hot standby
    8253              :  * have changed, and update the value in pg_control file if necessary.
    8254              :  */
    8255              : static void
    8256          970 : XLogReportParameters(void)
    8257              : {
    8258          970 :     if (wal_level != ControlFile->wal_level ||
    8259          708 :         wal_log_hints != ControlFile->wal_log_hints ||
    8260          621 :         MaxConnections != ControlFile->MaxConnections ||
    8261          620 :         max_worker_processes != ControlFile->max_worker_processes ||
    8262          617 :         max_wal_senders != ControlFile->max_wal_senders ||
    8263          590 :         max_prepared_xacts != ControlFile->max_prepared_xacts ||
    8264          487 :         max_locks_per_xact != ControlFile->max_locks_per_xact ||
    8265          487 :         track_commit_timestamp != ControlFile->track_commit_timestamp)
    8266              :     {
    8267              :         /*
    8268              :          * The change in number of backend slots doesn't need to be WAL-logged
    8269              :          * if archiving is not enabled, as you can't start archive recovery
    8270              :          * with wal_level=minimal anyway. We don't really care about the
    8271              :          * values in pg_control either if wal_level=minimal, but seems better
    8272              :          * to keep them up-to-date to avoid confusion.
    8273              :          */
    8274          495 :         if (wal_level != ControlFile->wal_level || XLogIsNeeded())
    8275              :         {
    8276              :             xl_parameter_change xlrec;
    8277              :             XLogRecPtr  recptr;
    8278              : 
    8279          468 :             xlrec.MaxConnections = MaxConnections;
    8280          468 :             xlrec.max_worker_processes = max_worker_processes;
    8281          468 :             xlrec.max_wal_senders = max_wal_senders;
    8282          468 :             xlrec.max_prepared_xacts = max_prepared_xacts;
    8283          468 :             xlrec.max_locks_per_xact = max_locks_per_xact;
    8284          468 :             xlrec.wal_level = wal_level;
    8285          468 :             xlrec.wal_log_hints = wal_log_hints;
    8286          468 :             xlrec.track_commit_timestamp = track_commit_timestamp;
    8287              : 
    8288          468 :             XLogBeginInsert();
    8289          468 :             XLogRegisterData(&xlrec, sizeof(xlrec));
    8290              : 
    8291          468 :             recptr = XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_PARAMETER_CHANGE);
    8292          468 :             XLogFlush(recptr);
    8293              :         }
    8294              : 
    8295          495 :         LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    8296              : 
    8297          495 :         ControlFile->MaxConnections = MaxConnections;
    8298          495 :         ControlFile->max_worker_processes = max_worker_processes;
    8299          495 :         ControlFile->max_wal_senders = max_wal_senders;
    8300          495 :         ControlFile->max_prepared_xacts = max_prepared_xacts;
    8301          495 :         ControlFile->max_locks_per_xact = max_locks_per_xact;
    8302          495 :         ControlFile->wal_level = wal_level;
    8303          495 :         ControlFile->wal_log_hints = wal_log_hints;
    8304          495 :         ControlFile->track_commit_timestamp = track_commit_timestamp;
    8305          495 :         UpdateControlFile();
    8306              : 
    8307          495 :         LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    8308              :     }
    8309          970 : }
    8310              : 
    8311              : /*
    8312              :  * Update full_page_writes in shared memory, and write an
    8313              :  * XLOG_FPW_CHANGE record if necessary.
    8314              :  *
    8315              :  * Note: this function assumes there is no other process running
    8316              :  * concurrently that could update it.
    8317              :  */
    8318              : void
    8319         1655 : UpdateFullPageWrites(void)
    8320              : {
    8321         1655 :     XLogCtlInsert *Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert;
    8322              :     bool        recoveryInProgress;
    8323              : 
    8324              :     /*
    8325              :      * Do nothing if full_page_writes has not been changed.
    8326              :      *
    8327              :      * It's safe to check the shared full_page_writes without the lock,
    8328              :      * because we assume that there is no concurrently running process which
    8329              :      * can update it.
    8330              :      */
    8331         1655 :     if (fullPageWrites == Insert->fullPageWrites)
    8332         1212 :         return;
    8333              : 
    8334              :     /*
    8335              :      * Perform this outside critical section so that the WAL insert
    8336              :      * initialization done by RecoveryInProgress() doesn't trigger an
    8337              :      * assertion failure.
    8338              :      */
    8339          443 :     recoveryInProgress = RecoveryInProgress();
    8340              : 
    8341          443 :     START_CRIT_SECTION();
    8342              : 
    8343              :     /*
    8344              :      * It's always safe to take full page images, even when not strictly
    8345              :      * required, but not the other round. So if we're setting full_page_writes
    8346              :      * to true, first set it true and then write the WAL record. If we're
    8347              :      * setting it to false, first write the WAL record and then set the global
    8348              :      * flag.
    8349              :      */
    8350          443 :     if (fullPageWrites)
    8351              :     {
    8352          431 :         WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive();
    8353          431 :         Insert->fullPageWrites = true;
    8354          431 :         WALInsertLockRelease();
    8355              :     }
    8356              : 
    8357              :     /*
    8358              :      * Write an XLOG_FPW_CHANGE record. This allows us to keep track of
    8359              :      * full_page_writes during archive recovery, if required.
    8360              :      */
    8361          443 :     if (XLogStandbyInfoActive() && !recoveryInProgress)
    8362              :     {
    8363            0 :         XLogBeginInsert();
    8364            0 :         XLogRegisterData(&fullPageWrites, sizeof(bool));
    8365              : 
    8366            0 :         XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_FPW_CHANGE);
    8367              :     }
    8368              : 
    8369          443 :     if (!fullPageWrites)
    8370              :     {
    8371           12 :         WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive();
    8372           12 :         Insert->fullPageWrites = false;
    8373           12 :         WALInsertLockRelease();
    8374              :     }
    8375          443 :     END_CRIT_SECTION();
    8376              : }
    8377              : 
    8378              : /*
    8379              :  * XLOG resource manager's routines
    8380              :  *
    8381              :  * Definitions of info values are in include/catalog/pg_control.h, though
    8382              :  * not all record types are related to control file updates.
    8383              :  *
    8384              :  * NOTE: Some XLOG record types that are directly related to WAL recovery
    8385              :  * are handled in xlogrecovery_redo().
    8386              :  */
    8387              : void
    8388       106897 : xlog_redo(XLogReaderState *record)
    8389              : {
    8390       106897 :     uint8       info = XLogRecGetInfo(record) & ~XLR_INFO_MASK;
    8391       106897 :     XLogRecPtr  lsn = record->EndRecPtr;
    8392              : 
    8393              :     /*
    8394              :      * In XLOG rmgr, backup blocks are only used by XLOG_FPI and
    8395              :      * XLOG_FPI_FOR_HINT records.
    8396              :      */
    8397              :     Assert(info == XLOG_FPI || info == XLOG_FPI_FOR_HINT ||
    8398              :            !XLogRecHasAnyBlockRefs(record));
    8399              : 
    8400       106897 :     if (info == XLOG_NEXTOID)
    8401              :     {
    8402              :         Oid         nextOid;
    8403              : 
    8404              :         /*
    8405              :          * We used to try to take the maximum of TransamVariables->nextOid and
    8406              :          * the recorded nextOid, but that fails if the OID counter wraps
    8407              :          * around.  Since no OID allocation should be happening during replay
    8408              :          * anyway, better to just believe the record exactly.  We still take
    8409              :          * OidGenLock while setting the variable, just in case.
    8410              :          */
    8411           95 :         memcpy(&nextOid, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(Oid));
    8412           95 :         LWLockAcquire(OidGenLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    8413           95 :         TransamVariables->nextOid = nextOid;
    8414           95 :         TransamVariables->oidCount = 0;
    8415           95 :         LWLockRelease(OidGenLock);
    8416              :     }
    8417       106802 :     else if (info == XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN)
    8418              :     {
    8419              :         CheckPoint  checkPoint;
    8420              :         TimeLineID  replayTLI;
    8421              : 
    8422           41 :         memcpy(&checkPoint, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(CheckPoint));
    8423              :         /* In a SHUTDOWN checkpoint, believe the counters exactly */
    8424           41 :         LWLockAcquire(XidGenLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    8425           41 :         TransamVariables->nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
    8426           41 :         LWLockRelease(XidGenLock);
    8427           41 :         LWLockAcquire(OidGenLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    8428           41 :         TransamVariables->nextOid = checkPoint.nextOid;
    8429           41 :         TransamVariables->oidCount = 0;
    8430           41 :         LWLockRelease(OidGenLock);
    8431           41 :         MultiXactSetNextMXact(checkPoint.nextMulti,
    8432              :                               checkPoint.nextMultiOffset);
    8433              : 
    8434           41 :         MultiXactAdvanceOldest(checkPoint.oldestMulti,
    8435              :                                checkPoint.oldestMultiDB);
    8436              : 
    8437              :         /*
    8438              :          * No need to set oldestClogXid here as well; it'll be set when we
    8439              :          * redo an xl_clog_truncate if it changed since initialization.
    8440              :          */
    8441           41 :         SetTransactionIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestXid, checkPoint.oldestXidDB);
    8442              : 
    8443              :         /*
    8444              :          * If we see a shutdown checkpoint while waiting for an end-of-backup
    8445              :          * record, the backup was canceled and the end-of-backup record will
    8446              :          * never arrive.
    8447              :          */
    8448           41 :         if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested &&
    8449           41 :             XLogRecPtrIsValid(ControlFile->backupStartPoint) &&
    8450            0 :             !XLogRecPtrIsValid(ControlFile->backupEndPoint))
    8451            0 :             ereport(PANIC,
    8452              :                     (errmsg("online backup was canceled, recovery cannot continue")));
    8453              : 
    8454              :         /*
    8455              :          * If we see a shutdown checkpoint, we know that nothing was running
    8456              :          * on the primary at this point. So fake-up an empty running-xacts
    8457              :          * record and use that here and now. Recover additional standby state
    8458              :          * for prepared transactions.
    8459              :          */
    8460           41 :         if (standbyState >= STANDBY_INITIALIZED)
    8461              :         {
    8462              :             TransactionId *xids;
    8463              :             int         nxids;
    8464              :             TransactionId oldestActiveXID;
    8465              :             TransactionId latestCompletedXid;
    8466              :             RunningTransactionsData running;
    8467              : 
    8468           39 :             oldestActiveXID = PrescanPreparedTransactions(&xids, &nxids);
    8469              : 
    8470              :             /* Update pg_subtrans entries for any prepared transactions */
    8471           39 :             StandbyRecoverPreparedTransactions();
    8472              : 
    8473              :             /*
    8474              :              * Construct a RunningTransactions snapshot representing a shut
    8475              :              * down server, with only prepared transactions still alive. We're
    8476              :              * never overflowed at this point because all subxids are listed
    8477              :              * with their parent prepared transactions.
    8478              :              */
    8479           39 :             running.xcnt = nxids;
    8480           39 :             running.subxcnt = 0;
    8481           39 :             running.subxid_status = SUBXIDS_IN_SUBTRANS;
    8482           39 :             running.nextXid = XidFromFullTransactionId(checkPoint.nextXid);
    8483           39 :             running.oldestRunningXid = oldestActiveXID;
    8484           39 :             latestCompletedXid = XidFromFullTransactionId(checkPoint.nextXid);
    8485           39 :             TransactionIdRetreat(latestCompletedXid);
    8486              :             Assert(TransactionIdIsNormal(latestCompletedXid));
    8487           39 :             running.latestCompletedXid = latestCompletedXid;
    8488           39 :             running.xids = xids;
    8489              : 
    8490           39 :             ProcArrayApplyRecoveryInfo(&running);
    8491              :         }
    8492              : 
    8493              :         /* ControlFile->checkPointCopy always tracks the latest ckpt XID */
    8494           41 :         LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    8495           41 :         ControlFile->checkPointCopy.nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
    8496           41 :         LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    8497              : 
    8498              :         /*
    8499              :          * We should've already switched to the new TLI before replaying this
    8500              :          * record.
    8501              :          */
    8502           41 :         (void) GetCurrentReplayRecPtr(&replayTLI);
    8503           41 :         if (checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID != replayTLI)
    8504            0 :             ereport(PANIC,
    8505              :                     (errmsg("unexpected timeline ID %u (should be %u) in shutdown checkpoint record",
    8506              :                             checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID, replayTLI)));
    8507              : 
    8508           41 :         RecoveryRestartPoint(&checkPoint, record);
    8509              : 
    8510              :         /*
    8511              :          * After replaying a checkpoint record, free all smgr objects.
    8512              :          * Otherwise we would never do so for dropped relations, as the
    8513              :          * startup does not process shared invalidation messages or call
    8514              :          * AtEOXact_SMgr().
    8515              :          */
    8516           41 :         smgrdestroyall();
    8517              :     }
    8518       106761 :     else if (info == XLOG_CHECKPOINT_ONLINE)
    8519              :     {
    8520              :         CheckPoint  checkPoint;
    8521              :         TimeLineID  replayTLI;
    8522              : 
    8523          694 :         memcpy(&checkPoint, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(CheckPoint));
    8524              :         /* In an ONLINE checkpoint, treat the XID counter as a minimum */
    8525          694 :         LWLockAcquire(XidGenLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    8526          694 :         if (FullTransactionIdPrecedes(TransamVariables->nextXid,
    8527              :                                       checkPoint.nextXid))
    8528            0 :             TransamVariables->nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
    8529          694 :         LWLockRelease(XidGenLock);
    8530              : 
    8531              :         /*
    8532              :          * We ignore the nextOid counter in an ONLINE checkpoint, preferring
    8533              :          * to track OID assignment through XLOG_NEXTOID records.  The nextOid
    8534              :          * counter is from the start of the checkpoint and might well be stale
    8535              :          * compared to later XLOG_NEXTOID records.  We could try to take the
    8536              :          * maximum of the nextOid counter and our latest value, but since
    8537              :          * there's no particular guarantee about the speed with which the OID
    8538              :          * counter wraps around, that's a risky thing to do.  In any case,
    8539              :          * users of the nextOid counter are required to avoid assignment of
    8540              :          * duplicates, so that a somewhat out-of-date value should be safe.
    8541              :          */
    8542              : 
    8543              :         /* Handle multixact */
    8544          694 :         MultiXactAdvanceNextMXact(checkPoint.nextMulti,
    8545              :                                   checkPoint.nextMultiOffset);
    8546              : 
    8547              :         /*
    8548              :          * NB: This may perform multixact truncation when replaying WAL
    8549              :          * generated by an older primary.
    8550              :          */
    8551          694 :         MultiXactAdvanceOldest(checkPoint.oldestMulti,
    8552              :                                checkPoint.oldestMultiDB);
    8553          694 :         if (TransactionIdPrecedes(TransamVariables->oldestXid,
    8554              :                                   checkPoint.oldestXid))
    8555            0 :             SetTransactionIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestXid,
    8556              :                                   checkPoint.oldestXidDB);
    8557              :         /* ControlFile->checkPointCopy always tracks the latest ckpt XID */
    8558          694 :         LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    8559          694 :         ControlFile->checkPointCopy.nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
    8560          694 :         LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    8561              : 
    8562              :         /* TLI should not change in an on-line checkpoint */
    8563          694 :         (void) GetCurrentReplayRecPtr(&replayTLI);
    8564          694 :         if (checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID != replayTLI)
    8565            0 :             ereport(PANIC,
    8566              :                     (errmsg("unexpected timeline ID %u (should be %u) in online checkpoint record",
    8567              :                             checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID, replayTLI)));
    8568              : 
    8569          694 :         RecoveryRestartPoint(&checkPoint, record);
    8570              : 
    8571              :         /*
    8572              :          * After replaying a checkpoint record, free all smgr objects.
    8573              :          * Otherwise we would never do so for dropped relations, as the
    8574              :          * startup does not process shared invalidation messages or call
    8575              :          * AtEOXact_SMgr().
    8576              :          */
    8577          694 :         smgrdestroyall();
    8578              :     }
    8579       106067 :     else if (info == XLOG_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD)
    8580              :     {
    8581              :         /* nothing to do here, handled in xlogrecovery_redo() */
    8582              :     }
    8583       106066 :     else if (info == XLOG_END_OF_RECOVERY)
    8584              :     {
    8585              :         xl_end_of_recovery xlrec;
    8586              :         TimeLineID  replayTLI;
    8587              : 
    8588           10 :         memcpy(&xlrec, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(xl_end_of_recovery));
    8589              : 
    8590              :         /*
    8591              :          * For Hot Standby, we could treat this like a Shutdown Checkpoint,
    8592              :          * but this case is rarer and harder to test, so the benefit doesn't
    8593              :          * outweigh the potential extra cost of maintenance.
    8594              :          */
    8595              : 
    8596              :         /*
    8597              :          * We should've already switched to the new TLI before replaying this
    8598              :          * record.
    8599              :          */
    8600           10 :         (void) GetCurrentReplayRecPtr(&replayTLI);
    8601           10 :         if (xlrec.ThisTimeLineID != replayTLI)
    8602            0 :             ereport(PANIC,
    8603              :                     (errmsg("unexpected timeline ID %u (should be %u) in end-of-recovery record",
    8604              :                             xlrec.ThisTimeLineID, replayTLI)));
    8605              :     }
    8606       106056 :     else if (info == XLOG_NOOP)
    8607              :     {
    8608              :         /* nothing to do here */
    8609              :     }
    8610       106056 :     else if (info == XLOG_SWITCH)
    8611              :     {
    8612              :         /* nothing to do here */
    8613              :     }
    8614       105602 :     else if (info == XLOG_RESTORE_POINT)
    8615              :     {
    8616              :         /* nothing to do here, handled in xlogrecovery.c */
    8617              :     }
    8618       105597 :     else if (info == XLOG_ASSIGN_LSN)
    8619              :     {
    8620              :         /* nothing to do here, see XLogGetFakeLSN() */
    8621              :     }
    8622        43271 :     else if (info == XLOG_FPI || info == XLOG_FPI_FOR_HINT)
    8623              :     {
    8624              :         /*
    8625              :          * XLOG_FPI records contain nothing else but one or more block
    8626              :          * references. Every block reference must include a full-page image
    8627              :          * even if full_page_writes was disabled when the record was generated
    8628              :          * - otherwise there would be no point in this record.
    8629              :          *
    8630              :          * XLOG_FPI_FOR_HINT records are generated when a page needs to be
    8631              :          * WAL-logged because of a hint bit update. They are only generated
    8632              :          * when checksums and/or wal_log_hints are enabled. They may include
    8633              :          * no full-page images if full_page_writes was disabled when they were
    8634              :          * generated. In this case there is nothing to do here.
    8635              :          *
    8636              :          * No recovery conflicts are generated by these generic records - if a
    8637              :          * resource manager needs to generate conflicts, it has to define a
    8638              :          * separate WAL record type and redo routine.
    8639              :          */
    8640        89731 :         for (uint8 block_id = 0; block_id <= XLogRecMaxBlockId(record); block_id++)
    8641              :         {
    8642              :             Buffer      buffer;
    8643              : 
    8644        47306 :             if (!XLogRecHasBlockImage(record, block_id))
    8645              :             {
    8646           66 :                 if (info == XLOG_FPI)
    8647            0 :                     elog(ERROR, "XLOG_FPI record did not contain a full-page image");
    8648           66 :                 continue;
    8649              :             }
    8650              : 
    8651        47240 :             if (XLogReadBufferForRedo(record, block_id, &buffer) != BLK_RESTORED)
    8652            0 :                 elog(ERROR, "unexpected XLogReadBufferForRedo result when restoring backup block");
    8653        47240 :             UnlockReleaseBuffer(buffer);
    8654              :         }
    8655              :     }
    8656          846 :     else if (info == XLOG_BACKUP_END)
    8657              :     {
    8658              :         /* nothing to do here, handled in xlogrecovery_redo() */
    8659              :     }
    8660          751 :     else if (info == XLOG_PARAMETER_CHANGE)
    8661              :     {
    8662              :         xl_parameter_change xlrec;
    8663              : 
    8664              :         /* Update our copy of the parameters in pg_control */
    8665           38 :         memcpy(&xlrec, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(xl_parameter_change));
    8666              : 
    8667           38 :         LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    8668           38 :         ControlFile->MaxConnections = xlrec.MaxConnections;
    8669           38 :         ControlFile->max_worker_processes = xlrec.max_worker_processes;
    8670           38 :         ControlFile->max_wal_senders = xlrec.max_wal_senders;
    8671           38 :         ControlFile->max_prepared_xacts = xlrec.max_prepared_xacts;
    8672           38 :         ControlFile->max_locks_per_xact = xlrec.max_locks_per_xact;
    8673           38 :         ControlFile->wal_level = xlrec.wal_level;
    8674           38 :         ControlFile->wal_log_hints = xlrec.wal_log_hints;
    8675              : 
    8676              :         /*
    8677              :          * Update minRecoveryPoint to ensure that if recovery is aborted, we
    8678              :          * recover back up to this point before allowing hot standby again.
    8679              :          * This is important if the max_* settings are decreased, to ensure
    8680              :          * you don't run queries against the WAL preceding the change. The
    8681              :          * local copies cannot be updated as long as crash recovery is
    8682              :          * happening and we expect all the WAL to be replayed.
    8683              :          */
    8684           38 :         if (InArchiveRecovery)
    8685              :         {
    8686           23 :             LocalMinRecoveryPoint = ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint;
    8687           23 :             LocalMinRecoveryPointTLI = ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI;
    8688              :         }
    8689           38 :         if (XLogRecPtrIsValid(LocalMinRecoveryPoint) && LocalMinRecoveryPoint < lsn)
    8690              :         {
    8691              :             TimeLineID  replayTLI;
    8692              : 
    8693           12 :             (void) GetCurrentReplayRecPtr(&replayTLI);
    8694           12 :             ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = lsn;
    8695           12 :             ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = replayTLI;
    8696              :         }
    8697              : 
    8698           38 :         CommitTsParameterChange(xlrec.track_commit_timestamp,
    8699           38 :                                 ControlFile->track_commit_timestamp);
    8700           38 :         ControlFile->track_commit_timestamp = xlrec.track_commit_timestamp;
    8701              : 
    8702           38 :         UpdateControlFile();
    8703           38 :         LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    8704              : 
    8705              :         /* Check to see if any parameter change gives a problem on recovery */
    8706           38 :         CheckRequiredParameterValues();
    8707              :     }
    8708          713 :     else if (info == XLOG_FPW_CHANGE)
    8709              :     {
    8710              :         bool        fpw;
    8711              : 
    8712            0 :         memcpy(&fpw, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(bool));
    8713              : 
    8714              :         /*
    8715              :          * Update the LSN of the last replayed XLOG_FPW_CHANGE record so that
    8716              :          * do_pg_backup_start() and do_pg_backup_stop() can check whether
    8717              :          * full_page_writes has been disabled during online backup.
    8718              :          */
    8719            0 :         if (!fpw)
    8720              :         {
    8721            0 :             SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    8722            0 :             if (XLogCtl->lastFpwDisableRecPtr < record->ReadRecPtr)
    8723            0 :                 XLogCtl->lastFpwDisableRecPtr = record->ReadRecPtr;
    8724            0 :             SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    8725              :         }
    8726              : 
    8727              :         /* Keep track of full_page_writes */
    8728            0 :         lastFullPageWrites = fpw;
    8729              :     }
    8730          713 :     else if (info == XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO)
    8731              :     {
    8732              :         /* nothing to do here, just for informational purposes */
    8733              :     }
    8734           18 :     else if (info == XLOG_LOGICAL_DECODING_STATUS_CHANGE)
    8735              :     {
    8736              :         bool        status;
    8737              : 
    8738           18 :         memcpy(&status, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(bool));
    8739              : 
    8740              :         /*
    8741              :          * We need to toggle the logical decoding status and update the
    8742              :          * XLogLogicalInfo cache of processes synchronously because
    8743              :          * XLogLogicalInfoActive() is used even during read-only queries
    8744              :          * (e.g., via RelationIsAccessibleInLogicalDecoding()). In the
    8745              :          * 'disable' case, it is safe to invalidate existing slots after
    8746              :          * disabling logical decoding because logical decoding cannot process
    8747              :          * subsequent WAL records, which may not contain logical information.
    8748              :          */
    8749           18 :         if (status)
    8750            9 :             EnableLogicalDecoding();
    8751              :         else
    8752            9 :             DisableLogicalDecoding();
    8753              : 
    8754           18 :         elog(DEBUG1, "update logical decoding status to %d during recovery",
    8755              :              status);
    8756              : 
    8757           18 :         if (InRecovery && InHotStandby)
    8758              :         {
    8759           16 :             if (!status)
    8760              :             {
    8761              :                 /*
    8762              :                  * Invalidate logical slots if we are in hot standby and the
    8763              :                  * primary disabled logical decoding.
    8764              :                  */
    8765            9 :                 InvalidateObsoleteReplicationSlots(RS_INVAL_WAL_LEVEL,
    8766              :                                                    0, InvalidOid,
    8767              :                                                    InvalidTransactionId);
    8768              :             }
    8769            7 :             else if (sync_replication_slots)
    8770              :             {
    8771              :                 /*
    8772              :                  * Signal the postmaster to launch the slotsync worker.
    8773              :                  *
    8774              :                  * XXX: For simplicity, we keep the slotsync worker running
    8775              :                  * even after logical decoding is disabled. A future
    8776              :                  * improvement can consider starting and stopping the worker
    8777              :                  * based on logical decoding status change.
    8778              :                  */
    8779            0 :                 kill(PostmasterPid, SIGUSR1);
    8780              :             }
    8781              :         }
    8782              :     }
    8783       106895 : }
    8784              : 
    8785              : /*
    8786              :  * Return the extra open flags used for opening a file, depending on the
    8787              :  * value of the GUCs wal_sync_method, fsync and debug_io_direct.
    8788              :  */
    8789              : static int
    8790        17265 : get_sync_bit(int method)
    8791              : {
    8792        17265 :     int         o_direct_flag = 0;
    8793              : 
    8794              :     /*
    8795              :      * Use O_DIRECT if requested, except in walreceiver process.  The WAL
    8796              :      * written by walreceiver is normally read by the startup process soon
    8797              :      * after it's written.  Also, walreceiver performs unaligned writes, which
    8798              :      * don't work with O_DIRECT, so it is required for correctness too.
    8799              :      */
    8800        17265 :     if ((io_direct_flags & IO_DIRECT_WAL) && !AmWalReceiverProcess())
    8801           10 :         o_direct_flag = PG_O_DIRECT;
    8802              : 
    8803              :     /* If fsync is disabled, never open in sync mode */
    8804        17265 :     if (!enableFsync)
    8805        17265 :         return o_direct_flag;
    8806              : 
    8807            0 :     switch (method)
    8808              :     {
    8809              :             /*
    8810              :              * enum values for all sync options are defined even if they are
    8811              :              * not supported on the current platform.  But if not, they are
    8812              :              * not included in the enum option array, and therefore will never
    8813              :              * be seen here.
    8814              :              */
    8815            0 :         case WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC:
    8816              :         case WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC_WRITETHROUGH:
    8817              :         case WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FDATASYNC:
    8818            0 :             return o_direct_flag;
    8819              : #ifdef O_SYNC
    8820            0 :         case WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN:
    8821            0 :             return O_SYNC | o_direct_flag;
    8822              : #endif
    8823              : #ifdef O_DSYNC
    8824            0 :         case WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN_DSYNC:
    8825            0 :             return O_DSYNC | o_direct_flag;
    8826              : #endif
    8827            0 :         default:
    8828              :             /* can't happen (unless we are out of sync with option array) */
    8829            0 :             elog(ERROR, "unrecognized \"wal_sync_method\": %d", method);
    8830              :             return 0;           /* silence warning */
    8831              :     }
    8832              : }
    8833              : 
    8834              : /*
    8835              :  * GUC support
    8836              :  */
    8837              : void
    8838         1222 : assign_wal_sync_method(int new_wal_sync_method, void *extra)
    8839              : {
    8840         1222 :     if (wal_sync_method != new_wal_sync_method)
    8841              :     {
    8842              :         /*
    8843              :          * To ensure that no blocks escape unsynced, force an fsync on the
    8844              :          * currently open log segment (if any).  Also, if the open flag is
    8845              :          * changing, close the log file so it will be reopened (with new flag
    8846              :          * bit) at next use.
    8847              :          */
    8848            0 :         if (openLogFile >= 0)
    8849              :         {
    8850            0 :             pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_SYNC_METHOD_ASSIGN);
    8851            0 :             if (pg_fsync(openLogFile) != 0)
    8852              :             {
    8853              :                 char        xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
    8854              :                 int         save_errno;
    8855              : 
    8856            0 :                 save_errno = errno;
    8857            0 :                 XLogFileName(xlogfname, openLogTLI, openLogSegNo,
    8858              :                              wal_segment_size);
    8859            0 :                 errno = save_errno;
    8860            0 :                 ereport(PANIC,
    8861              :                         (errcode_for_file_access(),
    8862              :                          errmsg("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m", xlogfname)));
    8863              :             }
    8864              : 
    8865            0 :             pgstat_report_wait_end();
    8866            0 :             if (get_sync_bit(wal_sync_method) != get_sync_bit(new_wal_sync_method))
    8867            0 :                 XLogFileClose();
    8868              :         }
    8869              :     }
    8870         1222 : }
    8871              : 
    8872              : 
    8873              : /*
    8874              :  * Issue appropriate kind of fsync (if any) for an XLOG output file.
    8875              :  *
    8876              :  * 'fd' is a file descriptor for the XLOG file to be fsync'd.
    8877              :  * 'segno' is for error reporting purposes.
    8878              :  */
    8879              : void
    8880       201047 : issue_xlog_fsync(int fd, XLogSegNo segno, TimeLineID tli)
    8881              : {
    8882       201047 :     char       *msg = NULL;
    8883              :     instr_time  start;
    8884              : 
    8885              :     Assert(tli != 0);
    8886              : 
    8887              :     /*
    8888              :      * Quick exit if fsync is disabled or write() has already synced the WAL
    8889              :      * file.
    8890              :      */
    8891       201047 :     if (!enableFsync ||
    8892            0 :         wal_sync_method == WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN ||
    8893            0 :         wal_sync_method == WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN_DSYNC)
    8894       201047 :         return;
    8895              : 
    8896              :     /*
    8897              :      * Measure I/O timing to sync the WAL file for pg_stat_io.
    8898              :      */
    8899            0 :     start = pgstat_prepare_io_time(track_wal_io_timing);
    8900              : 
    8901            0 :     pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_SYNC);
    8902            0 :     switch (wal_sync_method)
    8903              :     {
    8904            0 :         case WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC:
    8905            0 :             if (pg_fsync_no_writethrough(fd) != 0)
    8906            0 :                 msg = _("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m");
    8907            0 :             break;
    8908              : #ifdef HAVE_FSYNC_WRITETHROUGH
    8909              :         case WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC_WRITETHROUGH:
    8910              :             if (pg_fsync_writethrough(fd) != 0)
    8911              :                 msg = _("could not fsync write-through file \"%s\": %m");
    8912              :             break;
    8913              : #endif
    8914            0 :         case WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FDATASYNC:
    8915            0 :             if (pg_fdatasync(fd) != 0)
    8916            0 :                 msg = _("could not fdatasync file \"%s\": %m");
    8917            0 :             break;
    8918            0 :         case WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN:
    8919              :         case WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN_DSYNC:
    8920              :             /* not reachable */
    8921              :             Assert(false);
    8922            0 :             break;
    8923            0 :         default:
    8924            0 :             ereport(PANIC,
    8925              :                     errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE),
    8926              :                     errmsg_internal("unrecognized \"wal_sync_method\": %d", wal_sync_method));
    8927              :             break;
    8928              :     }
    8929              : 
    8930              :     /* PANIC if failed to fsync */
    8931            0 :     if (msg)
    8932              :     {
    8933              :         char        xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
    8934            0 :         int         save_errno = errno;
    8935              : 
    8936            0 :         XLogFileName(xlogfname, tli, segno, wal_segment_size);
    8937            0 :         errno = save_errno;
    8938            0 :         ereport(PANIC,
    8939              :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    8940              :                  errmsg(msg, xlogfname)));
    8941              :     }
    8942              : 
    8943            0 :     pgstat_report_wait_end();
    8944              : 
    8945            0 :     pgstat_count_io_op_time(IOOBJECT_WAL, IOCONTEXT_NORMAL, IOOP_FSYNC,
    8946              :                             start, 1, 0);
    8947              : }
    8948              : 
    8949              : /*
    8950              :  * do_pg_backup_start is the workhorse of the user-visible pg_backup_start()
    8951              :  * function. It creates the necessary starting checkpoint and constructs the
    8952              :  * backup state and tablespace map.
    8953              :  *
    8954              :  * Input parameters are "state" (the backup state), "fast" (if true, we do
    8955              :  * the checkpoint in fast mode), and "tablespaces" (if non-NULL, indicates a
    8956              :  * list of tablespaceinfo structs describing the cluster's tablespaces.).
    8957              :  *
    8958              :  * The tablespace map contents are appended to passed-in parameter
    8959              :  * tablespace_map and the caller is responsible for including it in the backup
    8960              :  * archive as 'tablespace_map'. The tablespace_map file is required mainly for
    8961              :  * tar format in windows as native windows utilities are not able to create
    8962              :  * symlinks while extracting files from tar. However for consistency and
    8963              :  * platform-independence, we do it the same way everywhere.
    8964              :  *
    8965              :  * It fills in "state" with the information required for the backup, such
    8966              :  * as the minimum WAL location that must be present to restore from this
    8967              :  * backup (starttli) and the corresponding timeline ID (starttli).
    8968              :  *
    8969              :  * Every successfully started backup must be stopped by calling
    8970              :  * do_pg_backup_stop() or do_pg_abort_backup(). There can be many
    8971              :  * backups active at the same time.
    8972              :  *
    8973              :  * It is the responsibility of the caller of this function to verify the
    8974              :  * permissions of the calling user!
    8975              :  */
    8976              : void
    8977          177 : do_pg_backup_start(const char *backupidstr, bool fast, List **tablespaces,
    8978              :                    BackupState *state, StringInfo tblspcmapfile)
    8979              : {
    8980              :     bool        backup_started_in_recovery;
    8981              : 
    8982              :     Assert(state != NULL);
    8983          177 :     backup_started_in_recovery = RecoveryInProgress();
    8984              : 
    8985              :     /*
    8986              :      * During recovery, we don't need to check WAL level. Because, if WAL
    8987              :      * level is not sufficient, it's impossible to get here during recovery.
    8988              :      */
    8989          177 :     if (!backup_started_in_recovery && !XLogIsNeeded())
    8990            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    8991              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    8992              :                  errmsg("WAL level not sufficient for making an online backup"),
    8993              :                  errhint("\"wal_level\" must be set to \"replica\" or \"logical\" at server start.")));
    8994              : 
    8995          177 :     if (strlen(backupidstr) > MAXPGPATH)
    8996            1 :         ereport(ERROR,
    8997              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE),
    8998              :                  errmsg("backup label too long (max %d bytes)",
    8999              :                         MAXPGPATH)));
    9000              : 
    9001          176 :     strlcpy(state->name, backupidstr, sizeof(state->name));
    9002              : 
    9003              :     /*
    9004              :      * Mark backup active in shared memory.  We must do full-page WAL writes
    9005              :      * during an on-line backup even if not doing so at other times, because
    9006              :      * it's quite possible for the backup dump to obtain a "torn" (partially
    9007              :      * written) copy of a database page if it reads the page concurrently with
    9008              :      * our write to the same page.  This can be fixed as long as the first
    9009              :      * write to the page in the WAL sequence is a full-page write. Hence, we
    9010              :      * increment runningBackups then force a CHECKPOINT, to ensure there are
    9011              :      * no dirty pages in shared memory that might get dumped while the backup
    9012              :      * is in progress without having a corresponding WAL record.  (Once the
    9013              :      * backup is complete, we need not force full-page writes anymore, since
    9014              :      * we expect that any pages not modified during the backup interval must
    9015              :      * have been correctly captured by the backup.)
    9016              :      *
    9017              :      * Note that forcing full-page writes has no effect during an online
    9018              :      * backup from the standby.
    9019              :      *
    9020              :      * We must hold all the insertion locks to change the value of
    9021              :      * runningBackups, to ensure adequate interlocking against
    9022              :      * XLogInsertRecord().
    9023              :      */
    9024          176 :     WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive();
    9025          176 :     XLogCtl->Insert.runningBackups++;
    9026          176 :     WALInsertLockRelease();
    9027              : 
    9028              :     /*
    9029              :      * Ensure we decrement runningBackups if we fail below. NB -- for this to
    9030              :      * work correctly, it is critical that sessionBackupState is only updated
    9031              :      * after this block is over.
    9032              :      */
    9033          176 :     PG_ENSURE_ERROR_CLEANUP(do_pg_abort_backup, BoolGetDatum(true));
    9034              :     {
    9035          176 :         bool        gotUniqueStartpoint = false;
    9036              :         DIR        *tblspcdir;
    9037              :         struct dirent *de;
    9038              :         tablespaceinfo *ti;
    9039              :         int         datadirpathlen;
    9040              : 
    9041              :         /*
    9042              :          * Force an XLOG file switch before the checkpoint, to ensure that the
    9043              :          * WAL segment the checkpoint is written to doesn't contain pages with
    9044              :          * old timeline IDs.  That would otherwise happen if you called
    9045              :          * pg_backup_start() right after restoring from a PITR archive: the
    9046              :          * first WAL segment containing the startup checkpoint has pages in
    9047              :          * the beginning with the old timeline ID.  That can cause trouble at
    9048              :          * recovery: we won't have a history file covering the old timeline if
    9049              :          * pg_wal directory was not included in the base backup and the WAL
    9050              :          * archive was cleared too before starting the backup.
    9051              :          *
    9052              :          * During recovery, we skip forcing XLOG file switch, which means that
    9053              :          * the backup taken during recovery is not available for the special
    9054              :          * recovery case described above.
    9055              :          */
    9056          176 :         if (!backup_started_in_recovery)
    9057          168 :             RequestXLogSwitch(false);
    9058              : 
    9059              :         do
    9060              :         {
    9061              :             bool        checkpointfpw;
    9062              : 
    9063              :             /*
    9064              :              * Force a CHECKPOINT.  Aside from being necessary to prevent torn
    9065              :              * page problems, this guarantees that two successive backup runs
    9066              :              * will have different checkpoint positions and hence different
    9067              :              * history file names, even if nothing happened in between.
    9068              :              *
    9069              :              * During recovery, establish a restartpoint if possible. We use
    9070              :              * the last restartpoint as the backup starting checkpoint. This
    9071              :              * means that two successive backup runs can have same checkpoint
    9072              :              * positions.
    9073              :              *
    9074              :              * Since the fact that we are executing do_pg_backup_start()
    9075              :              * during recovery means that checkpointer is running, we can use
    9076              :              * RequestCheckpoint() to establish a restartpoint.
    9077              :              *
    9078              :              * We use CHECKPOINT_FAST only if requested by user (via passing
    9079              :              * fast = true).  Otherwise this can take awhile.
    9080              :              */
    9081          176 :             RequestCheckpoint(CHECKPOINT_FORCE | CHECKPOINT_WAIT |
    9082              :                               (fast ? CHECKPOINT_FAST : 0));
    9083              : 
    9084              :             /*
    9085              :              * Now we need to fetch the checkpoint record location, and also
    9086              :              * its REDO pointer.  The oldest point in WAL that would be needed
    9087              :              * to restore starting from the checkpoint is precisely the REDO
    9088              :              * pointer.
    9089              :              */
    9090          176 :             LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_SHARED);
    9091          176 :             state->checkpointloc = ControlFile->checkPoint;
    9092          176 :             state->startpoint = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo;
    9093          176 :             state->starttli = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.ThisTimeLineID;
    9094          176 :             checkpointfpw = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.fullPageWrites;
    9095          176 :             LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    9096              : 
    9097          176 :             if (backup_started_in_recovery)
    9098              :             {
    9099              :                 XLogRecPtr  recptr;
    9100              : 
    9101              :                 /*
    9102              :                  * Check to see if all WAL replayed during online backup
    9103              :                  * (i.e., since last restartpoint used as backup starting
    9104              :                  * checkpoint) contain full-page writes.
    9105              :                  */
    9106            8 :                 SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    9107            8 :                 recptr = XLogCtl->lastFpwDisableRecPtr;
    9108            8 :                 SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    9109              : 
    9110            8 :                 if (!checkpointfpw || state->startpoint <= recptr)
    9111            0 :                     ereport(ERROR,
    9112              :                             (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    9113              :                              errmsg("WAL generated with \"full_page_writes=off\" was replayed "
    9114              :                                     "since last restartpoint"),
    9115              :                              errhint("This means that the backup being taken on the standby "
    9116              :                                      "is corrupt and should not be used. "
    9117              :                                      "Enable \"full_page_writes\" and run CHECKPOINT on the primary, "
    9118              :                                      "and then try an online backup again.")));
    9119              : 
    9120              :                 /*
    9121              :                  * During recovery, since we don't use the end-of-backup WAL
    9122              :                  * record and don't write the backup history file, the
    9123              :                  * starting WAL location doesn't need to be unique. This means
    9124              :                  * that two base backups started at the same time might use
    9125              :                  * the same checkpoint as starting locations.
    9126              :                  */
    9127            8 :                 gotUniqueStartpoint = true;
    9128              :             }
    9129              : 
    9130              :             /*
    9131              :              * If two base backups are started at the same time (in WAL sender
    9132              :              * processes), we need to make sure that they use different
    9133              :              * checkpoints as starting locations, because we use the starting
    9134              :              * WAL location as a unique identifier for the base backup in the
    9135              :              * end-of-backup WAL record and when we write the backup history
    9136              :              * file. Perhaps it would be better generate a separate unique ID
    9137              :              * for each backup instead of forcing another checkpoint, but
    9138              :              * taking a checkpoint right after another is not that expensive
    9139              :              * either because only few buffers have been dirtied yet.
    9140              :              */
    9141          176 :             WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive();
    9142          176 :             if (XLogCtl->Insert.lastBackupStart < state->startpoint)
    9143              :             {
    9144          176 :                 XLogCtl->Insert.lastBackupStart = state->startpoint;
    9145          176 :                 gotUniqueStartpoint = true;
    9146              :             }
    9147          176 :             WALInsertLockRelease();
    9148          176 :         } while (!gotUniqueStartpoint);
    9149              : 
    9150              :         /*
    9151              :          * Construct tablespace_map file.
    9152              :          */
    9153          176 :         datadirpathlen = strlen(DataDir);
    9154              : 
    9155              :         /* Collect information about all tablespaces */
    9156          176 :         tblspcdir = AllocateDir(PG_TBLSPC_DIR);
    9157          566 :         while ((de = ReadDir(tblspcdir, PG_TBLSPC_DIR)) != NULL)
    9158              :         {
    9159              :             char        fullpath[MAXPGPATH + sizeof(PG_TBLSPC_DIR)];
    9160              :             char        linkpath[MAXPGPATH];
    9161          390 :             char       *relpath = NULL;
    9162              :             char       *s;
    9163              :             PGFileType  de_type;
    9164              :             char       *badp;
    9165              :             Oid         tsoid;
    9166              : 
    9167              :             /*
    9168              :              * Try to parse the directory name as an unsigned integer.
    9169              :              *
    9170              :              * Tablespace directories should be positive integers that can be
    9171              :              * represented in 32 bits, with no leading zeroes or trailing
    9172              :              * garbage. If we come across a name that doesn't meet those
    9173              :              * criteria, skip it.
    9174              :              */
    9175          390 :             if (de->d_name[0] < '1' || de->d_name[1] > '9')
    9176          352 :                 continue;
    9177           38 :             errno = 0;
    9178           38 :             tsoid = strtoul(de->d_name, &badp, 10);
    9179           38 :             if (*badp != '\0' || errno == EINVAL || errno == ERANGE)
    9180            0 :                 continue;
    9181              : 
    9182           38 :             snprintf(fullpath, sizeof(fullpath), "%s/%s", PG_TBLSPC_DIR, de->d_name);
    9183              : 
    9184           38 :             de_type = get_dirent_type(fullpath, de, false, ERROR);
    9185              : 
    9186           38 :             if (de_type == PGFILETYPE_LNK)
    9187              :             {
    9188              :                 StringInfoData escapedpath;
    9189              :                 int         rllen;
    9190              : 
    9191           23 :                 rllen = readlink(fullpath, linkpath, sizeof(linkpath));
    9192           23 :                 if (rllen < 0)
    9193              :                 {
    9194            0 :                     ereport(WARNING,
    9195              :                             (errmsg("could not read symbolic link \"%s\": %m",
    9196              :                                     fullpath)));
    9197            0 :                     continue;
    9198              :                 }
    9199           23 :                 else if (rllen >= sizeof(linkpath))
    9200              :                 {
    9201            0 :                     ereport(WARNING,
    9202              :                             (errmsg("symbolic link \"%s\" target is too long",
    9203              :                                     fullpath)));
    9204            0 :                     continue;
    9205              :                 }
    9206           23 :                 linkpath[rllen] = '\0';
    9207              : 
    9208              :                 /*
    9209              :                  * Relpath holds the relative path of the tablespace directory
    9210              :                  * when it's located within PGDATA, or NULL if it's located
    9211              :                  * elsewhere.
    9212              :                  */
    9213           23 :                 if (rllen > datadirpathlen &&
    9214            1 :                     strncmp(linkpath, DataDir, datadirpathlen) == 0 &&
    9215            0 :                     IS_DIR_SEP(linkpath[datadirpathlen]))
    9216            0 :                     relpath = pstrdup(linkpath + datadirpathlen + 1);
    9217              : 
    9218              :                 /*
    9219              :                  * Add a backslash-escaped version of the link path to the
    9220              :                  * tablespace map file.
    9221              :                  */
    9222           23 :                 initStringInfo(&escapedpath);
    9223          562 :                 for (s = linkpath; *s; s++)
    9224              :                 {
    9225          539 :                     if (*s == '\n' || *s == '\r' || *s == '\\')
    9226            0 :                         appendStringInfoChar(&escapedpath, '\\');
    9227          539 :                     appendStringInfoChar(&escapedpath, *s);
    9228              :                 }
    9229           23 :                 appendStringInfo(tblspcmapfile, "%s %s\n",
    9230           23 :                                  de->d_name, escapedpath.data);
    9231           23 :                 pfree(escapedpath.data);
    9232              :             }
    9233           15 :             else if (de_type == PGFILETYPE_DIR)
    9234              :             {
    9235              :                 /*
    9236              :                  * It's possible to use allow_in_place_tablespaces to create
    9237              :                  * directories directly under pg_tblspc, for testing purposes
    9238              :                  * only.
    9239              :                  *
    9240              :                  * In this case, we store a relative path rather than an
    9241              :                  * absolute path into the tablespaceinfo.
    9242              :                  */
    9243           15 :                 snprintf(linkpath, sizeof(linkpath), "%s/%s",
    9244           15 :                          PG_TBLSPC_DIR, de->d_name);
    9245           15 :                 relpath = pstrdup(linkpath);
    9246              :             }
    9247              :             else
    9248              :             {
    9249              :                 /* Skip any other file type that appears here. */
    9250            0 :                 continue;
    9251              :             }
    9252              : 
    9253           38 :             ti = palloc_object(tablespaceinfo);
    9254           38 :             ti->oid = tsoid;
    9255           38 :             ti->path = pstrdup(linkpath);
    9256           38 :             ti->rpath = relpath;
    9257           38 :             ti->size = -1;
    9258              : 
    9259           38 :             if (tablespaces)
    9260           38 :                 *tablespaces = lappend(*tablespaces, ti);
    9261              :         }
    9262          176 :         FreeDir(tblspcdir);
    9263              : 
    9264          176 :         state->starttime = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
    9265              :     }
    9266          176 :     PG_END_ENSURE_ERROR_CLEANUP(do_pg_abort_backup, BoolGetDatum(true));
    9267              : 
    9268          176 :     state->started_in_recovery = backup_started_in_recovery;
    9269              : 
    9270              :     /*
    9271              :      * Mark that the start phase has correctly finished for the backup.
    9272              :      */
    9273          176 :     sessionBackupState = SESSION_BACKUP_RUNNING;
    9274          176 : }
    9275              : 
    9276              : /*
    9277              :  * Utility routine to fetch the session-level status of a backup running.
    9278              :  */
    9279              : SessionBackupState
    9280          199 : get_backup_status(void)
    9281              : {
    9282          199 :     return sessionBackupState;
    9283              : }
    9284              : 
    9285              : /*
    9286              :  * do_pg_backup_stop
    9287              :  *
    9288              :  * Utility function called at the end of an online backup.  It creates history
    9289              :  * file (if required), resets sessionBackupState and so on.  It can optionally
    9290              :  * wait for WAL segments to be archived.
    9291              :  *
    9292              :  * "state" is filled with the information necessary to restore from this
    9293              :  * backup with its stop LSN (stoppoint), its timeline ID (stoptli), etc.
    9294              :  *
    9295              :  * It is the responsibility of the caller of this function to verify the
    9296              :  * permissions of the calling user!
    9297              :  */
    9298              : void
    9299          169 : do_pg_backup_stop(BackupState *state, bool waitforarchive)
    9300              : {
    9301          169 :     bool        backup_stopped_in_recovery = false;
    9302              :     char        histfilepath[MAXPGPATH];
    9303              :     char        lastxlogfilename[MAXFNAMELEN];
    9304              :     char        histfilename[MAXFNAMELEN];
    9305              :     XLogSegNo   _logSegNo;
    9306              :     FILE       *fp;
    9307              :     int         seconds_before_warning;
    9308          169 :     int         waits = 0;
    9309          169 :     bool        reported_waiting = false;
    9310              : 
    9311              :     Assert(state != NULL);
    9312              : 
    9313          169 :     backup_stopped_in_recovery = RecoveryInProgress();
    9314              : 
    9315              :     /*
    9316              :      * During recovery, we don't need to check WAL level. Because, if WAL
    9317              :      * level is not sufficient, it's impossible to get here during recovery.
    9318              :      */
    9319          169 :     if (!backup_stopped_in_recovery && !XLogIsNeeded())
    9320            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    9321              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    9322              :                  errmsg("WAL level not sufficient for making an online backup"),
    9323              :                  errhint("\"wal_level\" must be set to \"replica\" or \"logical\" at server start.")));
    9324              : 
    9325              :     /*
    9326              :      * OK to update backup counter and session-level lock.
    9327              :      *
    9328              :      * Note that CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPTS() must not occur while updating them,
    9329              :      * otherwise they can be updated inconsistently, which might cause
    9330              :      * do_pg_abort_backup() to fail.
    9331              :      */
    9332          169 :     WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive();
    9333              : 
    9334              :     /*
    9335              :      * It is expected that each do_pg_backup_start() call is matched by
    9336              :      * exactly one do_pg_backup_stop() call.
    9337              :      */
    9338              :     Assert(XLogCtl->Insert.runningBackups > 0);
    9339          169 :     XLogCtl->Insert.runningBackups--;
    9340              : 
    9341              :     /*
    9342              :      * Clean up session-level lock.
    9343              :      *
    9344              :      * You might think that WALInsertLockRelease() can be called before
    9345              :      * cleaning up session-level lock because session-level lock doesn't need
    9346              :      * to be protected with WAL insertion lock. But since
    9347              :      * CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPTS() can occur in it, session-level lock must be
    9348              :      * cleaned up before it.
    9349              :      */
    9350          169 :     sessionBackupState = SESSION_BACKUP_NONE;
    9351              : 
    9352          169 :     WALInsertLockRelease();
    9353              : 
    9354              :     /*
    9355              :      * If we are taking an online backup from the standby, we confirm that the
    9356              :      * standby has not been promoted during the backup.
    9357              :      */
    9358          169 :     if (state->started_in_recovery && !backup_stopped_in_recovery)
    9359            0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    9360              :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    9361              :                  errmsg("the standby was promoted during online backup"),
    9362              :                  errhint("This means that the backup being taken is corrupt "
    9363              :                          "and should not be used. "
    9364              :                          "Try taking another online backup.")));
    9365              : 
    9366              :     /*
    9367              :      * During recovery, we don't write an end-of-backup record. We assume that
    9368              :      * pg_control was backed up last and its minimum recovery point can be
    9369              :      * available as the backup end location. Since we don't have an
    9370              :      * end-of-backup record, we use the pg_control value to check whether
    9371              :      * we've reached the end of backup when starting recovery from this
    9372              :      * backup. We have no way of checking if pg_control wasn't backed up last
    9373              :      * however.
    9374              :      *
    9375              :      * We don't force a switch to new WAL file but it is still possible to
    9376              :      * wait for all the required files to be archived if waitforarchive is
    9377              :      * true. This is okay if we use the backup to start a standby and fetch
    9378              :      * the missing WAL using streaming replication. But in the case of an
    9379              :      * archive recovery, a user should set waitforarchive to true and wait for
    9380              :      * them to be archived to ensure that all the required files are
    9381              :      * available.
    9382              :      *
    9383              :      * We return the current minimum recovery point as the backup end
    9384              :      * location. Note that it can be greater than the exact backup end
    9385              :      * location if the minimum recovery point is updated after the backup of
    9386              :      * pg_control. This is harmless for current uses.
    9387              :      *
    9388              :      * XXX currently a backup history file is for informational and debug
    9389              :      * purposes only. It's not essential for an online backup. Furthermore,
    9390              :      * even if it's created, it will not be archived during recovery because
    9391              :      * an archiver is not invoked. So it doesn't seem worthwhile to write a
    9392              :      * backup history file during recovery.
    9393              :      */
    9394          169 :     if (backup_stopped_in_recovery)
    9395              :     {
    9396              :         XLogRecPtr  recptr;
    9397              : 
    9398              :         /*
    9399              :          * Check to see if all WAL replayed during online backup contain
    9400              :          * full-page writes.
    9401              :          */
    9402            8 :         SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    9403            8 :         recptr = XLogCtl->lastFpwDisableRecPtr;
    9404            8 :         SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    9405              : 
    9406            8 :         if (state->startpoint <= recptr)
    9407            0 :             ereport(ERROR,
    9408              :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    9409              :                      errmsg("WAL generated with \"full_page_writes=off\" was replayed "
    9410              :                             "during online backup"),
    9411              :                      errhint("This means that the backup being taken on the standby "
    9412              :                              "is corrupt and should not be used. "
    9413              :                              "Enable \"full_page_writes\" and run CHECKPOINT on the primary, "
    9414              :                              "and then try an online backup again.")));
    9415              : 
    9416              : 
    9417            8 :         LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_SHARED);
    9418            8 :         state->stoppoint = ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint;
    9419            8 :         state->stoptli = ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI;
    9420            8 :         LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    9421              :     }
    9422              :     else
    9423              :     {
    9424              :         char       *history_file;
    9425              : 
    9426              :         /*
    9427              :          * Write the backup-end xlog record
    9428              :          */
    9429          161 :         XLogBeginInsert();
    9430          161 :         XLogRegisterData(&state->startpoint,
    9431              :                          sizeof(state->startpoint));
    9432          161 :         state->stoppoint = XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_BACKUP_END);
    9433              : 
    9434              :         /*
    9435              :          * Given that we're not in recovery, InsertTimeLineID is set and can't
    9436              :          * change, so we can read it without a lock.
    9437              :          */
    9438          161 :         state->stoptli = XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
    9439              : 
    9440              :         /*
    9441              :          * Force a switch to a new xlog segment file, so that the backup is
    9442              :          * valid as soon as archiver moves out the current segment file.
    9443              :          */
    9444          161 :         RequestXLogSwitch(false);
    9445              : 
    9446          161 :         state->stoptime = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
    9447              : 
    9448              :         /*
    9449              :          * Write the backup history file
    9450              :          */
    9451          161 :         XLByteToSeg(state->startpoint, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    9452          161 :         BackupHistoryFilePath(histfilepath, state->stoptli, _logSegNo,
    9453              :                               state->startpoint, wal_segment_size);
    9454          161 :         fp = AllocateFile(histfilepath, "w");
    9455          161 :         if (!fp)
    9456            0 :             ereport(ERROR,
    9457              :                     (errcode_for_file_access(),
    9458              :                      errmsg("could not create file \"%s\": %m",
    9459              :                             histfilepath)));
    9460              : 
    9461              :         /* Build and save the contents of the backup history file */
    9462          161 :         history_file = build_backup_content(state, true);
    9463          161 :         fprintf(fp, "%s", history_file);
    9464          161 :         pfree(history_file);
    9465              : 
    9466          161 :         if (fflush(fp) || ferror(fp) || FreeFile(fp))
    9467            0 :             ereport(ERROR,
    9468              :                     (errcode_for_file_access(),
    9469              :                      errmsg("could not write file \"%s\": %m",
    9470              :                             histfilepath)));
    9471              : 
    9472              :         /*
    9473              :          * Clean out any no-longer-needed history files.  As a side effect,
    9474              :          * this will post a .ready file for the newly created history file,
    9475              :          * notifying the archiver that history file may be archived
    9476              :          * immediately.
    9477              :          */
    9478          161 :         CleanupBackupHistory();
    9479              :     }
    9480              : 
    9481              :     /*
    9482              :      * If archiving is enabled, wait for all the required WAL files to be
    9483              :      * archived before returning. If archiving isn't enabled, the required WAL
    9484              :      * needs to be transported via streaming replication (hopefully with
    9485              :      * wal_keep_size set high enough), or some more exotic mechanism like
    9486              :      * polling and copying files from pg_wal with script. We have no knowledge
    9487              :      * of those mechanisms, so it's up to the user to ensure that he gets all
    9488              :      * the required WAL.
    9489              :      *
    9490              :      * We wait until both the last WAL file filled during backup and the
    9491              :      * history file have been archived, and assume that the alphabetic sorting
    9492              :      * property of the WAL files ensures any earlier WAL files are safely
    9493              :      * archived as well.
    9494              :      *
    9495              :      * We wait forever, since archive_command is supposed to work and we
    9496              :      * assume the admin wanted his backup to work completely. If you don't
    9497              :      * wish to wait, then either waitforarchive should be passed in as false,
    9498              :      * or you can set statement_timeout.  Also, some notices are issued to
    9499              :      * clue in anyone who might be doing this interactively.
    9500              :      */
    9501              : 
    9502          169 :     if (waitforarchive &&
    9503           12 :         ((!backup_stopped_in_recovery && XLogArchivingActive()) ||
    9504            1 :          (backup_stopped_in_recovery && XLogArchivingAlways())))
    9505              :     {
    9506            5 :         XLByteToPrevSeg(state->stoppoint, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    9507            5 :         XLogFileName(lastxlogfilename, state->stoptli, _logSegNo,
    9508              :                      wal_segment_size);
    9509              : 
    9510            5 :         XLByteToSeg(state->startpoint, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    9511            5 :         BackupHistoryFileName(histfilename, state->stoptli, _logSegNo,
    9512              :                               state->startpoint, wal_segment_size);
    9513              : 
    9514            5 :         seconds_before_warning = 60;
    9515            5 :         waits = 0;
    9516              : 
    9517           15 :         while (XLogArchiveIsBusy(lastxlogfilename) ||
    9518            5 :                XLogArchiveIsBusy(histfilename))
    9519              :         {
    9520            5 :             CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPTS();
    9521              : 
    9522            5 :             if (!reported_waiting && waits > 5)
    9523              :             {
    9524            0 :                 ereport(NOTICE,
    9525              :                         (errmsg("base backup done, waiting for required WAL segments to be archived")));
    9526            0 :                 reported_waiting = true;
    9527              :             }
    9528              : 
    9529            5 :             (void) WaitLatch(MyLatch,
    9530              :                              WL_LATCH_SET | WL_TIMEOUT | WL_EXIT_ON_PM_DEATH,
    9531              :                              1000L,
    9532              :                              WAIT_EVENT_BACKUP_WAIT_WAL_ARCHIVE);
    9533            5 :             ResetLatch(MyLatch);
    9534              : 
    9535            5 :             if (++waits >= seconds_before_warning)
    9536              :             {
    9537            0 :                 seconds_before_warning *= 2;    /* This wraps in >10 years... */
    9538            0 :                 ereport(WARNING,
    9539              :                         (errmsg("still waiting for all required WAL segments to be archived (%d seconds elapsed)",
    9540              :                                 waits),
    9541              :                          errhint("Check that your \"archive_command\" is executing properly.  "
    9542              :                                  "You can safely cancel this backup, "
    9543              :                                  "but the database backup will not be usable without all the WAL segments.")));
    9544              :             }
    9545              :         }
    9546              : 
    9547            5 :         ereport(NOTICE,
    9548              :                 (errmsg("all required WAL segments have been archived")));
    9549              :     }
    9550          164 :     else if (waitforarchive)
    9551            7 :         ereport(NOTICE,
    9552              :                 (errmsg("WAL archiving is not enabled; you must ensure that all required WAL segments are copied through other means to complete the backup")));
    9553          169 : }
    9554              : 
    9555              : 
    9556              : /*
    9557              :  * do_pg_abort_backup: abort a running backup
    9558              :  *
    9559              :  * This does just the most basic steps of do_pg_backup_stop(), by taking the
    9560              :  * system out of backup mode, thus making it a lot more safe to call from
    9561              :  * an error handler.
    9562              :  *
    9563              :  * 'arg' indicates that it's being called during backup setup; so
    9564              :  * sessionBackupState has not been modified yet, but runningBackups has
    9565              :  * already been incremented.  When it's false, then it's invoked as a
    9566              :  * before_shmem_exit handler, and therefore we must not change state
    9567              :  * unless sessionBackupState indicates that a backup is actually running.
    9568              :  *
    9569              :  * NB: This gets used as a PG_ENSURE_ERROR_CLEANUP callback and
    9570              :  * before_shmem_exit handler, hence the odd-looking signature.
    9571              :  */
    9572              : void
    9573           10 : do_pg_abort_backup(int code, Datum arg)
    9574              : {
    9575           10 :     bool        during_backup_start = DatumGetBool(arg);
    9576              : 
    9577              :     /* If called during backup start, there shouldn't be one already running */
    9578              :     Assert(!during_backup_start || sessionBackupState == SESSION_BACKUP_NONE);
    9579              : 
    9580           10 :     if (during_backup_start || sessionBackupState != SESSION_BACKUP_NONE)
    9581              :     {
    9582            7 :         WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive();
    9583              :         Assert(XLogCtl->Insert.runningBackups > 0);
    9584            7 :         XLogCtl->Insert.runningBackups--;
    9585              : 
    9586            7 :         sessionBackupState = SESSION_BACKUP_NONE;
    9587            7 :         WALInsertLockRelease();
    9588              : 
    9589            7 :         if (!during_backup_start)
    9590            7 :             ereport(WARNING,
    9591              :                     errmsg("aborting backup due to backend exiting before pg_backup_stop was called"));
    9592              :     }
    9593           10 : }
    9594              : 
    9595              : /*
    9596              :  * Register a handler that will warn about unterminated backups at end of
    9597              :  * session, unless this has already been done.
    9598              :  */
    9599              : void
    9600            5 : register_persistent_abort_backup_handler(void)
    9601              : {
    9602              :     static bool already_done = false;
    9603              : 
    9604            5 :     if (already_done)
    9605            1 :         return;
    9606            4 :     before_shmem_exit(do_pg_abort_backup, BoolGetDatum(false));
    9607            4 :     already_done = true;
    9608              : }
    9609              : 
    9610              : /*
    9611              :  * Get latest WAL insert pointer
    9612              :  */
    9613              : XLogRecPtr
    9614         2139 : GetXLogInsertRecPtr(void)
    9615              : {
    9616         2139 :     XLogCtlInsert *Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert;
    9617              :     uint64      current_bytepos;
    9618              : 
    9619         2139 :     SpinLockAcquire(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
    9620         2139 :     current_bytepos = Insert->CurrBytePos;
    9621         2139 :     SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
    9622              : 
    9623         2139 :     return XLogBytePosToRecPtr(current_bytepos);
    9624              : }
    9625              : 
    9626              : /*
    9627              :  * Get latest WAL record end pointer
    9628              :  */
    9629              : XLogRecPtr
    9630       100482 : GetXLogInsertEndRecPtr(void)
    9631              : {
    9632       100482 :     XLogCtlInsert *Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert;
    9633              :     uint64      current_bytepos;
    9634              : 
    9635       100482 :     SpinLockAcquire(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
    9636       100482 :     current_bytepos = Insert->CurrBytePos;
    9637       100482 :     SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
    9638              : 
    9639       100482 :     return XLogBytePosToEndRecPtr(current_bytepos);
    9640              : }
    9641              : 
    9642              : /*
    9643              :  * Get latest WAL write pointer
    9644              :  */
    9645              : XLogRecPtr
    9646        13633 : GetXLogWriteRecPtr(void)
    9647              : {
    9648        13633 :     RefreshXLogWriteResult(LogwrtResult);
    9649              : 
    9650        13633 :     return LogwrtResult.Write;
    9651              : }
    9652              : 
    9653              : /*
    9654              :  * Returns the redo pointer of the last checkpoint or restartpoint. This is
    9655              :  * the oldest point in WAL that we still need, if we have to restart recovery.
    9656              :  */
    9657              : void
    9658          392 : GetOldestRestartPoint(XLogRecPtr *oldrecptr, TimeLineID *oldtli)
    9659              : {
    9660          392 :     LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_SHARED);
    9661          392 :     *oldrecptr = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo;
    9662          392 :     *oldtli = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.ThisTimeLineID;
    9663          392 :     LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    9664          392 : }
    9665              : 
    9666              : /* Thin wrapper around ShutdownWalRcv(). */
    9667              : void
    9668         1032 : XLogShutdownWalRcv(void)
    9669              : {
    9670              :     Assert(AmStartupProcess() || !IsUnderPostmaster);
    9671              : 
    9672         1032 :     ShutdownWalRcv();
    9673         1032 :     ResetInstallXLogFileSegmentActive();
    9674         1032 : }
    9675              : 
    9676              : /* Enable WAL file recycling and preallocation. */
    9677              : void
    9678         1210 : SetInstallXLogFileSegmentActive(void)
    9679              : {
    9680         1210 :     LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    9681         1210 :     XLogCtl->InstallXLogFileSegmentActive = true;
    9682         1210 :     LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    9683         1210 : }
    9684              : 
    9685              : /* Disable WAL file recycling and preallocation. */
    9686              : void
    9687         1185 : ResetInstallXLogFileSegmentActive(void)
    9688              : {
    9689         1185 :     LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    9690         1185 :     XLogCtl->InstallXLogFileSegmentActive = false;
    9691         1185 :     LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    9692         1185 : }
    9693              : 
    9694              : bool
    9695            0 : IsInstallXLogFileSegmentActive(void)
    9696              : {
    9697              :     bool        result;
    9698              : 
    9699            0 :     LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_SHARED);
    9700            0 :     result = XLogCtl->InstallXLogFileSegmentActive;
    9701            0 :     LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    9702              : 
    9703            0 :     return result;
    9704              : }
    9705              : 
    9706              : /*
    9707              :  * Update the WalWriterSleeping flag.
    9708              :  */
    9709              : void
    9710          595 : SetWalWriterSleeping(bool sleeping)
    9711              : {
    9712          595 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    9713          595 :     XLogCtl->WalWriterSleeping = sleeping;
    9714          595 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    9715          595 : }
        

Generated by: LCOV version 2.0-1